Annual Statements Open main menu

QCR HOLDINGS INC - Annual Report: 2021 (Form 10-K)

Table of Contents

U.S. SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2021.

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file number: 0-22208

QCR HOLDINGS, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware

42-1397595

(State of incorporation)

(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

3551 7th Street, Moline, Illinois 61265

(Address of principal executive offices)

(309) 736-3580

(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act:

Title of each class

Trading Symbol(s)

Name of each exchange on which registered

Common Stock, $1.00 Par Value

QCRH

The Nasdaq Global Market

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act:

Preferred Share Purchase Rights

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

Yes  [ ]  No  [ X ]

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act.

Yes  [ ]  No  [ X ]

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for past 90 days.  Yes  [ X ]  No  [ ]

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

                                                                                                                                                                                                Yes  [ X ]   No  [ ]

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer [X]

Accelerated filer  [ ]

Non-accelerated filer [  ]

Smaller reporting company [  ]

Emerging growth company [  ]

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.   [   ]          

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report. [X]

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes  [   ]  No  [ X ]

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant, based on the last sales price quoted on The Nasdaq Global Market on June 30, 2021, the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter, was approximately $730,269,379.

As of February 18, 2022 the Registrant had outstanding 15,641,927 shares of common stock, $1.00 par value per share.

Documents incorporated by reference:

Part III of Form 10-K  incorporates by reference portions of the proxy statement for annual meeting of stockholders to be held in May 2022.

Table of Contents

QCR HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

INDEX

Page
Number(s)

Part I

4

Item 1.

Business

4

Item 1A.

Risk Factors

14

Item 1B.

Unresolved Staff Comments

27

Item 2.

Properties

27

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

27

Item 4.

Mine Safety Disclosures

27

Part II

28

Item 5.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

28

Item 6.

[Reserved]

29

Item 7.

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

30

General

30

Executive Overview

32

Strategic Financial Metrics

34

Strategic Developments

34

GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliations

35

Net Interest Income and Margin (Tax Equivalent Basis)(Non-GAAP)

37

Critical Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates

30

Results of Operations

39

Interest Income

39

Interest Expense

39

Provision for Credit Losses

40

Noninterest Income

41

Noninterest Expenses

42

Income Tax Expense

44

Financial Condition

44

Overview

44

Investment Securities

44

Loans/Leases

46

Allowance for Credit Losses on Loans/Leases and OBS Exposures

47

Nonperforming Assets

50

Deposits

51

Short-Term Borrowings

52

FHLB Advances and Other Borrowings

52

Subordinated Notes

52

Stockholders’ Equity

53

Liquidity and Capital Resources

53

Commitments, Contingencies, Contractual Obligations, and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

54

Impact of Inflation and Changing Prices

55

Forward-Looking Statements

55

Item 7A.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

56

Item 8.

Consolidated Financial Statements

58

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2021 and 2020

62

Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019

63

2

Table of Contents

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019

64

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019

65

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019

66

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

68

Note 1: Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies

68

Note 2: Sales/Mergers/Acquisitions

85

Note 3: Investment Securities

87

Note 4: Loans/Leases Receivable

91

Note 5: Premises and Equipment

105

Note 6: Goodwill and Intangibles

107

Note 7: Derivatives and Hedging Activities

109

Note 8: Deposits

112

Note 9: Short-Term Borrowings

113

Note 10: FHLB Advances

113

Note 11: Other Borrowings and Unused Lines of Credit

114

Note 12: Subordinated Notes

114

Note 13: Junior Subordinated Debentures

115

Note 14: Federal and State Income Taxes

117

Note 15: Employee Benefit Plans

119

Note 16: Stock-Based Compensation

120

Note 17: Regulatory Requirements and Restrictions on Dividends

123

Note 18: Earnings Per Share

125

Note 19: Commitments and Contingencies

125

Note 20: Parent Company Only Financial Statements

127

Note 21: Fair Value

130

Note 22: Business Segment Information

133

Note 23: Pending Acquisition

133

Item 9.

Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

134

Item 9A.

Controls and Procedures

134

Item 9B.

Other Information

137

Item 9C.

Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspection

137

Part III

138

Item 10.

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

138

Item 11.

Executive Compensation

138

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

138

Item 13.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

139

Item 14.

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

139

Part IV

139

Item 15.

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

139

Item 16.

Form 10-K Summary

142

Signatures

143

Appendix A. Supervision and Regulation

145

Throughout the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and remaining sections of this Form 10-K (including appendices), we use certain acronyms and abbreviations, as defined in Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

3

Table of Contents

Part I

Item 1.    Business

General. QCR Holdings, Inc. is a multi-bank holding company headquartered in Moline, Illinois, that was formed in February 1993 under the laws of the state of Delaware. In 2016, the Company elected to operate as a financial holding company under the BHCA. The Company serves the Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Waterloo/Cedar Falls, Des Moines/Ankeny and Springfield communities through the following four wholly-owned banking subsidiaries (collectively, the “Banks”), which provide full-service commercial and consumer banking and trust and asset management services:

Quad City Bank & Trust (QCBT), which is based in Bettendorf, Iowa, and commenced operations in 1994;
Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust (CRBT), which is based in Cedar Rapids, Iowa, and commenced operations in 2001;
Community State Bank (CSB), which is based in Ankeny, Iowa, and was acquired in 2016; and
Springfield First Community Bank (SFCB), which is based in Springfield, Missouri, and was acquired in 2018.

On November 9, 2021, the Company announced the signing of a definitive agreement whereby the Company will acquire Guaranty Federal Bancshares, Inc. (GFED) and merge Guaranty Bank, the banking subsidiary of GFED into SFCB.  The combined bank will operate under the Guaranty Bank name in all Springfield and southwest Missouri markets.  As of December 31, 2021, GFED had $1.2 billion in assets, $815 million in loans and $1.0 billion in deposits.

Under the terms of the merger agreement, stockholders of GFED will have the right to receive for each share of GFED common stock owned, at the election of each stockholder, and subject to proration and adjustment, (1) $30.50 in cash, (2) 0.58775 shares of the Company’s common stock, or (3) mixed consideration of $6.10 in cash and 0.4702 shares of the Company’s common stock, with total consideration to consist of approximately 80% stock and 20% cash.  Based upon the $59.99 closing price of the Company’s common stock as of November 5, 2021, the transaction is valued at approximately $151.6 million.  The transaction is subject to regulatory approvals, approval by GFED’s stockholders and certain customary closing conditions.  The transaction is expected to close late in the first quarter or early in the second quarter of 2022.

On August 12, 2020, the Company sold the Bates Companies, headquartered in Rockford, Illinois.  From October 1, 2018, through the date of the disposition, the Company provided wealth management services to the Rockford community through the Bates Companies.

On November 30, 2019, the Company sold substantially all of the assets and transferred substantially all of the deposits and certain other liabilities of the Company’s wholly owned subsidiary, RB&T.  Prior to this time, the Company provided full service banking services to the Rockford community through RB&T.

See Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion on mergers, acquisitions and sales.

The Company engages in direct financing lease contracts and equipment financing agreements through m2, a wholly owned subsidiary of QCBT based in Brookfield, Wisconsin.

Subsidiary Banks. Segments of the Company have been established by management as defined by the structure of the Company’s internal organization, focusing on the financial information that the Company’s operating decision-makers routinely use to make decisions about operating matters. The Company’s Commercial Banking business is geographically divided by markets into the operating segments corresponding to the four subsidiary banks wholly owned by the Company: QCBT, CRBT, CSB and SFCB. See the Consolidated Financial Statements incorporated herein generally, and Note 23 to the Consolidated Financial Statements specifically, for additional business segment information.

QCBT was capitalized on October 13, 1993, and commenced operations on January 7, 1994. QCBT is an Iowa-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System. QCBT provides full service commercial, correspondent, and consumer banking and trust and asset management services in the Quad Cities and adjacent communities through its five offices located in Bettendorf and Davenport, Iowa and in Moline, Illinois. QCBT, on a consolidated basis with m2, had total segment assets of $2.14 billion and $2.15 billion as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

CRBT is an Iowa-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System. The Company commenced operations in Cedar Rapids in June 2001, operating as a branch of QCBT. The Cedar Rapids branch operation then began functioning under the CRBT charter in September of 2001. Acquired branches of CNB operate as a division of CRBT under the name “Community Bank & Trust.”  CRBT provides full-service commercial and consumer banking and trust

4

Table of Contents

and asset management services to Cedar Rapids, Marion and Waterloo/Cedar Falls, Iowa and adjacent communities through its eight facilities. The headquarters for CRBT is located in downtown Cedar Rapids with three other branches located in Cedar Rapids, one branch in Marion, two branches located in Waterloo and one branch located in Cedar Falls. CRBT had total segment assets of $2.03 billion and $1.96 billion as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

CSB is an Iowa-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System. CSB was acquired by the Company in 2016. CSB provides full-service commercial and consumer banking to Des Moines, Iowa and adjacent communities through its headquarters located in Ankeny, Iowa and its eight other branch facilities throughout the greater Des Moines area. CSB had total segment assets of $1.17 billion and $1.0 billion as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

SFCB is a Missouri-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System. SFCB was acquired by the Company in 2018 through a merger with Springfield Bancshares.  SFCB provides full-service commercial and consumer banking to the Springfield, Missouri area through its headquarters located on Glenstone Avenue in Springfield and its branch facility located on East Primrose in Springfield.  SFCB had total segment assets of $882.88 million and $779.96 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

Other Operating Subsidiaries. m2, which is based in Brookfield, Wisconsin, is engaged in the business of lending and leasing machinery and equipment to C&I businesses under direct financing lease contracts and equipment financing agreements.  

Trust Preferred Subsidiaries. Following is a listing of the Company’s non-consolidated subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities, including pertinent information as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

    

Amount Outstanding

    

Amount Outstanding

    

    

Interest

Interest

as of

as of

Rate as of

Rate as of

Name

Date Issued

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

Interest Rate

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust II

 

February 2004

$

10,310

$

10,310

 

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

 

3.07

%  

3.10

%

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust III

 

February 2004

 

8,248

 

8,248

 

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

 

3.07

%  

3.10

%

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust V

 

February 2006

 

10,310

 

10,310

 

1.55% over 3-month LIBOR

 

1.67

%  

1.79

%

Community National Statutory Trust II

 

September 2004

 

3,093

 

3,093

 

2.17% over 3-month LIBOR

 

2.38

%  

2.41

%

Community National Statutory Trust III

 

March 2007

 

3,609

 

3,609

 

1.75% over 3-month LIBOR

 

1.95

%  

1.97

%

Guaranty Bankshares Statutory Trust I

 

May 2005

 

4,640

 

4,640

 

1.75% over 3-month LIBOR

 

1.95

%  

1.97

%

 

$

40,210

$

40,210

 

Weighted Average Rate

 

2.43

%  

2.48

%

 

Securities issued by all of the trusts listed above mature 30 years from the date of issuance, but are all currently callable at par at any time. Interest rate reset dates vary by trust.  

Business. The Company’s principal business consists of attracting deposits and investing those deposits in loans/leases and securities. The deposits of the subsidiary banks are insured to the maximum amount allowable by the FDIC. The Company’s results of operations are dependent primarily on net interest income, which is the difference between the interest earned on its loans/leases and securities and the interest paid on deposits and borrowings. The Company’s operating results are affected by economic and competitive conditions, particularly changes in interest rates, government policies and the actions of regulatory authorities, as described more fully in this Form 10-K, including in Appendix A “Supervision and Regulation.”  Its operating results also can be affected by trust fees, investment advisory and management fees, deposit service charge fees, swap fee income/capital markets revenue, gains on the sale of residential real estate and government guaranteed loans, earnings from BOLI and other noninterest income. Operating expenses include employee compensation and benefits, occupancy and equipment expense, professional and data processing fees, advertising and marketing expenses, bank service charges, FDIC and other insurance, loan/lease expenses and other administrative expenses.

The Company and its subsidiaries collectively employed 726 and 714 FTEs at December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. The increase in FTEs during 2021 was primarily due to the addition of new positions created to build scale.

The Federal Reserve is the primary federal regulator of the Company, QCBT, CRBT, CSB and SFCB.  QCBT, CRBT and CSB are also regulated by the Iowa Superintendent of Banking and SFCB is regulated by the Missouri Division of Finance. The FDIC, as administrator of the DIF, also has regulatory authority over the subsidiary banks. See Appendix A

5

Table of Contents

“Supervision and Regulation” for more information on the federal and state statutes and regulations that are applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries.

Lending/Leasing. The Company and its subsidiaries provide a broad range of commercial and retail lending/leasing and investment services to corporations, partnerships, individuals, and government agencies. The subsidiary banks actively market their services to qualified lending and deposit clients. Officers actively solicit the business of new clients entering their market areas as well as long-standing members of the local business community. The Company has an established lending/leasing policy which includes a number of underwriting factors to be considered in making a loan/lease, including, but not limited to, location, loan-to-value ratio, cash flow, collateral and the credit history of the borrower.

In accordance with Iowa regulation, the legal lending limit to one borrower for QCBT, CRBT and CSB, calculated as 15% of aggregate capital, was $35.9 million, $42.7 million, and $19.9 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2021. In accordance with Missouri regulation, the legal lending limit to one borrower for SFCB, calculated as 15% of aggregate capital, totaled $15.3 million as of December 31, 2021.

The Company recognizes the need to prevent excessive concentrations of credit exposure to any one borrower or group of related borrowers. As such, the Company has established an in-house lending limit, which is lower than each subsidiary bank’s legal lending limit, in an effort to manage individual borrower exposure levels.

The in-house lending limit is the maximum amount of credit each subsidiary bank will extend to a single borrowing entity or group of related entities. The Company implements a tiered approach, based on the risk rating of the borrower. Under the most recent in-house limit, total credit exposure to a single borrowing entity or group of related entities will not exceed the following, subject to certain exceptions:

High Quality

Medium Quality

Low Quality

    

(Risk Ratings 1-3)

    

(Risk Rating 4)

    

(Risk Ratings 5-8)

(dollars in thousands)

QCBT

$

20,500

$

17,000

$

12,000

CRBT

$

20,000

$

17,000

$

11,500

CSB

$

11,000

$

9,500

$

6,500

SFCB

$

10,000

$

8,000

$

6,000

QCRH Consolidated

$

30,000

$

24,000

$

15,000

The QCRH Consolidated amount represents the maximum amount of credit that all affiliated banks, when combined, will extend to a single borrowing entity or group of related entities, subject to certain exceptions.

In addition, m2’s in-house lending limit is $2.5 million to a single lending/leasing entity or group of related entities, subject to certain exceptions.

As part of the loan monitoring activity at the four subsidiary banks, credit administration personnel interact closely with senior bank management. For example, the internal loan committee of each subsidiary bank meets weekly. The Company has a separate in-house loan review function to analyze credits of the subsidiary banks.   To complement the in-house loan review, an independent third-party performs external loan reviews. Historically, management has attempted to identify problem loans at an early stage and to aggressively seek a resolution of those situations.

The Company recognizes that a diversified loan/lease portfolio contributes to reducing risk in the overall loan/lease portfolio. The specific loan/lease portfolio mix is subject to change based on loan/lease demand, the business environment and various economic factors. The Company actively monitors concentrations within the loan/lease portfolio to ensure appropriate diversification and concentration risk is maintained.

6

Table of Contents

Specifically, each subsidiary bank’s total loans as a percentage of average assets may not exceed 85%. In addition, following are established policy limits and the actual allocations for the subsidiary banks as of December 31, 2021 for the loan portfolio organized by loan type, reflected as a percentage of the subsidiary bank’s gross loans:

QCBT

CRBT

CSB

SFCB

 

Maximum

    

    

Maximum

    

    

Maximum

    

    

Maximum

    

 

Percentage

As of

Percentage

As of

Percentage

As of

Percentage

As of

 

per Loan

December 31, 

per Loan

December 31, 

per Loan

December 31, 

per Loan

December 31, 

 

Type of Loan *

Policy

2021

Policy

2021

Policy

2021

Policy

2021

 

One-to-four family residential

30

%  

12

%  

25

%  

6

%  

35

%  

9

%  

30

%  

11

%

Multi-family

15

%  

9

%  

15

%  

16

%  

15

%  

11

%  

20

%  

16

%

Farmland

5

%  

1

%  

5

%  

%  

15

%  

1

%  

5

%  

1

%

Non-farm, nonresidential

50

%  

16

%  

50

%  

24

%  

50

%  

22

%  

50

%  

32

%

Construction and land development

20

%  

18

%  

15

%  

17

%  

35

%  

28

%  

15

%  

20

%

C&I

60

%  

30

%  

60

%  

31

%  

50

%  

23

%  

20

%  

16

%

Loans to individuals

10

%  

1

%  

10

%  

%  

10

%  

%  

5

%  

1

%

Lease financing

30

%  

3

%  

5

%  

%  

5

%  

%  

5

%  

%

Bank stock loans

**

 

 

10

%  

%  

%

%  

20

%  

%

All other loans

15

%  

10

%  

10

%  

6

%  

15

%  

6

%  

15

%  

3

%

  

 

100

%  

  

 

100

%  

  

 

100

%  

  

 

100

%

*   The loan types above are as defined and reported in the subsidiary banks’ quarterly Reports of Condition and Income (also known as Call Reports).

** QCBT’s maximum percentage for bank stock loans is 150% of risk-based capital (bank stock loan commitments are limited to 200% of risk-based capital). At December 31, 2021, QCBT’s bank stock loans totaled 32% of risk-based capital.

*** Policy limits are compared to average loan balances rather than the current balance for monitoring purposes.

The following table presents total loans/leases by major loan/lease type and subsidiary as of December 31, 2021 and 2020. Residential real estate loans held for sale are included in residential real estate loans below. Loan segmentation under ASU 2016-13 follows different methodology where that segmentation is collateral driven, causing certain segments to contain commercial and non-commercial borrowers, whereas pre-ASU 2016-13 segments were borrower driven. Class of receivable and segment detail post-ASU 2016-03 do not break out CRE loans separately.

Consolidated

 

QCBT

CRBT

CSB

SFCB

Total

 

    

$

    

%

    

$

    

%

    

$

    

%

    

$

    

%

    

$

%

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

As of December 31, 2021

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C & I - Revolving Lines of Credit

$

69,179

 

4

%  

$

92,757

 

7

%  

$

56,072

 

7

%  

$

30,475

 

4

%  

$

248,483

 

5

%

C & I - Other

 

602,451

 

37

%  

 

437,200

 

30

%  

 

194,357

 

22

%  

 

112,594

 

16

%  

 

1,346,602

 

29

%

CRE - Owner Occupied

114,927

7

%  

145,895

10

%  

75,322

9

%  

85,557

12

%  

421,701

 

9

%

CRE - Non Owner Occupied

171,444

9

%  

202,051

14

%  

122,690

14

%  

150,315

21

%  

646,500

 

14

%

Construction & Land Development

291,000

18

%  

240,790

17

%  

243,126

28

%  

143,655

20

%  

918,571

 

19

%

Multi-Family

153,977

9

%  

228,083

16

%  

100,186

12

%  

118,166

16

%  

600,412

 

13

%

Direct financing leases

 

45,191

 

3

%  

 

 

%  

 

 

%  

 

 

%  

 

45,191

 

1

%

1-4 Family

 

177,227

 

11

%  

 

73,821

 

5

%  

 

64,767

 

7

%  

 

61,546

 

8

%  

 

377,361

 

8

%

Consumer

 

24,837

 

2

%  

 

17,211

 

1

%  

 

10,432

 

1

%  

 

22,831

 

3

%  

 

75,311

 

2

%

$

1,650,233

 

100

%  

$

1,437,808

 

100

%  

$

866,952

 

100

%  

$

725,139

%  

100

%  

$

4,680,132

 

100

%

As of December 31, 2020

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C&I loans

$

732,363

 

46

%  

$

601,387

 

44

%  

$

230,835

 

33

%  

$

162,138

 

26

%  

$

1,726,723

 

40

%

CRE loans

 

588,167

 

38

%  

 

690,539

 

51

%  

 

423,029

 

59

%  

 

405,894

 

65

%  

 

2,107,629

 

50

%

Direct financing leases

 

66,016

 

4

%  

 

 

%  

 

 

%  

 

 

%  

 

66,016

 

2

%

Residential real estate loans

 

134,712

 

9

%  

 

45,493

 

3

%  

 

41,673

 

6

%  

 

30,243

 

5

%  

 

252,121

 

6

%

Installment and other consumer loans

 

26,916

 

2

%  

 

25,986

 

2

%  

 

12,376

 

2

%  

 

26,024

 

4

%  

 

91,302

 

2

%

Deferred loan/lease origination costs, net of fees

 

8,588

 

1

%  

 

(1,349)

 

%  

 

(231)

 

%  

 

330

 

%  

 

7,338

 

%  

$

1,556,762

 

100

%  

$

1,362,056

 

100

%  

$

707,682

 

100

%  

$

624,629

 

100

%  

$

4,251,129

 

100

%

Proper pricing of loans is necessary to provide adequate return to the Company’s stockholders. Loan pricing, as established with guidance from the subsidiary banks’ senior management and asset/liability management committees, includes consideration for the cost of funds, loan maturity and risk, origination and maintenance costs, appropriate stockholder return, competitive factors, and the economic environment. The portfolio contains a mix of loans with fixed and floating interest rates. Management attempts to maximize the use of interest rate floors on its variable rate loan portfolio. Refer to “Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk” for more discussion on the Company’s management of interest rate risk.

In an effort to manage interest rate risk, the subsidiary banks will consider entering into back-to-back interest rate swaps with select commercial borrowers. The interest rate swaps allow the commercial borrowers to pay a fixed interest rate while the banks receive a variable interest rate as well as an upfront nonrefundable fee dependent on the pricing. The banks enter an interest rate swap with the commercial borrower and an equal and offsetting interest rate swap with a larger financial institution counterparty. The Company has increased its focus on this business which has led to significantly increased noninterest income, stronger overall loan growth, and improved management of its interest rate risk.  The Company will continue to review opportunities to execute these swaps at all of its subsidiary banks, as the circumstances are appropriate for the borrower and the Company.  An optimal interest rate swap candidate must be of a certain size and sophistication which can lead to volatility in activity from year to year.  Future levels of swap fee income can be somewhat dependent upon prevailing interest rates and other market activity.

7

Table of Contents

C&I Lending

As noted above, the subsidiary banks are active C&I lenders. The current areas of emphasis include loans to small and mid-sized businesses with a wide range of operations such as wholesalers, manufacturers, building contractors, business services companies, other banks, and retailers. The subsidiary banks provide a wide range of business loans, including lines of credit for working capital and operational purposes, and term loans for the acquisition of facilities, equipment and other purposes. Since 2010, the subsidiary banks have been active in participating in lending programs offered by the SBA and USDA. Under these programs, the government entities will generally provide a guarantee of repayment ranging from 50% to 85% of the principal amount of the qualifying loan.

Loan approval is generally based on the following factors:

Ability and stability of current management of the borrower;
Stable earnings with positive financial trends;
Sufficient cash flow to support debt repayment;
Earnings projections based on reasonable assumptions;
Financial strength of the industry and business; and
Value and marketability of collateral.

For C&I loans, the Company assigns internal risk ratings which are largely dependent upon the aforementioned approval factors. The risk rating is reviewed annually or on an as needed basis depending on the specific circumstances of the loan. See Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information, including the internal risk rating scale.

As part of the underwriting process, management reviews current borrower financial statements. When appropriate, certain C&I loans may contain covenants requiring maintenance of financial performance ratios such as, but not limited to:

Minimum debt service coverage ratio;
Minimum current ratio;
Maximum debt to tangible net worth ratio; and/or
Minimum tangible net worth.

Establishment of these financial performance ratios depends on a number of factors, including risk rating and the specific industry in which the borrower is engaged.

Collateral for these loans generally includes accounts receivable, inventory and equipment.  The Company’s lending policy specifies approved collateral types and corresponding maximum advance percentages. The value of collateral pledged on loans must exceed the loan amount by a margin sufficient to absorb potential erosion of its value in the event of foreclosure and cover the loan amount plus costs incurred to convert it to cash. Approved non-real estate collateral types and corresponding maximum advance percentages for each collateral type are listed below.

8

Table of Contents

Approved Collateral Type

    

Maximum Advance %

Financial Instruments

 

  

U.S. Government Securities

 

90% of market value

Securities of Federal Agencies

 

90% of market value

Municipal Bonds rated by Moody’s As “A” or better

 

80% of market value

Listed Stocks

 

75% of market value

Mutual Funds

 

75% of market value

Cash Value Life Insurance

 

95%, less policy loans

Savings/Time Deposits (Bank)

 

100% of current value

Penny Stocks

 

0%

General Business

 

  

Accounts Receivable

 

80% of eligible accounts

Inventory

 

50% of value

Crop and Grain Inventories

 

80% of current market value

Livestock

 

80% of purchase price, or current market value; or higher if cross-collateralized with other assets

Fixed Assets (Existing)

 

50% of net book value, or 75% of orderly liquidation appraised value

Fixed Assets (New)

 

80% of cost, or higher if cross-collateralized with other assets

Leasehold Improvements

 

0%

Generally, if the above collateral is part of a cross-collateralization with other approved assets, then the maximum advance percentage may be higher.

The Company’s lending policy specifies maximum term limits for C&I loans. For term loans, the maximum term is generally seven years. Generally, term loans range from three to five years. For lines of credit, the maximum term is typically 365 days.

In addition, the subsidiary banks often take personal guarantees or cosigners to help assure repayment. Loans may be made on an unsecured basis if warranted by the overall financial condition of the borrower.

Following is a summary of the five largest industry concentrations within the C&I portfolio as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

2021

    

2020

Amount

Amount

(dollars in thousands)

Lessors of Residential Buildings and Dwellings

$

387,818

$

346,177

Administration of Urban Planning and Rural Development

120,416

138,514

Bank Holding Companies

 

65,080

 

80,383

Lessors of Nonresidential Buildings

28,821

16,408

Industrial Machinery and Equipment Merchant Wholesalers

 

28,123

 

14,533

These loan categories are defined by industry-standard NAICS codes – refer to NAICS.com for a description of each category.

CRE Lending

The subsidiary banks also make CRE loans. CRE loans are subject to underwriting standards and processes similar to C&I loans, in addition to those standards and processes specific to real estate loans. Collateral for these loans generally includes the underlying real estate and improvements, and may include additional assets of the borrower. The Company’s lending policy specifies maximum loan-to-value limits based on the category of CRE (commercial real estate loans on improved property, raw land, land development, and commercial construction). These limits are the same limits as, or in some

9

Table of Contents

situations, more conservative than, those established by regulatory authorities. Following is a listing of these limits as well as some of the other guidelines included in the Company’s lending policy for the major categories of CRE loans:

    

    

Maximum

CRE Loan Types

Maximum Advance Rate **

Term

CRE Loans on Improved Property *

 

80%

 

7 years***

Raw Land

 

Lesser of 90% of project cost, or 65% of "as is" appraised value

 

12 months

Land Development

 

Lesser of 85% of project cost, or 75% of "as-completed" appraised value

 

24 months

Commercial Construction Loans

 

Lesser of 85% of project cost, or 80% of "as-completed" appraised value

 

24 months

Residential Construction Loans to Builders****

 

Lesser of 90% of project cost, or 80% of "as-completed" appraised value

 

15 months

LIHTC construction Loans

80%

3 years

LIHTC permanent Loans

 

80%

 

20
ears

*       Generally, the debt service coverage ratio must be a minimum of 1.25x for non-owner occupied loans and 1.15x for owner-occupied loans that are subject to a DSCR covenant. For loans greater than $500 thousand, the subsidiary banks sensitize this ratio for deteriorated economic conditions, major changes in interest rates, and/or significant increases in vacancy rates.

**     These maximum rates are consistent with, or in some situations, more conservative than those established by regulatory authorities.

***   Some real estate transactions may offer a swap option whereby the maximum term is 20 years.

**** Generally, the maximum term is 12 months but can be 15 months with credit risk committee monthly review.

The Company’s lending policy also includes guidelines for real estate appraisals and evaluations, including minimum appraisal and evaluation standards based on certain transactions. In addition, the subsidiary banks often take personal guarantees to help assure repayment.

In addition, management tracks the level of owner-occupied CRE loans versus non-owner occupied CRE loans. Owner-occupied CRE loans are generally considered to have less risk. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, approximately 16% and 24%, respectively, of the CRE loan portfolio was owner-occupied.

In accordance with regulatory guidelines, the Company exercises heightened risk management practices when non-owner occupied CRE lending exceeds 300% of total risk-based capital and outstanding balances have increased 50% or more during the prior 36 months or construction, land development and other land loans exceed 100% of total risk-based capital.

In addition, the banks have established policy limits around non-owner occupied CRE and total construction, land development and other land loans.

    

    

Non-owner CRE Loans/TRBC

Total Construction, Land Development and Other Land Loans/TRBC

QCBT

 

300%

 

100%

CRBT

 

400%

 

100%

CSB

 

400%

 

150%

SFC

 

450%

 

100%

Although CSB’s loan portfolio has historically been real estate dominated and its total construction, land development and other land loans levels exceed these policy limits, it has established a Credit Risk Committee to routinely monitor its real estate loan portfolio.

10

Table of Contents

Following is a listing of the significant industries within the Company’s CRE loan portfolio as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

 

2021

2020

Amount

    

%

    

Amount

    

%

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

Lessors of Residential Buildings

$

1,316,851

 

49

%  

$

786,066

 

37

%

Lessors of Nonresidential Buildings

557,859

 

21

%  

567,759

 

27

%

Hotels

 

73,639

 

3

%  

 

72,718

 

4

%

New Housing For-Sale Builders

61,028

2

%

46,764

2

%

Lessors of Other Real Estate Property

 

60,605

 

2

%  

 

45,619

 

2

%

Other Activities Related to Real Estate

42,507

2

%

41,197

2

%

Other *

 

568,784

 

21

%  

 

547,506

 

26

%

Total CRE Loans

$

2,681,273

100

%

$

2,107,629

100

%

*   “Other” consists of all other industries. None of these had concentrations greater than $40.9 million, or 1.5%, of total CRE loans as of December 31, 2021.

Following is a breakdown of non owner-occupied income-producing CRE by property type as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

2021

2020

    

Amount

    

%

    

Amount

    

%

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

Multi-family

$

1,231,937

 

58

%  

$

599,774

 

38

%

Office

 

175,890

 

8

%  

 

174,578

 

11

%

Retail

 

147,327

 

7

%  

 

156,589

 

10

%

Industrial/warehouse

 

104,035

 

5

%  

 

82,568

 

5

%

Hotel/motel

 

77,758

 

4

%  

 

77,165

 

5

%

Other

 

373,872

 

18

%  

 

480,292

 

31

%

Total income-producing CRE

$

2,110,819

 

100

%  

$

1,570,966

 

100

%

Included in Multi-family is $445.6 million of LIHTC permanent loans which are permanent financing for low-income housing tax credit real estate projects.  These loans have a maximum term of 20 years.  Considering the longer duration, the subsidiary banks often enter into a back-to-back interest rate swap to provide the borrower a long-term fixed interest rate while the subsidiary banks receive a variable interest rate and an upfront nonrefundable fee dependent on market pricing.  In addition, the financing structure of the LIHTC permanent loans includes tax credit equity investment that strengthens the overall credit profile.  Including the value of the real estate and the LIHTCs, the loan-to-values of the LIHTC permanent loans are typically in the range of 25% to 65%.  Lastly, the Company has policy limits on maximum exposure amounts to single developers. 

11

Table of Contents

A portion of the Company’s construction portfolio is considered non-residential construction. Following is a summary of industry concentrations within that category as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

2021

2020

    

Amount

    

%

    

Amount

    

%

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

Multi-family

$

627,101

 

77

%  

$

281,986

 

57

%

Industrial/warehouse

 

28,191

 

4

%  

 

10,884

 

2

%

Office

 

23,714

 

3

%  

 

17,126

 

3

%

Retail

 

11,798

 

1

%  

 

8,665

 

2

%

Hotel/motel

 

6,804

 

1

%  

 

5,715

 

1

%

Other

 

113,786

 

14

%  

 

170,153

 

35

%

Total non-residential construction loans

$

811,394

 

100

%  

$

494,529

 

100

%

Included in Multi-family is $587.2 million of LIHTC construction loans which provide financing for the construction of both new LIHTC real estate projects and the rehabilitation of existing LIHTC real estate projects.  Many of these will convert to LIHTC permanent loans upon completion of construction. 

Additionally, the Company had approximately $78.0 million and $48.8 million of residential construction loans outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. Of this amount, approximately 52% was considered speculative, while 48% was pre-sold at December 31, 2021, and approximately 54% was considered speculative, while 46% was pre-sold at December 31, 2020.

Direct Financing Leasing

m2 leases machinery and equipment to C&I customers under direct financing leases. All lease requests are subject to the credit requirements and criteria as set forth in the lending/leasing policy. In all cases, a formal independent credit analysis of the lessee is performed.

The following private and public sector business assets are generally acceptable to consider for lease funding:

Computer systems;
Photocopy systems;
Fire trucks;
Specialized road maintenance equipment;
Medical equipment;
Commercial business furnishings;
Vehicles classified as heavy equipment;
Trucks and trailers;
Equipment classified as plant or office equipment; and
Marine boat lifts.

m2 will generally refrain from funding leases of the following type:

Leases collateralized by non-marketable items;
Leases collateralized by consumer items, such as vehicles, household goods, recreational vehicles, boats, etc.;
Leases collateralized by used equipment, unless its remaining useful life can be readily determined; and
Leases with a repayment schedule exceeding seven years.

Residential Real Estate Lending

Generally, the subsidiary banks residential real estate loans conform to the underwriting requirements of Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae to allow the subsidiary banks to resell loans in the secondary market. The subsidiary banks structure most loans that will not conform to those underwriting requirements as adjustable rate mortgages that adjust in one to five years,

12

Table of Contents

and then retain these loans in their portfolios. Servicing rights are generally not retained on the loans sold in the secondary market. The Company’s lending policy establishes minimum appraisal and other credit guidelines.

The following table presents the originations and sales of residential real estate loans for the Company. Included in originations is activity related to the refinancing of previously held in-house mortgages.

For the year ended December 31, 

2021

2020

2019

(dollars in thousands)

 

Originations of residential real estate loans

$

249,892

$

281,662

$

183,491

Sales of residential real estate loans

$

201,638

$

234,512

$

141,195

Percentage of sales to originations

 

81

%  

 

83

%  

 

77

%

Installment and Other Consumer Lending

The consumer lending department of each subsidiary bank provides many types of consumer loans, including home improvement, home equity, motor vehicle, signature loans and small personal credit lines. The Company’s lending policy addresses specific credit guidelines by consumer loan type. In particular, for home equity loans and home equity lines of credit, the minimum credit bureau score is 650. For both home equity loans and lines of credit, the maximum advance rate is 90% of value for primary residences and 80% for second/vacation homes. The maximum term on home equity loans is 10 years and maximum amortization is 15 years. The maximum term on home equity lines of credit is 10 years.

In some instances for all loans/leases, it may be appropriate to originate or purchase loans/leases that are exceptions to the guidelines and limits established within the Company’s lending policy described above. In general, exceptions to the lending policy do not significantly deviate from the guidelines and limits established within the lending policy and, if there are exceptions, they are generally noted as such and specifically identified in loan/lease approval documents.

Human Capital Resources. As of December 31, 2021, the Company employed 693 full-time employees and 63 part-time employees across all locations.  The employees are not represented by a collective bargaining unit. The Company is a relationship driven company and its ability to attract and retain exceptional employees is key to its success.  

The Company encourages and supports the growth and development of its employees and, wherever possible, seeks to fill positions by promotion and transfer from within the organization. Continual learning and career development is advanced through ongoing performance and development conversations with employees, internally developed training programs and external training opportunities. Educational reimbursement is available to employees enrolled in degree or certification programs and for seminars, conferences, and other training events employees attend in connection with their job duties.

As part of its compensation philosophy, the Company believes that it must offer and maintain market competitive total rewards programs for its employees in order to attract and retain exceptional talent. In addition to competitive base wages, additional programs include annual bonus opportunities, an employee stock purchase plan, Company matched 401(k) Plan, healthcare and insurance benefits, health savings and flexible spending accounts, paid time off, family leave, sabbaticals, flexible work schedules, an employee assistance program, and various wellness programs.

The Company is committed to fostering and preserving a culture of diversity, equity, and inclusion, and believes its differences, of every kind, make the company and its communities better.  During recent years, the Company focused on  several initiatives to promote diversity, equity, and inclusion across its organization.  A few specific actions included hiring a Diversity Officer, rolling out a diversity survey for the second year to gather feedback from all employees, and several diversity and inclusion sessions and workshops across our different entities.

 

The safety, health and wellness of the Company’s employees is a top priority. The COVID-19 pandemic continues to present a unique challenge with regard to maintaining employee safety while continuing successful operations.  The Company offers remote working alternatives and enforces safety measures for all employees working in locations across the Company.  All employees are encouraged to get vaccinated and are asked not to come in to the office to work when they are experiencing symptoms of COVID-19 or other communicable illnesses.  The Company provided frequent communication using a variety of methods to ensure that all employees were kept informed regarding the ongoing pandemic.

13

Table of Contents

The Company strives to maintain a culture in which employees feel valued and, to that end, regularly solicits feedback from employees to understand their views about their work environment and the Company’s culture. The results from employee engagement surveys are used to implement programs and processes designed to enhance engagement and improve the employee experience. In 2021, 88% of employees participated in the annual employee engagement survey, exceeding the Company goal of 80%, and the Company received a strong employee engagement score of 81%, above the national benchmark of 74%.

The regions in which the subsidiary banks operate primarily – the Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Marion, Waterloo/Cedar Falls, Des Moines, Iowa and Springfield, Missouri – generally have strong labor markets, with unemployment rates of 3.7% and 3.3% in Iowa and Missouri, respectively.

ESG Commitment. The Company is built on relationships and integrity.  We adhere to those principles in all areas of our business and in our communities and believe that meaningful environmental, social and governance programs will drive shareholder value and make us a better company.  With numerous programs and activities aligned with the ESG framework, we continue to develop and enhance our long-term plan for the future.  We are advancing standard reporting processes and gathering benchmarking data to generate meaningful ESG goals for our company.

Competition. The Company currently operates in the highly competitive Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Marion, Waterloo/Cedar Falls, Des Moines, Iowa and Springfield, Missouri markets. Competitors include not only other commercial banks, credit unions, thrift institutions, and mutual funds, but also insurance companies, FinTech companies, finance companies, brokerage firms, investment banking companies, and a variety of other financial services and advisory companies. Many of these competitors are not subject to the same regulatory restrictions as the Company. Many of these competitors compete across geographic boundaries and provide customers increasing access to meaningful alternatives to traditional banking services. The Company also competes in markets with a number of much larger financial institutions with substantially greater resources and larger lending limits.

Appendices. The commercial banking business is a highly regulated business. See Appendix A “Supervision and Regulation” for a discussion of the federal and state statutes and regulations that are applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries.

Internet Site, Securities Filings and Governance Documents. The Company maintains an Internet site at www.qcrh.com. The Company makes available free of charge through this site its Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K, and other reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as soon as reasonably practicable after it electronically files such material with, or furnishes it to, the SEC. These filings are available at http://www.snl.com/IRW/Docs/1024092. Also available are many of the Company’s corporate governance documents, including its Business Code of Conduct and Ethics Policy (https://qcrh.q4ir.com/governance/documents/default.aspx).

Item 1A.    Risk Factors

In addition to the other information in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, stockholders or prospective investors should carefully consider the following risk factors:

Economic and Market Risks

Conditions in the financial market and economic conditions, including conditions in the markets in which we operate, generally may adversely affect our business.

We operate primarily in the Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Waterloo/Cedar Falls, Des Moines/Ankeny, Iowa and Springfield, Missouri markets.  Our general financial performance is highly dependent upon the business environment in the markets where we operate and in particular, the ability of borrowers to pay interest on and repay principal of outstanding loans and the value of collateral securing those loans, as well as demand for loans and other products and services it offers. A favorable business environment is generally characterized by, among other factors, economic growth, efficient capital markets, low inflation, low unemployment, high business and investor confidence, and strong business earnings. Unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by declines in economic growth, business activity or investor or business confidence; limitations on the availability or increases in the cost of credit and capital; increases in inflation or interest rates; high unemployment, natural disasters, pandemics or a combination of these or other factors.

14

Table of Contents

Uncertainty regarding economic conditions may result in changes in consumer and business spending, borrowing and savings habits. Downturns in the markets where our banking operations occur could result in a decrease in demand for our products and services, an increase in loan delinquencies and defaults, high or increased levels of problem assets and foreclosures and reduced wealth management fees resulting from lower asset values. Such conditions could adversely affect the credit quality of our loans, financial condition and results of operations.

Interest rates and other conditions impact our results of operations.

Our profitability is in large part a function of the spread between the interest rates earned on investments and loans/leases and the interest rates paid on deposits and other interest bearing liabilities. Like most banking institutions, our net interest spread and margin will be affected by general economic conditions and other factors, including fiscal and monetary policies of the federal government that influence market interest rates and our ability to respond to changes in such rates. At any given time, our assets and liabilities will be such that they are affected differently by a given change in interest rates. As a result, an increase or decrease in rates, the length of loan/lease terms, and the mix of adjustable and fixed rate loans/leases in our portfolio, the length of time deposits and borrowings and the rate sensitivity of our deposit customers could have a positive or negative effect on our net income, capital and liquidity. In addition, the size of nonrefundable swap fees earned in connection with our LIHTC permanent loans may fluctuate depending on the interest rate environment. We measure interest rate risk under various rate scenarios using specific criteria and assumptions. A summary of this process, along with the results of our net interest income simulations is presented at "Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk" included under Item 7A of Part II of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Although we believe our current level of interest rate sensitivity is reasonable and effectively managed, significant fluctuations in interest rates may have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition to being affected by general economic conditions, our earnings and growth are affected by the policies of the Federal Reserve. An important function of the Federal Reserve is to regulate the money supply and credit conditions. Among the instruments used by the Federal Reserve to implement these objectives are open market operations in U.S. government securities, adjustments of the discount rate and changes in reserve requirements against bank deposits. These instruments are used in varying combinations to influence overall economic growth and the distribution of credit, bank loans, investments and deposits. Their use also affects interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

In March 2020, the Federal Reserve reduced the target federal funds rate and announced a $700 billion quantitative easing program in response to the expected economic downturn caused by the COVID-19 pandemic and reduced the interest it pays on excess reserves. The prolong reduction in interest rates is likely to continue to have an adverse effect our net interest income and margins and our profitability. There is potential that reduced rates could pose additional risks to the economy primarily through higher inflation and financial-stability concerns driven by low borrowing costs. There is also a possibility that labor markets could tighten causing inflationary pressures to build faster than the expected gradual pace. Persistently low interest rates could lead consumers and firms to take on riskier financial investments in search of better returns, increasing asset prices to unsustainable levels. The potential rise in asset prices to unsustainable levels could pose potential financial-stability risks in the commercial real estate and corporate borrowing sectors. Sustained low interest rate periods were something that preceded the 1990 and 2007 recessions, placing significant pressure on real estate asset prices through reach-for-yield investor behavior.

The Federal Reserve has signaled that it will begin to increase rates, taper its quantitative easing program, and reduce its balance sheet of bonds and other assets in 2022, but will do so with the goal of avoiding abrupt or unpredictable changes in economic or financial conditions so as not to disrupt the financial systems, also known as “shocks;” despite this, the impact of these changes cannot be certain.  Vulnerabilities in the financial system can amplify the impact of an initial shock following rate increases, potentially leading to unintended volatility, as well to disruptions in the provision of financial services, such as clearing payments, the provision of liquidity, and the availability of credit.  Furthermore, asset liquidation pressures can be amplified by liquidity mismatches and the leverage of certain nonbank financial intermediaries such as hedge funds.  The financial downturn in March 2020 also demonstrated that pressures on dealer intermediation can limit the availability of liquidity during times of market stress.  Given the interconnectedness of the global financial system, these vulnerabilities could impact the Company’s business operations and financial condition.

15

Table of Contents

Declines in asset values may result in impairment charges and adversely affect the value of our investments, financial performance and capital.

The market value of investments in our securities portfolio has become increasingly volatile in recent years, and as of December 31, 2021, we had gross unrealized losses of $1.3 million, or 0.2% of amortized cost, in our investment portfolio (offset by gross unrealized gains of $58.9 million). The market value of investments may be affected by factors other than the underlying performance of the servicer of the securities or the mortgages underlying the securities, such as ratings downgrades, adverse changes in the business climate and a lack of liquidity in the secondary market for certain investment securities. On a quarterly basis, we formally evaluate investments and other assets for impairment indicators. Reduction in the value, or impairment of our investment securities, can impact our earnings and common stockholders' equity. We maintained a balance of $810.2 million, or 13% of our assets, in investment securities at December 31, 2021. Changes in market interest rates can affect the value of these investment securities, with increasing interest rates generally resulting in a reduction of value. Although the reduction in value from temporary increases in market rates does not affect our income until the security is sold, it does result in an unrealized loss recorded in other comprehensive income that can reduce our common stockholders’ equity. Further, we may have to record provision expense to establish an allowance for credit losses on our carried at fair value debt securities, and we must periodically test our investment securities for other-than-temporary impairment in value. In assessing whether the value of investment securities is impaired, we consider the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than cost, the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, and the intent and ability to retain our investment in the security for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value in the near term. Based on management's evaluation, it was determined that the gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2021 were primarily a function of the changes in certain market interest rates.

The stock market can be volatile, and fluctuations in our operating results and other factors could cause our stock price to decline.

The stock market has experienced, and may continue to experience, fluctuations that significantly impact the market prices of securities issued by many companies. Market fluctuations could also adversely affect our stock price. These fluctuations have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of particular companies. These broad market fluctuations, as well as general economic, systemic, political and market conditions, such as recessions, loss of investor confidence, interest rate changes, or international currency fluctuations, may negatively affect the market price of our common stock. Moreover, our operating results may fluctuate and vary from period to period due to the risk factors set forth herein. As a result, period-to-period comparisons should not be relied upon as an indication of future performance. Our stock price could fluctuate significantly in response to our quarterly or annual results and the impact of these risk factors on our operating results or financial position.

Secondary mortgage, government guaranteed loan and interest rate swap market conditions could have a material impact on our financial condition and results of operations.

Currently, we sell a portion of the residential real estate and government guaranteed loans we originate. The profitability of these operations depends in large part upon our ability to make loans and to sell them in the secondary market at a gain. Thus, we are dependent upon the existence of an active secondary market and our ability to profitably sell loans into that market.

In addition to being affected by interest rates, the secondary markets are also subject to investor demand for residential mortgages and government guaranteed loans and investor yield requirements for those loans. These conditions may fluctuate or even worsen in the future. As a result, a prolonged period of secondary market illiquidity may reduce our loan production volumes and could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

The interest rate swap market is dependent upon market conditions. If interest rates move, interest rate swap transactions may no longer make sense for the Company and/or its customers. Interest rate swaps are generally appropriate for commercial customers with a certain level of expertise and comfort with derivatives, so our success is dependent upon the ability to make loans to these types of commercial customers. Additionally, our ability to execute interest rate swaps is also dependent upon counterparties that are willing to enter into the interest rate swap that is equal and offsetting to the interest rate swap we enter into with the commercial customer.  The mix of loans with interest rate swaps are heavily weighted towards LIHTC permanent loans.  Future levels of swap fee income are dependent upon the needs of our traditional commercial and LIHTC borrowers, and the size of the related nonrefundable swap fee may fluctuate on the interest rate environment.

16

Table of Contents

The COVID-19 pandemic continues to create disruptions that affect our business, financial condition, liquidity, and results of operations.

The extent to which COVID-19 will continue to affect business operations, financial condition, credit quality, and results of operations will depend on future developments that cannot be predicted, including the duration and scope of the pandemic.  The direct or indirect impact on employees, customers, counterparties, and service providers, as well as other market participants, is likely to continue through 2022 as the world attempts to gain control over the virus and emerging variants. The impact that the virus continues to have on global markets, the economy, business restrictions, and employment is ongoing as a projected return to pre-pandemic operating conditions is unknown.

In the past year, the United States economy began to rebound from severe disruptions caused by the onset of the pandemic in March 2020.  Economic conditions have begun to normalize with the availability of vaccines and treatments, increasing workforce employment and participation, the lessening of business and education restrictions, and demand for services beginning to return.  The financial conditions of households and businesses was bolstered significantly by government stimulus, which contributed to the economic recovery but also brought about growing pains as evidenced by supply chain problems and rising prices.  Although current economic conditions are more favorable than the prior year, the outlook for continued growth is characterized by elevated uncertainty with potential for unevenness across markets and sectors.  Although household and business credit and liquidity is strong currently, further pandemic-related disruptions could result in increased risk of delinquencies, defaults, foreclosures, and losses on our loans; declines in assets under management, affecting wealth management revenues; negative impacts on regional economic conditions resulting in declines in local loan demand, liquidity of loan guarantors, loan collateral (particularly in real estate), loan originations, and deposit availability; and impacts on the implementation of our growth strategy.  While the recovery this past year has been strong, the pace of growth in the United States and globally could decline as a result of rising inflation, the pervasiveness of supply chain challenges across industries, and the persistence of the virus in variant forms.

Overall, we believe that the economic impact from COVID-19 will continue for some time and could have a material and adverse impact on our business and result in significant losses in our loan portfolio, all of which would adversely and materially impact our earnings and capital.  Even after the COVID-19 pandemic has subsided, we may continue to experience materially adverse impacts to our business as a result of the global economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, including the availability of credit, adverse impacts on liquidity, and any recession that has occurred or may occur in the future.  There are no comparable recent events that provide guidance as to the effect the spread of COVID-19 as a global pandemic may have, nor are there historical indicators to rely on in terms of how markets will react, and as a result, the ultimate impact of the pandemic is highly uncertain and subject to change.

Continued elevated levels of inflation could adversely impact our business and results of operations.

The United States has recently experienced elevated levels of inflation, with the consumer price index climbing approximately 7.0% in 2021.  Continued levels of inflation could have complex effects on our business and results of operations, some of which could be materially adverse.  For example, if interest rates were to rise in response to, or as a result of, elevated levels of inflation, the value of our securities portfolio would be negatively impacted.  In addition, while we generally expect any inflation-related increases in our interest expense to be offset by increases in our interest revenue, inflation-driven increases in our levels of non-interest expense could negatively impact our results of operations.  Continued elevated levels of inflation could also cause increased volatility and uncertainty in the business environment, which could adversely affect loan demand and our clients’ ability to repay indebtedness. It is also possible that governmental responses to the current inflation environment could adversely affect our business, such as changes to monetary and fiscal policy that are too strict, or the imposition or threatened imposition of price controls. The duration and severity of the current inflationary period cannot be estimated with precision.

Labor shortages and failure to attract and retain qualified employees could negatively impact our business, results of operations and financial condition.

A number of factors may adversely affect the labor force available to us or increase labor costs, including high employment levels, decreased labor force size and participation rates as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic, expanded unemployment benefits offered in response to the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic, and other government actions. Although we have not experienced any material labor shortage to date, we have recently observed an overall tightening and increasingly competitive local labor market. A sustained labor shortage or increased turnover rates within our employee base could lead to increased costs, such as increased compensation expense to attract and retain employees.

17

Table of Contents

In addition, if we are unable to hire and retain employees capable of performing at a high-level, or if mitigation measures we may take to respond to a decrease in labor availability have unintended negative effects, our business could be adversely affected. An overall labor shortage, lack of skilled labor, increased turnover or labor inflation, caused by COVID-19 or as a result of general macroeconomic factors, could have a material adverse impact on our operations, results of operations, liquidity or cash flows.

Regulatory and Legal Risks

We may be materially and adversely affected by the highly regulated environment in which we operate.

The Company and its bank subsidiaries are subject to extensive federal and state regulation, supervision and examination. Banking regulations are primarily intended to protect depositors' funds, FDIC funds, customers and the banking system as a whole, rather than stockholders. These regulations affect our lending practices, capital structure, investment practices, dividend policy and growth, among other things.

As a bank holding company, we are subject to regulation and supervision primarily by the Federal Reserve. QCBT, CRBT and CSB, as Iowa-chartered state member banks, are subject to regulation and supervision primarily by both the Iowa Superintendent and the Federal Reserve. SFCB, as a Missouri-chartered commercial bank, is subject to regulation by both the Missouri Division of Finance and the Federal Reserve. We and our banks undergo periodic examinations by these regulators, who have extensive discretion and authority to prevent or remedy unsafe or unsound practices or violations of law by banks and bank holding companies.  The primary federal and state banking laws and regulations that affect us are described in Appendix A “Supervision and Regulation” to this report. These laws, regulations, rules, standards, policies and interpretations are constantly evolving and may change significantly over time.

U.S. financial institutions are also subject to numerous monitoring, recordkeeping, and reporting requirements designed to detect and prevent illegal activities such as money laundering and terrorist financing. These requirements are imposed primarily through the Bank Secrecy Act which was most recently amended by the USA Patriot Act. We have instituted policies and procedures to protect us and our employees, to the extent reasonably possible, from being used to facilitate money laundering, terrorist financing and other financial crimes. There can be no guarantee, however, that these policies and procedures are effective.

Failure to comply with applicable laws, regulations or policies could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, civil monetary penalties, and/or damage to our reputation, which could have a material adverse effect on us. Although we have policies and procedures designed to mitigate the risk of any such violations, there can be no assurance that such violations will not occur.

Future legislation, regulation, and government policy could affect the banking industry as a whole, including our business and results of operations, in ways that are difficult to predict. In addition, our results of operations also could be adversely affected by changes in the way in which existing statutes and regulations are interpreted or applied by courts and government agencies.

We are required to maintain capital to meet regulatory requirements, and if we fail to maintain sufficient capital, whether due to losses, an inability to raise additional capital or otherwise, our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, as well as our ability to maintain regulatory compliance, would be adversely affected.

The Company and each of its banking subsidiaries are required by federal and state regulatory authorities to maintain adequate levels of capital to support their operations, which have recently increased due to the effectiveness of the Basel III regulatory capital reforms. We intend to grow our business organically and to explore opportunities to grow our business by taking advantage of attractive acquisition opportunities, and such growth plans may require us to raise additional capital to ensure that we have adequate levels of capital to support such growth on top of our current operations. Our ability to raise additional capital, when and if needed or desired, will depend on conditions in the capital markets, economic conditions and a number of other factors, including investor perceptions regarding the banking industry and market conditions, and governmental activities, many of which are outside our control, and on our financial condition and performance. Accordingly, we cannot assure you that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed or on terms acceptable to us. Our failure to meet these capital and other regulatory requirements could affect customer confidence, our ability to grow, our costs of funds and FDIC insurance costs, our ability to pay dividends on common and preferred stock and to make distributions on our trust preferred securities, our ability to make acquisitions, and our business, results of operations and financial condition.

18

Table of Contents

Climate change and related legislative and regulatory initiatives may result in operational changes and expenditures that could significantly impact our business.

The current and anticipated effects of climate change are creating an increasing level of concern for the state of the global environment. As a result, political and social attention to the issue of climate change has increased. In recent years, governments across the world have entered into international agreements to attempt to reduce global temperatures, in part by limiting greenhouse gas emissions. The U.S. Congress, state legislatures and federal and state regulatory agencies have continued to propose and advance numerous legislative and regulatory initiatives seeking to mitigate the effects of climate change. Consumers and businesses may also change their behavior on their own as a result of these concerns. The impact on our customers will likely vary depending on their specific attributes, including reliance on or role in carbon intensive activities. Our efforts to take these risks into account in making lending and other decisions, including by increasing our business with climate-friendly companies, may not be effective in protecting us from the negative impact of new laws and regulations or changes in consumer or business behavior.

Given the lack of empirical data on the credit and other financial risks posed by climate change, it is difficult to predict how climate change may impact our financial condition and operations; however, as a banking organization, the physical effects of climate change may present certain unique risks. For example, weather disasters, shifts in local climates and other disruptions related to climate change may adversely affect the value of real properties securing our loans, which could diminish the value of our loan portfolio. Such events may also cause reductions in regional and local economic activity that may have an adverse effect on our customers, which could limit our ability to raise and invest capital in these areas and communities.

Evolving law impacting cannabis-related businesses in Illinois and other states may have an impact on the Company's operations and risk profile.

The Controlled Substances Act makes it illegal under federal law to manufacture, distribute, or dispense marijuana. Starting January 1, 2020, however, the Illinois Cannabis Regulation and Tax Act began permitting adults to legally purchase marijuana for recreational use from licensed dispensaries. It is the Banks' current policy to avoid knowingly providing banking products or services to entities or individuals that: (i) directly or indirectly manufacture, distribute, or dispense marijuana or hemp products, or those with a significant financial interest in such entities; or (ii) derive a significant percentage of revenue from providing products or services to, or other involvement with, such entities. The Banks are taking reasonable measures, including appropriate new account screening and customer due diligence measures, to ensure that existing and potential customers do not engage in any such activities. Nonetheless, the shift in Illinois law legalizing cannabis use has increased the number of direct and indirect cannabis-related businesses in Illinois, and therefore has increased the likelihood that the Banks could interact with such businesses, as well as their owners and employees. Such interactions could create additional legal, regulatory, strategic, and reputational risk to the Banks and the Company.

Credit and Lending Risks

We must effectively manage our credit risk.

There are risks inherent in making any loan, including risks inherent in dealing with specific borrowers, risks of nonpayment, risks resulting from uncertainties as to the future value of collateral and risks resulting from changes in economic and industry conditions. We attempt to minimize our credit risk through prudent loan application approval procedures, careful monitoring of the concentration of our loans within specific industries and periodic independent reviews of outstanding loans by our credit review department and an external third party. However, we cannot assure you that such approval and monitoring procedures will reduce these credit risks.

The majority of our subsidiary banks' loan portfolios are invested in C&I and CRE loans, and we focus on lending to small to medium-sized businesses. The size of the loans we can offer to commercial customers is less than the size of the loans that our competitors with larger lending limits can offer. This may limit our ability to establish relationships with the area's largest businesses. Smaller companies tend to be at a competitive disadvantage and generally have limited operating histories, less sophisticated internal record keeping and financial planning capabilities and fewer financial resources than larger companies. As a result, we may assume greater lending risks than financial institutions that have a lesser concentration of such loans and tend to make loans to larger, more established businesses. Collateral for these loans generally includes accounts receivable, inventory, equipment and real estate. However, depending on the overall financial condition of the borrower, some loans are made on an unsecured basis. In addition to C&I and CRE loans, our subsidiary banks are also active in residential mortgage and consumer lending. Our borrowers may experience financial difficulties,

19

Table of Contents

and the level of nonperforming loans, charge-offs and delinquencies could rise, which could negatively impact our business through increased provision, reduced interest income on loans/leases, and increased expenses incurred to carry and resolve problem loans/leases.

C&I loans make up a large portion of our loan/lease portfolio.

C&I loans were $1.6 billion, or approximately 34% of our total loan/lease portfolio, as of December 31, 2021. Our C&I loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. Most often, this collateral is accounts receivable, inventory, equipment and real estate. Credit support provided by the borrower for most of these loans and the probability of repayment is based on the liquidation value of the pledged collateral and enforcement of a personal guarantee, if any exists. Whenever possible, we require a personal guarantee or cosigner on commercial loans. In the case of loans secured by accounts receivable, the availability of funds for the repayment of these loans may be substantially dependent on the ability of the borrower to collect amounts due from its customers. The collateral securing these loans may lose value over time, may be difficult to appraise, and may fluctuate in value based on the success of the business. In addition, a prolonged recovery period could harm or continue to harm the businesses of our C&I customers and reduce the value of the collateral securing these loans.

Our loan/lease portfolio has a significant concentration of CRE loans, which involve risks specific to real estate values.

CRE lending comprises a significant portion of our lending business. Specifically, CRE loans were $2.7 billion, or approximately 57% of our total loan/lease portfolio, as of December 31, 2021. Of this amount, $421.7 million, or approximately 16%, was owner-occupied. The market value of real estate securing our CRE loans can fluctuate significantly in a short period of time as a result of market conditions in the geographic area in which the real estate is located. Adverse developments affecting real estate values in one or more of our markets could increase the credit risk associated with our loan portfolio. Additionally, real estate lending typically involves higher loan principal amounts and the repayment of the loans generally is dependent, in large part, on sufficient income from the properties securing the loans to cover operating expenses and debt service. Economic events or governmental regulations outside of the control of the borrower or lender could negatively impact the future cash flow and market values of the affected properties.

Included in our CRE lending portfolio are our LIHTC construction and permanent loans, which have the same inherent risks as our other non-owner occupied CRE loans.  However, the LIHTC construction and permanent loans, and related nonrefundable swap fee income, rely on federal LIHTCs to help finance the overall real estate projects and are dependent on the continued availability of such LIHTC programs.  Changes to the LIHTC programs, including changes to the level of tax credits provided by the federal government on low income housing, may have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Capital and Liquidity Risks

Liquidity risks could affect operations and jeopardize our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Liquidity is essential to our business. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of securities and/or loans and other sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity. Our primary sources of funds consist of cash from operations, deposits, investment maturities, repayments, and calls, and loan/lease repayments. Additional liquidity is provided by federal funds purchased from the FRB or other correspondent banks, FHLB advances, wholesale and customer repurchase agreements, brokered deposits, and the ability to borrow at the FRB's Discount Window. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance or capitalize our activities or on terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that affect us directly or the financial services industry or economy in general, such as disruptions in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry.

During periods of economic turmoil, the financial services industry and the credit markets generally may be materially and adversely affected by significant declines in asset values and depressed levels of liquidity. Furthermore, regional and community banks generally have less access to the capital markets than do the national and super-regional banks because of their smaller size and limited analyst coverage. Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to originate loans/leases, invest in securities, meet our expenses, pay dividends to our stockholders, or fulfill obligations such as repaying our borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity, business, results of operations and financial condition.

20

Table of Contents

As a bank holding company, our sources of funds are limited.

We are a bank holding company, and our operations are primarily conducted by our subsidiary banks, which are subject to significant federal and state regulation. When available, cash to pay dividends to our stockholders is derived primarily from dividends received from our subsidiary banks. Our ability to receive dividends or loans from our subsidiary banks is restricted. Dividend payments by our subsidiaries to us in the future will require generation of future earnings by them and could require regulatory approval if any proposed dividends are in excess of prescribed guidelines. Further, as a structural matter, our right to participate in the assets of our subsidiary banks in the event of a liquidation or reorganization of any of the banks would be subject to the claims of the creditors of such bank, including depositors, which would take priority except to the extent we may be a creditor with a recognized claim. As of December 31, 2021, our subsidiary banks had deposits, borrowings and other liabilities in the aggregate of approximately $5.5 billion.

Our allowance may prove to be insufficient to absorb losses in our loan/lease portfolio.

We establish our allowance for credit losses in consultation with management of our subsidiaries and maintain it at a level considered adequate by management to absorb loan/lease losses that are inherent in the portfolio. The amount of future loan/lease losses is susceptible to changes in economic, operating and other conditions, including changes in interest rates, which may be beyond our control, and such losses may exceed current estimates. At December 31, 2021, our allowance as a percentage of total gross loans/leases was 1.68%, and as a percentage of total NPLs was 2,852.21%.

In addition, we had net charge-offs as a percentage of gross average loans/leases of 0.00% for the year ended December 31, 2021. Because of the concentration of C&I and CRE loans in our loan portfolio, which tend to be larger in amount than residential real estate and installment loans, the movement of a small number of loans to nonperforming status can have a significant impact on these ratios. Although management believes that the allowance as of December 31, 2021 was adequate to absorb losses on any existing loans/leases that may become uncollectible, we cannot predict loan/lease losses with certainty, and we cannot assure you that our allowance will prove sufficient to cover actual loan/lease losses in the future, particularly if economic conditions are more difficult than what management currently expects. Additional provisions and loan/lease losses in excess of our allowance may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Competitive and Strategic Risks

We face intense competition in all phases of our business from other banks, financial institutions and non-bank financial services providers.

The banking and financial services businesses in our markets are highly competitive. Our competitors include large regional banks, local community banks, savings and loan associations, securities and brokerage companies, mortgage companies, insurance companies, finance companies, Fintech companies, money market mutual funds, credit unions, online lenders and other non-bank financial services providers. Many of these competitors are not subject to the same regulatory restrictions as we are. Many of our unregulated competitors compete across geographic boundaries and are able to provide customers with a feasible alternative to traditional banking services.

Technology and other changes are allowing consumers and businesses to complete financial transactions that historically have involved banks through alternative methods. For example, the wide acceptance of Internet-based commerce has resulted in a number of alternative payment processing systems and lending platforms in which banks play only minor roles. Customers can now maintain funds in prepaid debit cards or digital currencies, and pay bills and transfer funds directly without the direct assistance of banks.

Increased competition in our markets may result in a decrease in the amounts of our loans and deposits, reduced spreads between loan/lease rates and deposit rates or loan/lease terms that are more favorable to the borrower. Any of these results could have a material adverse effect on our ability to grow and remain profitable. If increased competition causes us to significantly discount the interest rates we offer on loans or increase the amount we pay on deposits, our net interest income could be adversely impacted. If increased competition causes us to modify our underwriting standards, we could be exposed to higher losses from lending and leasing activities. Additionally, many of our competitors are much larger in total assets and capitalization, have greater access to capital markets, have larger lending limits and offer a broader range of financial services than we can offer.

21

Table of Contents

Potential future acquisitions could be difficult to integrate, divert the attention of key personnel, disrupt our business, dilute stockholder value and adversely affect our financial results.

As part of our business strategy, we may consider acquisitions of other banks or financial institutions or branches, assets or deposits of such organizations. There is no assurance, however, that we will determine to pursue any of these opportunities or that if we determine to pursue them that we will be successful. Acquisitions involve numerous risks, any of which could harm our business, including:

difficulties in integrating the operations, technologies, products, existing contracts, accounting processes and personnel of the target company and realizing the anticipated synergies of the combined businesses;
difficulties in supporting and transitioning customers of the target company;
diversion of financial and management resources from existing operations;
the price we pay or other resources that we devote may exceed the value we realize, or the value we could have realized if we had allocated the purchase price or other resources to another opportunity;
risks of entering new markets or areas in which we have limited or no experience or are outside our core competencies;
potential loss of key employees, customers and strategic alliances from either our current business or the business of the target company;
risks of acquiring loans with deteriorated credit quality;
assumption of unanticipated problems or latent liabilities; and
inability to generate sufficient revenue to offset acquisition costs.

Future acquisitions may involve the issuance of our equity securities as payment or in connection with financing the business or assets acquired, and as a result, could dilute the ownership interests of existing stockholders. In addition, consummating these transactions could result in the incurrence of additional debt and related interest expense, as well as unforeseen liabilities, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. The failure to successfully evaluate and execute acquisitions or otherwise adequately address the risks associated with acquisitions could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

New lines of business or new products and services may subject us to additional risks.

From time to time, we may seek to implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of business in our current markets or new markets. There are substantial risks and uncertainties associated with these efforts, particularly in instances where the markets are not fully developed. In developing and marketing new lines of business and/or new products and services, we may invest significant time and resources. Initial timetables for the introduction and development of new lines of business and/or new products or services may not be achieved and price and profitability targets may not prove feasible, which could in turn have a material negative effect on our operating results.

If securities or industry analysts do not publish or cease publishing research reports about us, if they adversely change their recommendations regarding our stock or if our operating results do not meet their expectations, the price of our stock could decline.

The trading market for our common stock can be influenced by the research and reports that industry or securities analysts may publish about us, our business, our market or our competitors. If there is limited or no securities or industry analyst coverage of us, the market price for our stock could be negatively impacted. Moreover, if any of the analysts who elect to cover us downgrade our common stock, provide more favorable relative recommendations about our competitors or if our operating results or prospects do not meet their expectations, the market price of our common stock may decline. If one or

22

Table of Contents

more of these analysts ceases coverage of us or fails to publish reports on us regularly, demand for our stock could decrease, which could cause our stock price and trading volume to decline.

Our reputation could be damaged by negative publicity.

Reputational risk, or the risk to our business, financial condition or results of operations from negative publicity, is inherent in our business. Negative publicity can result from actual or alleged conduct in a number of areas, including legal and regulatory compliance, lending practices, corporate governance, litigation, inadequate protection of customer data, ethical behavior of our employees, and from actions taken by regulators, ratings agencies and others as a result of that conduct. Damage to our reputation could impact our ability to attract new or maintain existing loan and deposit customers, employees and business relationships.

Accounting and Tax Risks

The FASB has issued an accounting standard update that has resulted in a significant change in how the Company recognizes credit losses and may have a material impact on our financial condition or results of operations.  

In June 2016, the FASB issued an accounting standard update, "Financial Instruments-Credit Losses (Topic 326), Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments," which replaced the "incurred loss" model for recognizing credit losses with an "expected loss" model referred to as the CECL model. The new CECL standard became effective for us on January 1, 2021.  Under the CECL model, we are required to present certain financial assets carried at amortized cost, such as loans held for investment and held-to-maturity debt securities, at the net amount expected to be collected. CECL also requires that an allowance for credit losses be established for any unfunded loan commitments that are not cancelable.  The measurement of expected credit losses is to be based on information from past events, including historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts that affect the collectability of the reported amount, including anticipated losses resulting from deteriorating economic conditions as a result of events such as the COVID-19 pandemic. This measurement takes place at the time the financial asset is first added to the balance sheet and periodically thereafter. This differs significantly from the incurred loss model previously required under GAAP, which delayed recognition until it is probable a loss has been incurred. Accordingly, the adoption of the CECL model materially affected how we determine our allowance for credit losses and could require us to significantly increase our allowance in future periods.   Moreover, the CECL model may create more volatility in the level of the allowance for credit losses.  If we are required to materially increase our level of allowance for credit losses for any reason, such increase could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.  See Note 1 “Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies” of the notes to the consolidated financial statements for additional information on the impact of the adoption of this standard.

The preparation of our Consolidated Financial Statements requires us to make estimates and judgments, which are subject to an inherent degree of uncertainty and which may differ from actual results.

Our Consolidated Financial Statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP and general reporting practices within the financial services industry, which require us to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. Some accounting policies, such as those pertaining to our allowance, require the application of significant judgment by management in selecting the appropriate assumptions for calculating financial estimates. By their nature, these estimates and judgments are subject to an inherent degree of uncertainty and actual results may differ from these estimates and judgments under different assumptions or conditions, which may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations in subsequent periods.

From time to time, the FASB and the SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards or the interpretation of those standards that govern the preparation of our external financial statements. These changes are beyond our control, can be difficult to predict and could materially impact how we report our financial condition and results of operations.

Operational Risks

The transition to an alternative reference rate could cause instability and have a negative effect on financial market conditions.

LIBOR represents the interest rate at which banks offer to lend funds to one another in the international interbank market for short-term loans. On July 27, 2017, the U.K. Financial Conduct Authority announced that it will no longer persuade or

23

Table of Contents

compel banks to submit rates for the calculation of LIBOR rates after 2021.  End dates for LIBOR have now been set, and U.S. Regulators have issued guidance as of October 2021 that urges market participants to address their existing LIBOR exposures and transition to robust and sustainable alternative rates. The Alternative Reference Rate Committee has proposed that the SOFR is the rate that represents best practice as the alternative to U.S. dollar-LIBOR for use in derivatives and other financial contracts that are currently indexed to LIBOR but has also advised participants to conduct a comprehensive evaluation of any alternative reference rates being considered for use.

Contracts linked to LIBOR are vast in number and value, are intertwined with numerous financial products and services, and have diverse parties. Although the Company has actively worked to plan for the transition away from LIBOR, the transition is both complex and challenging and the downstream effect of unwinding or transitioning such contracts could cause instability and negatively impact financial markets and individual institutions. If the Company’s selected alternative rate is based on small transaction volume, it could be susceptible to volatility and disruption during times of market stress.  Furthermore, if the Company fails to properly address legacy contracts by adding robust fallback positions, it will be exposed to interest rate risks and potential loss of yields.  Finally, if the Company or other market participants fail to properly plan to implement alternative rates other than LIBOR it could have an adverse effect on the Company and the financial system as a whole.

The Company's information systems may experience an interruption or breach in security and cyber-attacks, all of which could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business.

The Company relies heavily on internal and outsourced technologies, communications, and information systems to conduct its business. Additionally, in the normal course of business, the Company collects, processes and retains sensitive and confidential information regarding our customers. As the Company's reliance on technology has increased, so have the potential risks of a technology-related operation interruption (such as disruptions in the Company's customer relationship management, general ledger, deposit, loan, or other systems) or the occurrence of a cyber-attacks (such as unauthorized access to the Company's systems). These risks have increased for all financial institutions as new technologies, the use of the Internet and telecommunications technologies (including mobile devices) to conduct financial and other business transactions and the increased sophistication and activities of organized crime, perpetrators of fraud, hackers, terrorists and others have also increased.  In addition, cyber attackers have taken advantage of the pandemic to create campaigns to leverage individuals fears and uncertainties as well as capitalize on the increased number of transactions occurring on digital channels.  Industry trends in ransomware, phishing, and other intrusion methods have increased significantly and will continue to pose increased risk while the Company’s operations remain partially remote.

In addition to cyber-attacks or other security breaches involving the theft of sensitive and confidential information, hackers have engaged in attacks against financial institutions, retailers and government agencies, particularly denial of service attacks that are designed to disrupt key business or government services, such as customer-facing web sites. The Company is not able to anticipate or implement effective preventive measures against all security breaches of these types, especially because the techniques used change frequently and because attacks can originate from a wide variety of sources. It is also possible that a cyber incident, such as a security breach, may remain undetected for a period of time, further exposing the Company to technology-related risks.

The Company also faces risks related to cyber-attacks and other security breaches in connection with credit card, debit card and other payment related transactions that typically involve the transmission of sensitive information regarding the Company's customers through various third parties, including merchant acquiring banks, payment processors, payment card networks and its processors. Some of these parties have in the past been the target of security breaches and cyber-attacks, and because the transactions involve third parties and environments such as the point of sale that the Company does not control or secure, future security breaches or cyber-attacks affecting any of these third parties could impact the Company through no fault of its own, and in some cases it may have exposure and suffer losses for breaches or attacks relating to them. Further cyber-attacks or other breaches in the future, whether affecting the Company or others, could intensify consumer concern and regulatory focus and result in increased costs, all of which could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business. To the extent we are involved in any future cyber-attacks or other breaches, the Company's reputation could be affected, which could also have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition or results of operations.

24

Table of Contents

System failure or breaches of our network security could subject us to increased operating costs as well as litigation and other liabilities.

The computer systems and network infrastructure we use could be vulnerable to unforeseen problems. Our operations are dependent upon our ability to protect our computer equipment against damage from physical theft, fire, power loss, telecommunications failure or a similar catastrophic event, as well as from security breaches, denial of service attacks, viruses, worms and other disruptive problems caused by hackers. Any damage or failure that causes an interruption in our operations could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Computer break-ins, phishing and other disruptions could also jeopardize the security of information stored in and transmitted through our computer systems and network infrastructure, as well as that of our customers engaging in internet banking activities, which may result in significant liability to us and may cause existing and potential customers to refrain from doing business with us. Although we, with the help of third-party service providers, intend to continue to implement security technology and establish operational procedures to prevent such damage, there can be no assurance that these security measures will be successful. In addition, advances in computer capabilities, new discoveries in the field of cryptography or other developments could result in a compromise or breach of the algorithms we and our third-party service providers use to encrypt and protect customer transaction data. Any interruption in, or breach of security of, our computer systems and network infrastructure, or that of our internet banking customers, could damage our reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny, or expose us to civil litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. The Company may also need to spend additional resources to enhance protective and detective measures or to conduct investigations to remediate any vulnerabilities that arise.

We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, customer or employee misconduct or fraud and data processing system failures and errors.

Employee errors and employee and customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation. Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities from us, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of our customers or improper use of confidential information. It is not always possible to prevent employee errors and misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases. Employee errors could also subject us to financial claims for negligence.

We maintain a system of internal controls and insurance coverage to mitigate operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud. Despite having business continuity plans and other safeguards, the Company could still be affected. Should our internal controls fail to prevent or detect an occurrence, and if any resulting loss is not insured or exceeds applicable insurance limits, such failure could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The success of our SBA lending program is dependent upon the continued availability of SBA loan programs, our status as a preferred lender under the SBA loan programs and our ability to comply with applicable SBA lending requirements.

As an SBA Preferred Lender, we enable our clients to obtain SBA loans without being subject to the potentially lengthy SBA approval process necessary for lenders that are not SBA Preferred Lenders. The SBA periodically reviews the lending operations of participating lenders to assess, among other things, whether the lender exhibits prudent risk management. When weaknesses are identified, the SBA may request corrective actions or impose other restrictions, including revocation of the lender's SBA Preferred Lender status. If we lose our status as an SBA Preferred Lender, we may lose our ability to compete effectively with other SBA Preferred Lenders, and as a result we would experience a material adverse effect to our financial results. Any changes to the SBA program, including changes to the level of guaranty provided by the federal government on SBA loans or changes to the level of funds appropriated by the federal government to the various SBA programs, may also have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Historically we have sold the guaranteed portion of our SBA loans in the secondary market. These sales have resulted in our earning premium income and/or have created a stream of future servicing income. There can be no assurance that we will be able to continue originating these loans, that a secondary market will exist or that we will continue to realize premiums upon the sale of the guaranteed portion of these loans. When we sell the guaranteed portion of our SBA loans, we incur credit risk on the retained, non-guaranteed portion of the loans.

25

Table of Contents

In the event of a loss resulting from default and the SBA determines there is a deficiency in the manner in which the loan was originated, funded or serviced by the us, the SBA may require us to repurchase the loan, deny its liability under the guaranty, reduce the amount of the guaranty, or, if it has already paid under the guaranty, seek recovery of the principal loss related to the deficiency from us, any of which could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Our community banking strategy relies heavily on our subsidiaries' independent management teams, and the unexpected loss of key managers may adversely affect our operations.

We rely heavily on the success of our bank subsidiaries' independent management teams. Accordingly, much of our success to date has been influenced strongly by our ability to attract and to retain senior management experienced in banking and financial services and familiar with the communities in our market areas. Our ability to retain the executive officers and current management teams of our operating subsidiaries will continue to be important to the successful implementation of our strategy. It is also critical, as we manage our existing portfolio and grow, to be able to attract and retain qualified additional management and loan officers with the appropriate level of experience and knowledge about our market areas to implement our community-based operating strategy. Recent changes in labor market conditions have contributed to heightened levels of employee attrition and increased competition for talent, which has in turn driven wage rates higher and may contribute to an increase in operating expenses. The unexpected loss of services of any key management personnel, or the inability to recruit and retain qualified personnel in the future, could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Effective succession planning is also important to our long-term success. Failure to ensure effective transfer of knowledge and smooth transitions involving key employees could hinder our strategic planning and execution.

We have a continuing need for technological change, and we may not have the resources to effectively implement new technology.

The financial services industry continues to undergo rapid technological changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. In addition to enabling us to better serve our customers, the effective use of technology increases efficiency and the potential for cost reduction. Our future success will depend in part upon our ability to address the needs of our customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands for convenience as well as to create additional efficiencies in our operations as we continue to grow our market share. Many of our larger competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. As a result, they may be able to offer additional or superior products to those that we will be able to offer, which would put us at a competitive disadvantage. Accordingly, we cannot provide you with assurance that we will be able to effectively implement new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing such products and services to our customers.

We have a substantial amount of debt outstanding and may incur additional indebtedness in the future, which could restrict our operations.

As of December 31, 2021, we had $152.0 million of total indebtedness outstanding at the holding company level. In the future, it is possible that we may not generate sufficient revenues to service or repay our debt, and have sufficient funds left over to achieve or sustain profitability in our operations, meet our working capital and capital expenditure needs, and to pay dividends to our common stockholders. Moreover, the degree to which we are leveraged could have important consequences for our stockholders, including:

limiting our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industry in which we operate;
making it more difficult for us to satisfy our debt and other obligations;
limiting our ability to borrow additional funds, or to sell assets to raise funds, if needed, for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions or other purposes;
increasing our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions, including changes in interest rates; and

26

Table of Contents

placing us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors that have less debt.

Severe weather, natural disasters, pandemic, acts of terrorism or war or other adverse external events could significantly impact the Company's business.

As the Company's operating and market footprint continues to grow, severe weather, natural disasters, pandemic, acts of terrorism or war and other adverse external events could have a significant impact on the Company's ability to conduct business. The Company's current footprint poses a wide variety of potential weather, natural disaster, or other adverse events that could impact the Company in various ways. In addition, such events could affect the stability of the Company's deposit base, impair the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans, impair the value of collateral securing loans, cause significant property damage, result in loss of revenue and/or cause the Company to incur additional expenses. The occurrence of any such event could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, which in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the financial condition and results of operation.

Item 1B.    Unresolved Staff Comments

There are no unresolved staff comments.

Item 2.    Properties

The Company’s headquarters is located at 3551 7th Street, Moline, Illinois. The Company and its subsidiaries maintain numerous other facilities, including bank branch locations, which are occupied by the Company and its subsidiaries and which house the executive and primary administrative offices of each respective entity or otherwise facilitate the business operations of the Company and its subsidiaries. Each such property is leased or owned by the Company or its subsidiaries and no such property is subject to any material encumbrance.

The subsidiary banks intend to limit their investment in premises to no more than 50% of their capital. Management believes that the facilities are of sound construction, in good operating condition, are appropriately insured, and are adequately equipped for carrying on the business of the Company.

No individual real estate property amounts to 10% or more of consolidated assets.

Item 3.    Legal Proceedings

There are no material pending legal proceedings to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party other than ordinary routine litigation incidental to their respective businesses.

Item 4.    Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

27

Table of Contents

Part II

Item 5.  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Market Information.  The common stock, par value $1.00 per share, of the Company is listed on The Nasdaq Global Market under the symbol “QCRH”. The stock began trading on Nasdaq on October 6, 1993. As of February 18, 2022, there were 15,641,927 shares of common stock outstanding held by 656 holders of record. Additionally, there are an estimated 3,700 beneficial holders whose stock was held in the street name by brokerage houses and other nominees as of that date.

Dividends on Common Stock. The Company is heavily dependent on dividend payments from its subsidiary banks to provide cash flow for the operations of the holding company and dividend payments on the Company’s common stock. Under applicable state laws, the banks are restricted as to the maximum amount of dividends that they may pay on their common stock. Applicable Iowa and Missouri laws provide that state-chartered banks in those states may not pay dividends in excess of their undivided profits.

The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its stockholders may be affected by both general corporate law considerations and policies of the Federal Reserve applicable to bank holding companies. The payment of dividends by any financial institution or its holding company is affected by the requirement to maintain adequate capital pursuant to applicable capital adequacy guidelines and regulations, and a financial institution generally is prohibited from paying any dividends if, following payment thereof, the institution would be undercapitalized. See Appendix A “Supervision and Regulation” for additional information regarding regulatory restrictions on the payment of dividends.

The Company also has certain contractual restrictions on its ability to pay dividends. The Company has issued debt securities in public offerings and in private placements. Under the terms of the securities, the Company may be prohibited, under certain circumstances, from paying dividends on shares of its common stock. None of these circumstances existed through the date of filing of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. See Note 17 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information regarding dividend restrictions.

Purchase of Equity Securities by the Company. On February 18, 2020, the Board of Directors of the Company approved a share repurchase program under which the Company is authorized to repurchase, from time to time as the Company deems appropriate, up to 800,000 shares of its outstanding common stock, or approximately 5% of the outstanding shares as of December 31, 2019.     All shares that were repurchased under the share repurchase program were retired. There were no repurchases of common stock by the Company during the fourth quarter of 2021.

Total number of shares

Maximum number

 

purchased as part of

of shares that may yet

    

Total number of

Average price

publicly announced

be purchased under

 

Period

shares purchased

 

paid per share

 

plans or programs

 

the plans or programs

January 1-31, 2021

100,932

699,068

February 1-28, 2021

100,932

699,068

March 1-31, 2021

100,932

699,068

April 1-30, 2021

100,932

699,068

May 1-31, 2021

12,000

47.45

112,932

687,068

June 1-30, 2021

88,000

48.04

200,932

599,068

July 1-31, 2021

84,000

47.21

284,932

515,068

August 1-31, 2021

84,904

49.32

369,836

430,164

September 1-30, 2021

24,249

49.82

394,085

405,915

October 1-31, 2021

394,085

405,915

November 1-30, 2021

394,085

405,915

December 1-31, 2021

394,085

405,915

There were 100,932 shares of common stock purchased by the Company during the year ended December 31, 2020.  There were no purchases of common stock by the Company during the year ended December 31, 2019.

28

Table of Contents

Stockholder Return Performance Graph. The following graph indicates, for the period commencing December 31, 2016 and ending December 31, 2021, a comparison of cumulative total returns for the Company, the Nasdaq Composite Index, and the SNL Bank Nasdaq Index prepared by S&P Global, Charlottesville, Virginia. The graph was prepared at the Company’s request by S&P Global. The information assumes that $100 was invested at the closing price on December 31, 2016 in the common stock of the Company and in each index, and that all dividends were reinvested.

Chart, line chart

Description automatically generated

Index

    

12/31/16

    

12/31/17

    

12/31/18

    

12/31/19

    

12/31/20

    

12/31/21

QCR Holdings, Inc.

 

100.00

 

99.40

 

74.88

 

103.01

 

93.71

 

133.19

Nasdaq Composite Index

 

100.00

 

129.64

 

125.96

 

172.18

 

249.51

 

304.85

SNL Bank Nasdaq Index

 

100.00

 

118.59

 

97.58

 

132.84

 

119.14

 

164.80

Item 6. [Reserved]

29

Table of Contents

Item 7.    Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

This section generally discusses 2021 and 2020 items and annual comparison between our fiscal 2021 performance compared to our fiscal 2020 performance.  A detailed review of our fiscal 2020 performance compared to our fiscal 2019 performance can be found in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020, under the caption “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”  This discussion should be read in conjunction with our Consolidated Financial Statements and the accompanying notes thereto included or incorporated by reference elsewhere in this document.

Additionally, a comprehensive list of the acronyms and abbreviations used throughout this discussion is included in Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

GENERAL

The Company was formed in February 1993 for the purpose of organizing QCBT. Over the past twenty-eight years, the Company has grown to include four banking subsidiaries and a number of nonbanking subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2021, the Company had $6.1 billion in consolidated assets, including $4.7 billion in total loans/leases, and $4.9 billion in deposits. The financial results of acquired/merged entities for the periods since their acquisition/merger are included in this report. Further information related to acquired/merged entities has been presented in the Annual Reports previously filed with the SEC corresponding to the year of each acquisition/merger.

IMPACT OF COVID-19

The progression of the COVID-19 pandemic in the United States has not had a materially adverse impact on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations as of and for the year ended December 31, 2021, but continues to have a complex and significant adverse impact on the economy, the banking industry and the Company in future fiscal periods, all subject to a high degree of uncertainty.

Effects on the Company’s Market Areas

The Company offers commercial and consumer banking products and services primarily in Iowa, Missouri and Illinois.  Each of these three states has recently taken different steps to reopen since COVID-19 thrust the country into lockdown starting in March 2020. The continuation and scope of re-openings in each jurisdiction are subject to change, delay and setbacks based on ongoing regional monitoring of the pandemic.

Effects on the Company’s Business

The extent to which COVID-19 will continue to affect business operations, financial condition, credit quality, and results of operations will depend on future developments that cannot be predicted, including the duration and scope of the pandemic.  The direct or indirect impact on employees, customers, counterparties, and service providers, as well as other market participants, is likely to continue through 2022 as the world attempts to gain control over the virus and emerging variants. The impact that the virus continues to have on global markets, the economy, business restrictions, and employment is ongoing as a projected return to pre-pandemic operating conditions is unknown.

The Company currently expects that the economic impact from COVID-19 will continue for some time and could have a material and adverse impact on our business and result in significant losses in our loan portfolio, all of which would adversely and materially impact our earnings and capital. Even after the COVID-19 pandemic has subsided, we may continue to experience materially adverse impacts to our business as a result of the global economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, including the availability of credit, adverse impacts on liquidity, and any recession that has occurred or may occur in the future.  There are no comparable recent events that provide guidance as to the effect the spread of COVID-19 as a global pandemic may have, nor are there historical indicators to rely on in terms of how markets will react, and as a result, the ultimate impact of the pandemic is highly uncertain and subject to change.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

The Company’s financial statements are prepared in accordance with GAAP. The financial information contained within these statements is, to a significant extent, financial information that is based on approximate measures of the financial

30

Table of Contents

effects of transactions and events that have already occurred.  The preparation of financial statements, in conformity with GAAP, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the determination of the allowance, impairment of goodwill and the fair value of financial instruments. A more detailed discussion of these critical accounting policies and estimates can be found in Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Based on its consideration of accounting policies and estimates that involve the most complex and subjective decisions and assessments, management has identified the following as critical accounting policies and estimates:

GOODWILL

The Company records all assets and liabilities purchased in an acquisition, including intangibles, at fair value. Goodwill is not amortized but is subject, at a minimum, to annual tests for impairment. In certain situations, interim impairment tests may be required if events occur or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying amount.

The initial recognition of goodwill and subsequent impairment analysis requires us to make subjective judgments concerning estimates of how the acquired assets will perform in the future using valuation methods, which may include using the current market price of stock or discounted cash flow analyses. Additionally, estimated cash flows may extend beyond five years and, by their nature, are difficult to determine over an extended timeframe. Events and factors that may significantly affect the estimates include, among others, competitive forces, customer behaviors, changes in revenue growth trends, cost structures, technology, changes in discount rates and market conditions. In determining the reasonableness of cash flow estimates, the Company reviews historical performance of the underlying assets or similar assets in an effort to assess and validate assumptions utilized in its estimates.

In assessing the fair value of reporting units, we may consider the stage of the current business cycle and potential changes in market conditions. We may also utilize other information to validate the reasonableness of our valuations, including public market comparables and multiples of recent mergers and acquisitions of similar businesses. Valuation multiples may be based on tangible capital ratios of comparable companies and business segments. These multiples may be adjusted to consider competitive differences, including size, operating leverage and other factors. The carrying amount of a reporting unit is determined based on the capital required to support the reporting unit’s activities, including its tangible and intangible assets. The determination of a reporting unit’s capital allocation requires judgment and considers many factors, including the regulatory capital regulations and capital characteristics of comparably situated companies in relevant industry sectors. In certain circumstances, the Company will engage a third-party to independently validate our assessment of the fair value of our reporting units.

The Company assesses the impairment of goodwill whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable. Factors considered important, which could trigger an impairment review, include the following:

Significant under-performance relative to expected historical or projected future operating results;
Significant changes in the manner of use of the acquired assets or the strategy for the overall business;
Significant negative industry or economic trends;
Significant decline in the market price for our common stock over a sustained period; or
Market capitalization relative to net book value.

As of November 30, 2021 the Company’s management performed an annual assessment at the reporting unit level and determined no goodwill impairment existed.

ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES ON LOANS AND LEASES AND OFF-BALANCE SHEET EXPOSURES

On January 1, 2021, the Company adopted ASU 2016-13, “Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (Topic 326),” which replaces the incurred loss methodology with a current expected credit loss methodology, known as CECL.  Additionally, CECL required an allowance for OBS exposures and HTM securities to be calculated using a current expected credit loss methodology.

31

Table of Contents

The Company’s allowance methodology incorporates a variety of risk considerations, both quantitative and qualitative, in establishing an allowance that management believes is appropriate at each reporting date. The Company’s methodologies for estimating the ACL consider available relevant information about the collectability of cash flows, including information about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts.  The methodologies apply historical loss information adjusted for asset-specific characteristics, economic conditions at the measurement date, and forecasts about future economic conditions that are expected to exist through the contractual lives of the financial assets and that are reasonable and supportable – to the identified pools of financial assets with similar risk characteristics for which the historical loss experience was observed.  If a loan is determined to no longer share similar risk characteristics with other assets in the segmented pool, it is evaluated on an individual basis.

The Company believes that as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic, losses have been incurred that are not yet known and this could have an adverse effect in the future on the Company’s ACL in the future.  Disruption to the Company’s customers could result in increased loan delinquencies and defaults resulting in an increase in quantitative allocations.  Management believes individually analyzed loans may increase in the future as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic, having a direct impact on the specific component of the ACL.

The Company also estimates expected credit losses over the contractual term of the loan for the unfunded portion of the loan commitment that is not unconditionally cancellable by the Company.  Management uses an estimated average utilization rate to determine the exposure of default.  The allowance for OBS exposures is calculated using probability of default and loss given default using the same segmentation and qualitative factors used for loans and leases.

Although management believes the level of the ACL as of December 31, 2021 was adequate to absorb losses inherent in the loan/lease portfolio and OBS exposures, a decline in local economic conditions, or other factors, could result in increasing losses that cannot be reasonably predicted at this time.

FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

The fair value of a financial instrument is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants in the market in which the reporting entity transacts business. A framework has been established for measuring the fair value of financial instruments that considers the attributes specific to particular assets or liabilities and includes a three-level hierarchy for determining fair value based on the transparency of inputs to each valuation as of the measurement date. The Company estimates the fair value of financial instruments using a variety of valuation methods. When financial instruments are actively traded and have quoted market prices, quoted market prices are used for fair value and are classified as Level 1. When financial instruments, such as investment securities and derivatives, are not actively traded the Company determines fair value based on various sources and may apply matrix pricing with observable prices for similar instruments where a price for the identical instrument is not observable. The fair values of these financial instruments, which are classified as Level 2, are determined by pricing models that consider observable market data such as interest rate volatilities, LIBOR yield curve, credit spreads, prices from external market data providers and/or nonbinding broker-dealer quotations. When observable inputs do not exist, the Company estimates fair value based on available market data, and these values are classified as Level 3.

FAIR VALUE OF SECURITIES

The fair value of securities is determined monthly and the securities are stated at fair value. For available for sale securities, unrealized gains and losses are reported as a component of stockholders’ equity, net of the related tax effect. For both available for sale and held to maturity debt securities, any portion of a decline in value associated with credit loss is recognized in income with the remaining noncredit related component being recognized in other comprehensive income.

EXECUTIVE OVERVIEW

The Company reported net income of $98.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2021, and diluted EPS of $6.20. For the same period in 2020 the Company reported net income of $60.6 million and diluted EPS of $3.80.

The year ended December 31, 2021 was highlighted by several significant items:

Record annual net income of $98.9 million, or $6.20 per diluted share;
Reported NIM at 3.30%;
Noninterest income of $100.4 million for the year;
Core deposit growth of 7.2% for the year*;

32

Table of Contents

Loan and lease growth of 16.9% for the year, excluding PPP loans (non-GAAP);
ACL to total loans/leases of 1.69%, excluding PPP loans (non-GAAP); and
Nonperforming assets to total assets improved by 80% for the full year and now represent only 0.05% of total assets at December 31, 2021.

* Core deposits are total deposits less brokered deposits

Following is a table that represents the various net income measurements for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Year Ended December 31, 

2021

2020

(dollars in thousands, except per share data)

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

Diluted earnings per common share

$

6.20

$

3.80

Weighted average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

 

15,944,708

 

15,952,637

The Company reported adjusted net income (non-GAAP) of $100.0 million, with adjusted diluted EPS of $6.27. See section titled “GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliations” for additional information. Adjusted net income for the year excludes a number of non-recurring items, after-tax, most significantly:

$135 thousand of mark to market gains on unhedged derivatives;
$493 thousand of acquisition costs; and
$734 thousand of separation agreement expense.

Following is a table that represents the major income and expense categories.

Year Ended December 31, 

 

2021

    

2020

    

(dollars are in thousands)

Net interest income

$

178,233

$

166,950

Provision for credit losses

 

3,486

 

55,704

Noninterest income

 

100,422

 

113,798

Noninterest expense

 

153,702

 

151,755

Federal and state income tax expense

 

22,562

 

12,707

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

The following are some noteworthy developments in the Company’s financial results:

Net interest income grew $11.3 million, or 6.8%, in 2021 compared to the prior year. The increase in 2021 was primarily due to strong loan/lease growth funded by core deposit growth while maintaining modest excess liquidity.  The Company had success moving cost of funds lower which helped to drive NIM expansion of 4% compared to the fourth quarter of 2020.

Provision expense decreased $52.2 million when comparing 2021 to 2020.  The decrease in 2021 was primarily due to continued strong credit quality, a reduction in NPLs and improving economic conditions. Additionally, the provision amounts for prior years were calculated under different accounting standards due to the adoption of CECL on January 1, 2021. See the “Provision for Credit Losses” section of this report for additional details.

Noninterest income decreased $13.4 million, or 11.8%, when compared to the prior year.  The decrease in 2021 was primarily attributable to lower swap fee income/capital market revenue.

Noninterest expense increased $1.9 million, or 1.3%, in 2021 compared to the prior year, primarily due to an increase in salaries and benefits expense, a write-off of certain fixed assets which resulted in a $1.4 million loss on disposal of fixed assets and increase in advertising and marketing expense.  In addition, there was a $1.1 million increase in net income from and gain/losses on operations of other real estate due to the sale of one large OREO property at a gain.  

33

Table of Contents

STRATEGIC FINANCIAL METRICS

The Company has established strategic financial metrics by which it manages its business and measures its performance. The goals are periodically updated to reflect business developments. While the Company is determined to work prudently to achieve these goals, there is no assurance that they will be met. Moreover, the Company’s ability to achieve these goals will be affected by the factors discussed under “Forward Looking Statements” as well as the factors detailed in the “Risk Factors” section included under Item 1A. of Part I of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The Company’s strategic financial metrics are as follows:

Generate organic loan and lease growth of 9% per year, funded by core deposits;
Grow fee-based income by at least 6% per year; and
Limit our annual operating expense growth to 5% per year.

The following table shows the evaluation of the Company’s strategic financial metrics:

For the Year Ending

Strategic Financial Metric*

    

Key Metric

    

Target

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

Loan and lease growth organically **

 

Loans and leases growth

 

> 9% annually

16.9

%  

7.8

%  

Fee income growth

 

Fee income growth

 

> 6% annually

(10.1)

%  

67.8

%  

Improve operational efficiencies and hold noninterest expense growth

Noninterest expense growth

 

< 5% annually

4.0

%  

1.5

%  

* The calculations provided exclude non-core noninterest income and noninterest expense.

** Loans and leases growth excludes PPP loans.

It should be noted that these initiatives are long-term targets.

STRATEGIC DEVELOPMENTS

The Company took the following actions in 2021 to support our corporate strategy and further the strategic financial metrics shown above:

The Company grew loans and leases organically in 2021 by 16.9%, excluding PPP loans (non-GAAP), driven by both our specialty finance group and our traditional lending and leasing business.

Correspondent banking continues to be a core line of business for the Company. The Company is competitively positioned with experienced staff, software systems and processes to continue growing in the four states it currently serves – Iowa, Wisconsin, Missouri and Illinois.  The Company acts as the correspondent bank for 187 downstream banks with total average noninterest bearing deposits of $349.0 million and total average interest bearing deposits of $305.3 million for 2021. This line of business provides a strong source of noninterest bearing and interest bearing deposits, fee income, high-quality loan participations and bank stock loans.

The Company is focused on executing interest rate swaps on select commercial loans, including LIHTC permanent loans. The interest rate swaps allow the commercial borrowers to pay a fixed interest rate while the Company receives a variable interest rate as well as an upfront nonrefundable fee dependent on the pricing. Management believes that these swaps help position the Company more favorably for rising rate environments. The Company will continue to review opportunities to execute these swaps at all of its subsidiary banks, as the circumstances are appropriate for the borrower and the Company.  Future levels of swap fees are somewhat dependent upon prevailing interest rates. Swap fee income/capital markets revenue totaled $61.0 million in 2021 as compared to $74.8 million in 2020. Swap fee income relative to the increase in notional amount of the non-hedging interest rate swap contracts was 11.5% in 2021 and 10.6% in 2020.

In recent years, the Company has been successful in expanding its wealth management client base.  Trust department fees continue to be a significant contributor to noninterest income.  Assets under management increased by $1.0 billion in 2021. There were 321 new relationships added in 2021 totaling $450.2 million of new assets under management. Income is generated primarily from fees charged based on assets under administration for corporate and personal trusts and for custodial services.  The majority of the trust department fees are determined based on the value of the investments within the fully-managed trusts.  The Company expects trust

34

Table of Contents

department fees to be negatively impacted during periods of significantly lower market valuations and positively impacted during periods of significantly higher market valuations.
Noninterest expense in 2021 totaled $153.7 million as compared to $151.8 million in 2020. Salaries and employee benefits expense increased 5% in 2021.  This increase was primarily related to increased performance-based incentive compensation driven by strong financial results.  Advertising and marketing expenses increased 31% primarily due to the return to more normal operations during 2021 after improvements in the general environment due to COVID-19 as compared to 2020. In addition, there were $624 thousand of acquisition costs in 2021 related to the pending acquisition of GFED as discussed in the Company’s financial statements and the accompanying notes presented elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Net cost of (income from) and gains/losses on operations of other real estate totaled $1.4 million for 2021 due primarily to the sale of one commercial OREO property at a gain. There were no losses on liability extinguishment in 2021 as compared to $3.9 million in 2020 from the prepayment of certain FHLB advances. Other noninterest expense increased 44% in 2021 due primarily to the write-off of certain fixed assets which resulted in a $1.4 million loss on disposal of fixed assets.

GAAP TO NON-GAAP RECONCILIATIONS

The following table presents certain non-GAAP financial measures related to the “TCE/TA ratio”, “adjusted net income”, “adjusted EPS”, “adjusted ROAA”, “NIM (TEY)”, “adjusted NIM”, “efficiency ratio”, “ACL to total loans and leases excluding PPP loans” and “loan growth excluding PPP loans”. In compliance with applicable rules of the SEC, all non-GAAP measures are reconciled to the most directly comparable GAAP measure, as follows:

TCE/TA ratio (non-GAAP) is reconciled to stockholders’ equity and total assets;
Adjusted net income, adjusted EPS and adjusted ROAA (all non-GAAP measures) are reconciled to net income;
NIM (TEY) (non-GAAP) and adjusted NIM (non-GAAP) are reconciled to NIM;
Efficiency ratio (non-GAAP) is reconciled to noninterest expense, net interest income and noninterest income; and
ACL to total loans and leases excluding PPP loans and loan growth excluding PPP loans (all non-GAAP measures) are reconciled to ACL and total loans and leases.

The TCE/TA non-GAAP ratio has been a focus for our investors and management believes that this ratio may assist investors in analyzing the Company’s capital position without regard to the effects of intangible assets.  

The following tables also include several “adjusted” non-GAAP measurements of financial performance.  The Company’s management believes that these measures are important to investors as they exclude non-recurring income and expense items; therefore, they provide a better comparison for analysis and may provide a better indicator of future performance.

NIM (TEY) is a financial measure that the Company’s management utilizes to take into account the tax benefit associated with certain loans and securities. It is standard industry practice to measure net interest margin using tax-equivalent measures.  In addition, the Company calculates NIM without the impact of acquisition accounting net accretion (adjusted NIM), as accretion amounts can fluctuate a great deal, making comparisons difficult.

The efficiency ratio is a ratio that management utilizes to compare the Company to peers. It is standard in the banking industry and widely utilized by investors.

ACL to total loans and leases, excluding PPP loans, and loan growth, excluding PPP loans, are ratios that management utilizes to compare the Company to its peers.  The Company’s management believes these financial measures are important to investors as total loans and leases for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 were materially higher due to the addition of PPP loans which are guaranteed by the government and therefore do not necessitate an increase in ACL.  By excluding the PPP loans, the investor is provided a better comparison to prior years for analysis.

Non-GAAP financial measures have inherent limitations, are not required to be uniformly applied, and are not audited. Although these non-GAAP financial measures are frequently used by investors to evaluate a company, they have

35

Table of Contents

limitations as analytical tools and should not be considered in isolation, or as a substitute for analyses of results as reported under GAAP.

As of

 

GAAP TO NON-GAAP

    

 

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

 

RECONCILIATIONS

2021

2020

 

 

(dollars in thousands, except per share data)

TCE/TA RATIO

 

  

 

  

Stockholders' equity (GAAP)

$

677,010

$

593,793

Less: Intangible assets

 

83,415

 

85,447

TCE (non-GAAP)

$

593,595

$

508,346

Total assets (GAAP)

$

6,096,132

$

5,705,043

Less: Intangible assets

 

83,415

 

85,447

TA (non-GAAP)

$

6,012,717

$

5,619,596

TCE/TA ratio (non-GAAP)

 

9.87

%  

 

9.05

%

For the Year Ended

 

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

 

    

2021

    

2020

 

ADJUSTED NET INCOME

Net income (GAAP)

$

98,905

$

60,582

Less non-core items (post-tax) (*):

 

  

 

  

Income:

 

  

 

  

Securities gains (losses), net

$

(69)

$

1,962

Mark to market gains on unhedged derivatives, net

135

Gain on sale of loan

28

Loss on syndicated loan

(210)

Total non-core income (non-GAAP)

$

94

$

1,752

Expense:

 

  

 

  

Losses on liability extinguishment

$

$

3,087

Goodwill impairment

500

Disposition costs

10

545

Acquisition costs

 

493

 

Post-acquisition compensation, transition and integration costs

 

 

169

Separation agreement

 

734

 

Loss on sale of subsidiary

 

 

110

Total non-core expense (non-GAAP)

$

1,237

$

4,411

Adjusted net income (non-GAAP)

$

100,048

$

63,241

ADJUSTED EPS

 

  

 

  

Adjusted net income (non-GAAP) (from above)

$

100,048

$

63,241

Weighted average common shares outstanding

 

15,708,744

 

15,771,650

Weighted average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

 

15,944,708

 

15,952,637

Adjusted EPS (non-GAAP):

 

  

 

  

Basic

$

6.37

$

4.01

Diluted

$

6.27

$

3.96

ADJUSTED ROAA

 

  

 

  

Adjusted net income (non-GAAP) (from above)

$

100,048

$

63,241

Average Assets

$

5,890,042

$

5,604,074

Adjusted ROAA (non-GAAP)

 

1.70

%  

 

1.13

%  

ADJUSTED NIM (TEY)*

 

Net interest income (GAAP)

$

178,233

$

166,950

Plus: Tax equivalent adjustment

 

10,211

 

8,216

Net interest income - tax equivalent (non-GAAP)

$

188,444

$

175,166

Less: Acquisition accounting net accretion

1,340

3,271

Adjusted net interest income

$

187,104

$

171,895

Average earning assets

$

5,398,868

$

5,085,659

NIM (GAAP)

 

3.30

%  

 

3.28

%  

NIM (TEY) (non-GAAP)

 

3.49

%  

 

3.44

%  

Adjusted NIM (TEY) (non-GAAP)

3.47

%

3.38

%

EFFICIENCY RATIO

 

  

 

  

Noninterest expense (GAAP)

$

153,702

$

151,755

Net interest income (GAAP)

$

178,233

$

166,950

Noninterest income (GAAP)

 

100,422

 

113,798

Total income

$

278,655

$

280,748

Efficiency ratio (noninterest expense/total income) (non-GAAP)

 

55.16

%  

 

54.05

%  

ACL TO TOTAL LOANS AND LEASES, EXCLUDING PPP LOANS

ACL, loans and leases

$

78,721

$

84,376

Total loans and leases

4,680,132

4,251,129

Less: PPP loans

28,181

273,146

Total loans and leases, excluding PPP loans

$

4,651,951

$

3,977,983

ACL to total loans and leases, excluding PPP loans

1.69

%

2.12

%

LOAN GROWTH, EXCLUDING PPP LOANS

 

  

 

  

Total loans and leases

$

4,680,132

$

4,251,129

Less: PPP loans

 

28,181

 

273,146

Total loans and leases, excluding PPP loans

$

4,651,951

$

3,977,983

Loan growth, excluding PPP loans

 

16.94

%  

 

7.80

%  

*    Nonrecurring items (after-tax) are calculated using an estimated effective tax rate of 21% with the exception of goodwill impairment which is not deductible for tax and gain on sale of subsidiary which has an estimated effective tax rate of 30.5%.

36

Table of Contents

NET INTEREST INCOME AND MARGIN (TAX EQUIVALENT BASIS)

Net interest income, on a tax equivalent basis (non-GAAP), increased 8% to $188.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2021, as compared to the prior year. Excluding the tax equivalent adjustments, net interest income increased 7% for the year ended December 31, 2021 compared to the prior year. Net interest income improved due to several factors:

Strong organic loan and deposit growth;
Significant growth and forgiveness of PPP loans in 2021 and 2020;
Reduction in higher cost wholesale funds with strong core deposit growth including noninterest bearing deposits; and
Reduction in cost of funds.

A comparison of yields, spread and margin on a tax equivalent and GAAP basis is as follows:

GAAP

For the Year Ended

December 31, 

2020

Average Yield on Interest-Earning Assets

3.97

%

Average Cost of Interest-Bearing Liabilities

0.63

%

Net Interest Spread

3.34

%

NIM (TEY) (Non-GAAP)

3.28

%

NIM Excluding Acquisition Accounting Net Accretion

3.27

%

Acquisition accounting net accretion can fluctuate mostly depending on the payoff activity of the acquired loans. In evaluating net interest income and NIM, it's important to understand the impact of acquisition accounting net accretion when comparing periods. The above table reports NIM with and without the acquisition accounting net accretion to allow for more appropriate comparisons.  A comparison of acquisition accounting net accretion included in NIM is as follows:

For the Year Ended

December 31, 

December 31, 

    

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Acquisition Accounting Net Accretion in NIM

$

1,340

$

3,271

The Company's management closely monitors and manages NIM. From a profitability standpoint, an important challenge for the Company's subsidiary banks and leasing company is focusing on quality growth in conjunction with the improvement of their NIMs. Management continually addresses this issue with pricing and other balance sheet management strategies which included better loan pricing, reducing reliance on very rate-sensitive funding, closely managing deposit rate increases and finding additional ways to manage cost of funds through derivatives.

37

Table of Contents

The Company’s average balances, interest income/expense, and rates earned/paid on major balance sheet categories are presented in the following table:

Year Ended December 31, 

2021

2020

2019

Interest

Average

Interest

Average

Interest

Average

Average

Earned

Yield or

Average

Earned

Yield or

Average

Earned

Yield or

Balance

    

or Paid

    

Cost

    

Balance

    

or Paid

    

Cost

    

Balance

    

or Paid

    

Cost

    

(dollars in thousands)

ASSETS

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Interest earning assets:

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Federal funds sold

$

1,964

$

2

 

0.10

%  

$

2,398

$

19

 

0.79

%

$

8,898

$

203

 

2.29

%

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

116,421

 

173

 

0.15

 

315,616

 

669

 

0.21

 

179,635

 

3,910

 

2.18

Investment securities (1)

 

804,636

 

29,504

 

3.66

 

715,808

 

26,773

 

3.74

 

635,650

 

24,151

 

3.80

Restricted investment securities

 

19,386

 

950

 

4.83

 

20,270

 

1,031

 

5.00

 

21,559

 

1,174

 

5.45

Gross loans/leases receivable (1) (2) (3)

 

4,456,461

 

179,738

 

4.03

 

4,031,567

 

178,097

 

4.42

 

3,857,547

 

193,365

 

5.01

Total interest earning assets

$

5,398,868

 

210,367

 

3.90

$

5,085,659

 

206,589

 

4.06

$

4,703,289

 

222,803

 

4.74

Noninterest-earning assets:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Cash and due from banks

$

60,298

$

80,208

$

81,645

Premises and equipment

 

75,015

 

73,063

 

78,189

Less allowance

 

(81,633)

 

(55,275)

 

(40,953)

Other

 

420,809

 

420,419

 

280,810

Total assets

$

5,873,357

$

5,604,074

$

5,102,980

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

  

 

  

 

  

  

Interest-bearing liabilities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

  

 

  

 

  

  

Interest-bearing deposits

$

3,058,917

 

8,621

 

0.28

%  

$

2,797,669

 

11,980

0.43

%

$

2,443,989

 

29,898

1.22

%

Time deposits

 

448,191

 

4,679

 

1.04

 

690,222

 

11,289

1.64

 

966,745

 

20,977

2.17

Short-term borrowings

 

6,281

 

5

 

0.08

 

22,625

 

84

0.37

 

16,837

 

363

2.16

FHLB advances

 

23,389

 

70

 

0.30

 

74,167

 

1,087

1.44

 

108,536

 

2,895

2.67

Other borrowings

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,563

 

512

3.77

Subordinated notes

115,398

6,272

5.44

83,404

4,697

5.63

60,883

3,564

5.85

Junior subordinated debentures

 

38,067

 

2,276

 

5.90

 

37,913

 

2,286

5.93

 

37,751

 

2,308

6.11

Total interest-bearing liabilities

$

3,690,243

 

21,923

 

0.59

$

3,706,000

 

31,423

0.85

$

3,648,304

 

60,517

1.66

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

$

1,269,467

$

1,052,375

$

817,473

Other noninterest-bearing liabilities

 

276,457

 

279,459

 

129,794

Total liabilities

$

5,236,167

$

5,037,834

$

4,595,571

Stockholders' equity

 

637,190

 

566,240

 

507,409

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

$

5,873,357

$

5,604,074

$

5,102,980

Net interest income

$

188,444

 

$

175,166

 

$

162,286

Net interest spread

 

 

 

3.31

%  

 

 

3.21

%

 

 

3.08

%

Net interest margin

 

 

 

3.30

%  

 

 

3.28

%

 

 

3.31

%

Net interest margin (TEY)(Non-GAAP)

 

 

 

3.49

%  

 

 

3.44

%

 

 

3.45

%

Adjusted net interest margin (TEY)(Non-GAAP)

3.47

%

3.38

%

3.36

%

Ratio of average interest-earning assets to average interest-bearing liabilities

 

146.30

%  

 

 

 

137.23

%  

 

 

128.92

%  

 

(1)Interest earned and yields on nontaxable investment securities and loans are determined on a tax equivalent basis using a 21% tax rate.
(2)Loan/lease fees are not material and are included in interest income from loans/leases receivable in accordance with accounting and regulatory guidance.
(3)Non-accrual loans/leases are included in the average balance for gross loans/leases receivable in accordance with accounting and regulatory guidance.

38

Table of Contents

The Company’s components of change in net interest income are presented in the following table:

For the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020

Inc./(Dec.)

Components

Inc./(Dec.)

Components

from

of Change (1)

from

of Change (1)

 

Prior Year

    

Rate

    

Volume

    

Prior Year

    

Rate

    

Volume

2021 vs. 2020

2020 vs. 2019

(dollars in thousands)

(dollars in thousands)

INTEREST INCOME

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Federal funds sold

$

(17)

$

(14)

$

(3)

$

(184)

$

(88)

$

(96)

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

(496)

 

(154)

 

(342)

 

(3,241)

 

(4,985)

 

1,744

Investment securities (2)

 

2,731

 

(576)

 

3,307

 

2,622

 

(382)

 

3,004

Restricted investment securities

 

(81)

 

(35)

 

(46)

 

(143)

 

(83)

 

(60)

Gross loans/leases receivable (2) (3)

 

1,641

 

(16,368)

 

18,009

 

(15,268)

 

(23,679)

 

8,411

Total change in interest income

$

3,778

$

(17,147)

$

20,925

$

(16,214)

$

(29,217)

$

13,003

INTEREST EXPENSE

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Interest-bearing deposits

$

(3,359)

$

(4,422)

$

1,063

$

(17,918)

$

(21,725)

$

3,807

Time deposits

 

(6,610)

 

(3,375)

 

(3,235)

 

(9,688)

 

(4,462)

 

(5,226)

Short-term borrowings

 

(79)

 

(41)

 

(38)

 

(279)

 

(372)

 

93

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

(1,017)

 

(546)

 

(471)

 

(1,808)

 

(1,071)

 

(737)

Other borrowings

 

 

 

 

(512)

 

(256)

 

(256)

Subordinated notes

1,575

1,575

1,133

1,133

Junior subordinated debentures

 

(10)

 

 

(10)

 

(22)

 

 

(22)

Total change in interest expense

$

(9,500)

$

(8,384)

$

(1,116)

$

(29,094)

$

(27,886)

$

(1,208)

Total change in net interest income

$

13,278

$

(8,763)

$

22,041

$

12,880

$

(1,331)

$

14,211

(1)The column "Inc/(Dec) from Prior Year" is segmented into the changes attributable to variations in volume and the changes attributable to changes in interest rates. The variations attributable to simultaneous volume and rate changes have been proportionately allocated to rate and volume.
(2)Interest earned and yields on nontaxable investment securities and loans are determined on a tax equivalent basis using a 21% tax rate.
(3)Loan/lease fees are not material and are included in interest income from loans/leases receivable in accordance with accounting and regulatory guidance.

The Company’s operating results are also impacted by various sources of noninterest income, including trust department fees, investment advisory and management fees, deposit service fees, swap fee income, gains from the sales of residential real estate loans and government guaranteed loans, earnings on BOLI and other income. Offsetting these items, the Company incurs noninterest expenses, which include salaries and employee benefits, occupancy and equipment expense, professional and data processing fees, FDIC and other insurance expense, loan/lease expense and other administrative expenses.

The Company’s operating results are also affected by economic and competitive conditions, particularly changes in interest rates, income tax rates, government policies and actions of regulatory authorities.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2021 and 2020

INTEREST INCOME

For 2021, interest income increased $1.8 million, or 1%, primarily due to an increase in the volume of average securities and average loans/leases partially offset by a decline in yields on average loans/leases and average securities. In total, the Company’s average interest-earning assets increased $313.2 million, or 6%, year-over-year. Average loans/leases grew 11%, while average securities increased 12%.

The Company intends to continue to grow quality loans and leases as well as diversify the securities portfolio to maximize yield while minimizing credit and interest rate risk.

INTEREST EXPENSE

Comparing 2021 to 2020, interest expense decreased $9.5 million, or 30%, year-over-year. The Company has grown organically at a significant pace over the past several years. Loan growth has been funded by core deposits and has also allowed the Company to prepay higher cost brokered deposits and FHLB advances.  In the second half of 2020 and the full year of 2021, the Company’s cost of funds declined in conjunction with the declining rate environment.  The

39

Table of Contents

Company’s cost of funds was 0.59% for the year ending December 31, 2021, which was down from 0.85% for the year ending December 31, 2020.

The Company’s management intends to continue to shift the mix of funding from wholesale funds to core deposits, including noninterest-bearing deposits. Continuing this trend is expected to strengthen the Company’s franchise value, reduce funding costs and increase fee income opportunities through deposit service charges.

PROVISION FOR CREDIT LOSSES

The ACL is established through provision for credit losses expense to provide an estimated ACL.  The following table shows the components for the provision for credit losses for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Year Ended

December 31, 

December 31, 

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Provision for credit losses - loans and leases (1)

$

5,702

$

55,704

Provision for credit losses - off-balance sheet exposures (2)

(2,231)

N/A

Provision for credit losses - held to maturity securities (3)

 

15

 

N/A

Total provision for credit losses

$

3,486

$

55,704

(1)2021 and years forward are evaluated using ASU 2016-13 and years prior to 2021 were calculated under an incurred loss model.
(2)Prior to adoption of ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2021, there were no requirements to record provision for off-balance sheet exposures.
(3)Prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2021, there was no requirement to record provision for credit losses for held to maturity securities.

The Company’s total provision for credit losses was $3.5 million for 2021, a decrease of $52.2 million from 2020. The adoption of ASU 2016-13 now requires an allowance on HTM debt securities and OBS exposures, specifically unfunded commitments.  For the year ended December 31, 2021, the provision related to OBS was negative due to the decrease in the balance of those OBS exposures with an increase in line of credit usage. The decrease in provision on loans and leases was substantially driven by decreased qualitative allocations in response to improving economic conditions related to the effects of COVID-19.

The ACL for loans and leases is established based on a number of factors, including the Company’s historical loss experience, delinquencies and charge-off trends, economic and other forecasts, the local, state and national economies and the risk associated with the loans/leases and securities in the portfolio as described in more detail in the “Critical Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates” section.

The Company had an ACL on loans/leases of 1.68% of total gross loans/leases at December 31, 2021, compared to 1.98% of total gross loans/leases at December 31, 2020.  Management evaluates the allowance needed on the acquired loans factoring in the remaining discount, which was $1.5 million and $3.1 million at December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

The following table represents the current balance of loans to customers with concentrations in industries that management has deemed to have a higher risk of being impacted by COVID-19:

As of December 31, 

 

2021

    

% of Total Gross

 

Amount

    

Loans and Leases

(dollars in thousands)

 

Hotels

$

76,628

1.64

%

Arts, Entertainment and Recreation

21,918

0.47

Restaurants (full service and limited service only)

21,162

0.45

$

119,708

2.56

%

Additional discussion of the Company’s allowance can be found in the “Financial Condition” section of this report.

40

Table of Contents

NONINTEREST INCOME

The following tables set forth the various categories of noninterest income for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Year Ended

 

December 31, 

December 31, 

 

2021

    

2020

    

$ Change

    

% Change

 

(dollars in thousands)

Trust department fees

$

11,206

$

9,207

$

1,999

 

21.7

%

Investment advisory and management fees

 

4,080

 

5,318

 

(1,238)

 

(23.3)

Deposit service fees

 

6,132

 

6,041

 

91

 

1.5

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans, net

 

4,397

 

4,680

 

(283)

 

(6.0)

Gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans, net

 

227

 

224

 

3

 

1.3

Swap fee income/capital markets revenue

 

60,992

 

74,821

 

(13,829)

 

(18.5)

Securities gains (losses), net

 

(88)

 

2,484

 

(2,572)

 

(103.5)

Earnings on bank-owned life insurance

 

1,838

 

1,904

 

(66)

 

(3.5)

Debit card fees

 

4,216

 

3,402

 

814

 

23.9

Correspondent banking fees

 

1,114

 

903

 

211

 

23.4

Other

 

6,308

 

4,814

 

1,494

 

31.0

Total noninterest income

$

100,422

$

113,798

$

(13,376)

 

(11.8)

%

In recent years, the Company has been successful in expanding its wealth management customer base. Trust department fees continue to be a significant contributor to noninterest income. Assets under management increased by $1.0 billion in 2021.  Income is generated primarily from fees charged based on assets under administration for corporate and personal trusts and for custodial services. The majority of the trust department fees are determined based on the value of the investments within the fully managed trusts. Trust department fees increased 22% in 2021 as compared to 2020.  The Company expects trust department fees to be negatively impacted during periods of significantly lower market valuations and positively impacted during periods of significantly higher market valuation.  

Investment advisory and management fees decreased 23% in 2021 as compared to 2020. Similar to trust department fees, fees from these services are largely determined based on the value of the investments managed. As a result, fee income from this line of business fluctuates with market valuations.  The sale of the Bates Companies in August 2020 negatively impacted the fee income from this line of business compared to 2020.  Excluding the impact of the Bates Companies sale, investment advisory and management fees increased 22% when comparing 2021 to 2020.

Deposit service fees increased 2% in 2021 as compared to 2020. The increase was primarily due to higher transactional volume with improving current economic conditions and new accounts. The Company continues to emphasize shifting the mix of deposits from brokered and retail time deposits to non-maturity demand deposits across all its markets. With this continuing shift in mix, the Company has increased the number of demand deposit accounts, which tend to be lower in interest cost and higher in service fees. The Company plans to continue this shift in mix and to further focus on growing deposit service fees.

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans, net, decreased 6% in 2021 as compared to 2020. The decrease was primarily due to decreased residential real estate purchases impacted by availability and the refinancing of residential real estate loans as volumes peaked in 2020 when rates declined.

The Company’s gains on the sale of government-guaranteed portions of loans for 2021 increased 1% as compared to 2020. Over the past few years, competitors have been offering SBA and USDA loan candidates traditional financing without such a guarantee and the Company is not willing to relax its structure for those lending opportunities.

The Company has grown its interest rate swap program significantly over the past several years.  The Company’s interest rate swap program consists of back-to-back interest rate swaps with two types of commercial borrowers: (1) traditional commercial loans of a certain minimum size and sophistication, and (2) LIHTC permanent loans.  Most of the growth has been in the latter category as the Company has grown relationships with strong LIHTC developers with many years of experience.  The LIHTC industry is strong and growing with an increased need for affordable housing.  The interest rate swaps allow the commercial borrowers to pay a fixed interest rate while the Company receives a variable interest rate as well as an upfront nonrefundable fee dependent upon the pricing. Swap fee income/capital markets revenue totaled $61.0 million in 2021 as compared to $74.8 million in 2020. Swap fee income relative to the increase in notional amount of the

41

Table of Contents

non-hedging interest rate swap contracts was 11.5% in 2021 and 10.6% in 2020.  In the traditional commercial portfolio, the pricing is more competitive and the duration is shorter as compared to the LIHTC permanent loans.  The mix of loans with interest rate swaps continued to be heavily weighted towards LIHTC permanent loans. Future levels of swap fee income are dependent upon the needs of our traditional commercial and LIHTC borrowers, and the size of the related nonrefundable swap fee may fluctuate depending on the interest rate environment. 

Securities losses, net of gains totaled $88 thousand in 2021 as compared to $2.5 million in securities gains, net of losses in 2020. In 2020, management sold select overvalued securities and utilized the gains to offset the cost of prepaying certain high-cost wholesale funds.

Earnings on BOLI decreased 4% in 2021. There were no purchases of BOLI in 2021 or 2020. Yields on BOLI (based on a simple average and excluding the impact of the federal income tax exemption) were 2.94% for 2021 and 2.87% for 2020. Notably, a small portion of the Company’s BOLI is variable rate whereby the returns are determined by the performance of the equity market. Management intends to continue to review its BOLI investments to be consistent with policy and regulatory limits in conjunction with the rest of its earning assets in an effort to maximize returns while minimizing risk.

Debit card fees are the interchange fees paid on certain debit card customer transactions. Debit card fees increased 24% in 2021. These fees improved alongside improving economic conditions and more normalized spending patterns. These fees can vary based on customer debit card usage, so fluctuations from period to period may occur. As an opportunity to maximize fees, the Company offers a deposit product with a higher interest rate that incentivizes debit card activity.

Correspondent banking fees increased 23% in 2021. The fees are generally included in the earnings credit rates which incent the correspondent bank to maintain higher levels of noninterest bearing deposits to offset the correspondent banking fees.  Management will continue to evaluate earnings credit rates and the resulting impact on deposit balances and fees while balancing the ability to grow market share. Correspondent banking continues to be a core strategy for the Company, as this line of business provides a high level of noninterest bearing deposits that can be used to fund loan growth as well as a steady source of fee income.  The Company now serves 187 banks in Iowa, Illinois, Missouri and Wisconsin.

Other noninterest income increased 31% in 2021 primarily due to equity investment income and gains on disposal of leased assets.

NONINTEREST EXPENSES

The following tables set forth the various categories of noninterest expenses for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Year Ended

 

December 31, 

December 31, 

 

2021

    

2020

    

$ Change

    

% Change

 

(dollars in thousands)

Salaries and employee benefits

$

100,907

$

96,268

$

4,639

 

4.8

%

Occupancy and equipment expense

 

15,918

 

16,504

 

(586)

 

(3.6)

Professional and data processing fees

 

14,579

 

14,644

 

(65)

 

(0.4)

Acquisition costs

 

624

 

 

624

 

100.0

Post-acquisition compensation, transition and integration costs

 

 

214

 

(214)

 

(100.0)

Disposition costs

13

690

(677)

(98.1)

FDIC insurance, other insurance and regulatory fees

 

4,475

 

4,164

 

311

 

7.5

Loan/lease expense

 

1,671

 

1,435

 

236

 

16.4

Net (income from) and gains/losses on operations of other real estate

 

(1,420)

 

(307)

 

(1,113)

 

362.5

Advertising and marketing

 

4,254

 

3,260

 

994

 

30.5

Bank service charges

 

2,173

 

2,016

 

157

 

7.8

Loss on liability extinguishment

3,907

(3,907)

(100.0)

Correspondent banking expense

 

799

 

838

 

(39)

 

(4.7)

Intangibles amortization

 

2,032

 

2,149

 

(117)

 

(5.4)

Goodwill impairment

500

(500)

(100.0)

Loss on sale of subsidiary

158

(158)

(100.0)

Other

 

7,677

 

5,315

 

2,362

 

44.4

Total noninterest expense

$

153,702

$

151,755

$

1,947

 

1.3

%

Management places strong emphasis on overall cost containment and is committed to improving the Company’s general efficiency. One-time charges relating to acquisitions and separation agreement expenses impacted expense in 2021. In

42

Table of Contents

2020, one-time charges relating to losses on liability extinguishment, dispositions and goodwill impairments impacted expenses.

Salaries and employee benefits, which is the largest component of noninterest expense, increased 5% in 2021 as compared to 2020. This increase was primarily related to increased incentive compensation driven by record financial results, and higher salary costs due to a higher number of FTEs.

Occupancy and equipment expense decreased 4% in 2021 as compared to 2020. This decrease was due to reduced service contract costs.

Professional and data processing fees remained flat in 2021 as compared to 2020. Generally, professional and data processing fees can fluctuate depending on certain one-time project costs. Management will continue to focus on minimizing such one-time costs and driving recurring costs down through contract negotiation or managed reduction in activity where costs are determined on a usage basis.

Acquisition costs totaled $624 thousand in 2021.  These costs were comprised of primarily legal, accounting and investment banking costs related to the pending acquisition described in Note 24 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

There were no post-acquisition compensation, transition and integration costs in 2021.  Post-acquisition compensation, transition and integration costs totaled $214 thousand for 2020. These costs were comprised primarily of personnel costs, IT integration, and conversion costs related to the previous mergers/acquisitions as described in Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.  

Disposition costs totaled $13 thousand for 2021 as compared to $690 thousand for 2020. The costs were comprised primarily of legal, accounting, disposal of fixed assets and prepaids, personnel costs and IT deconversion costs related to the sale of the Bates Companies.    See Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion.

FDIC insurance, other insurance and regulatory fee expense increased 8% in 2021.  The increase in expense was due to an increase in the asset size of the Company in 2021 as well as FDIC insurance assessment credits applied in 2020.

Loan/lease expense increased 16% in 2021 as compared to 2020. Generally, loan/lease expense has a direct relationship with the level of NPLs; however, it may deviate depending upon the individual NPLs.  

Net cost of (income from) and gains/losses on operations of other real estate includes gains/losses on the sale of OREO, write-downs of OREO and all income/expenses associated with OREO. Net income from operations totaled $1.4 million for 2021 as compared to net income of operations of $307 thousand for 2020. The higher amount in 2021 is due primarily to the gain on sale of one commercial OREO property.

Advertising and marketing expense increased 31% in 2021 as compared to 2020. The increase in expense was primarily due to the return to more normal operations during 2021 after improvements in the general environment due to COVID-19 as compared to 2020.

Bank service charges, a large portion of which includes indirect costs incurred to provide services to QCBT’s correspondent banking customer portfolio, increased 8% in 2021 as compared to 2020.   As transaction volumes continue to increase and the number of correspondent banking clients increases, the associated expenses is expected to also increase.

There were no losses on liability extinguishment in 2021.  Losses on liability extinguishment were $3.9 million in 2020. These losses relate to the prepayment of certain FHLB advances.

Correspondent banking expense decreased 5% in 2021 as compared to 2020. These are direct costs incurred to provide services to QCBT’s correspondent banking customer portfolio, including safekeeping and cash management services. In 2021, the Company made a strategic decision to discontinue maintenance of a cash vault to supply correspondents and correspondents were successfully moved to ordering cash directly through the Federal Reserve Bank.  This resulted in a cost savings for the Company.

Intangible amortization expense decreased 5% in 2021 as compared to 2020. These expenses naturally decrease unless there is an addition to intangible assets.

43

Table of Contents

There was no goodwill impairment expense in 2021. Goodwill impairment expense totaled $500 thousand in 2020 related to the Bates Companies.  See Note 6 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion.

There was no loss on sale of a subsidiary in 2021.  Loss on sale of a subsidiary totaled $158 thousand in 2020 due to the sale of the Bates Companies.  See Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion. There was no loss on sale of a subsidiary in 2021.

Other noninterest expense increased 44% in 2021 as compared to 2020.  The increase was due primarily to the write-off of certain fixed assets which resulted in a $1.4 million loss on disposal of fixed assets and $993 of credit card processing expenses.

INCOME TAX EXPENSE

The provision for income taxes was $22.6 million for 2021, or an effective tax rate of 18.6%, compared to $12.7 million for 2020, or an effective tax rate of 17.3%.  Refer to the reconciliation of the expected income tax rate to the effective tax rate that is included in Note 14 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional details.

FINANCIAL CONDITION AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2021 AND 2020

OVERVIEW

Following is a table that represents the major categories of the Company’s balance sheet.  

As of December 31, 

 

2021

2020

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

Amount

    

%

    

Amount

    

%

 

Cash, federal funds sold, and interest-bearing deposits

$

125,152

 

2

%

$

157,005

 

3

%

Securities

810,215

 

13

%

838,131

 

15

%

Net loans/leases

4,601,411

 

75

%

4,166,753

 

73

%

Derivatives

222,220

4

%

222,757

4

%

Other assets

337,134

6

%

320,397

6

%

Total assets

$

6,096,132

 

100

%

$

5,705,043

 

100

%

Total deposits

$

4,922,772

 

80

%

$

4,599,137

 

81

%

Total borrowings

170,805

 

3

%

177,114

 

3

%

Derivatives

225,135

4

%

229,270

4

%

Other liabilities

100,410

 

2

%

105,729

 

2

%

Total stockholders' equity

677,010

 

11

%

593,793

 

10

%

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

$

6,096,132

 

100

%

$

5,705,043

 

100

%

In 2021, total assets increased $391.1 million, or 7%. The Company’s securities portfolio decreased $27.9 million, or 3%, during 2021.  The Company’s loan/lease portfolio increased $434.7 million, or 10%, during 2021. The increase in the loan/lease portfolio was due to traditional commercial lending and SFG. Excluding PPP loans (non-GAAP), the Company’s loan/lease portfolio grew organically $674.0 million, or 16.9%, during 2021, which was funded by deposit growth and excess cash. Deposits grew $323.6 million, or 7%,  during 2021. Borrowings decreased $6.3 million, or 4%, during 2021.

INVESTMENT SECURITIES

The composition of the Company’s securities portfolio is managed to meet liquidity needs while prioritizing the impact on interest rate risk and maximizing return, while minimizing credit risk. Over the recent years, the Company has continued to change the mix of the portfolio by decreasing U.S government sponsored agency securities, while increasing residential mortgage-backed and related securities and tax-exempt municipal securities. Of the latter, the large majority are privately placed tax-exempt debt issuances by municipalities located in the Midwest (with some in or near the Company’s existing markets) that require a thorough underwriting process before investment and are generated by our specialty finance group.

44

Table of Contents

Following is a breakdown of the Company’s securities portfolio by type, the percentage of net unrealized gains (losses) to carrying value on the total portfolio, and the portfolio duration as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

2021

2020

    

Amount

    

%  

    

Amount

    

%  

    

(dollars in thousands)

U.S. treasuries and govt. sponsored agency securities

$

23,328

 

3

%  

$

15,336

 

2

%  

Municipal securities

 

639,601

 

79

%  

 

627,523

 

75

%  

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

94,323

 

12

%  

 

132,842

 

16

%  

Asset-backed securities

27,124

3

%  

40,683

4

%  

Other securities

 

25,839

 

3

%  

 

21,747

 

3

%  

$

810,215

 

100

%  

$

838,131

 

100

%  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities as a % of Total Assets

 

13.29

%  

  

 

14.69

%  

  

Net Unrealized Gains as a % of Amortized Cost

 

7.17

%  

  

 

6.90

%  

  

Duration (in years)

 

8.2

 

  

 

7.0

 

  

Yield on investment securities (tax equivalent)

3.66

%  

3.74

%  

At January 1, 2021, the Company adopted ASU 2016-13, which requires an ACL related to HTM securities.  Additionally, ASU 2016-13 replaced the legacy GAAP OTTI model with a credit loss model.  The credit loss model under ASU 2016-13, applicable to AFS debt securities, requires the recognition of credit losses through an allowance account, but retains the concept from the OTTI model that credit losses are recognized once securities become impaired.  See Note 1, “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” to the consolidated financial statement for a discussion of the impact of the adoption of ASU 2016-13.

The Company has not invested in non-agency commercial or residential mortgage-backed securities or pooled trust preferred securities.

The following is a breakdown of the weighted-average yield for each range of maturities by category of debt securities that are not held at fair value:

Weighted

Amortized

Average

    

Cost*

    

Yield

(dollars in thousands)

Municipal securities:

 

  

 

  

Within 1 year

$

2,622

 

2.08

%

After 1 but within 5 years

 

22,746

 

3.34

%

After 5 but within 10 years

 

48,402

 

3.43

%

After 10 years

 

397,763

 

3.87

%

Total

$

471,533

 

3.79

%

Other securities:

 

  

 

  

Within 1 year

$

550

2.92

%

After 1 but within 5 years

500

 

4.39

%

Total

$

1,050

 

3.62

%

Total HTM Securities

$

472,583

* Amortized cost above excludes ACL of $198 thousand.

The weighted-average yield is calculated by dividing the total interest for each security per maturity range by the total amortized cost within that maturity range. Yields are not computed on a tax equivalent basis.

There have been no major changes within the tax exempt portfolio.

See Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information regarding the Company’s investment securities.

45

Table of Contents

LOANS/LEASES

Total loans/leases, excluding PPP loans (non-GAAP), grew 16.9% in 2021 over 2020. The mix of loan/lease types within the Company’s loan/lease portfolio is presented in the following tables. Adoption of ASU 2016-13 resulted in a change in loans and lease segments and those segments for prior to 2021 are shown in a separate table.

As of

December 31, 2021

    

Amount

    

%

    

(dollars in thousands)

C&I - revolving

$

248,483

 

5

%  

C&I - other *

1,346,602

29

%  

CRE - owner occupied

421,701

9

%  

CRE - non-owner occupied

646,500

14

%  

Construction and land development

918,571

20

%  

Multi-family

 

600,412

 

12

%  

Direct financing leases

 

45,191

 

1

%  

1-4 family real estate

 

377,361

 

8

%  

Consumer

 

75,311

 

2

%  

Total loans/leases

$

4,680,132

 

100

%  

Less allowance

 

(78,721)

 

Net loans/leases

$

4,601,411

2020

Amount

    

%

    

(dollars in thousands)

C&I loans*

$

1,726,723

 

41

%  

CRE loans

 

2,107,629

 

50

%  

Direct financing leases

 

66,016

 

1

%  

Residential real estate loans

 

252,121

 

6

%  

Installment and other consumer loans

 

91,302

 

2

%  

Total loans/leases

$

4,243,791

 

100

%  

Plus deferred loan/lease origination costs, net of fees

7,338

 

Less allowance

(84,376)

 

Net loans/leases

$

4,166,753

*Includes PPP loans totaling $28.2 million and $273.1 million at December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

The Company experienced strong loan growth in 2021.  The growth was broad-based with some stronger growth in multi-family and construction related to our increased focus on LIHTC lending. 

Historically, the Company structures most residential real estate loans to conform to the underwriting requirements of Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae to allow the subsidiary banks to resell the loans on the secondary market to avoid the interest rate risk associated with longer term fixed rate loans and recognizing noninterest income from the gain on sale. Loans originated for this purpose were classified as held for sale and are included in the residential real estate loans in the table above. Historically, the subsidiary banks structure most loans that will not conform to those underwriting requirements as adjustable rate mortgages that mature or adjust in one to five years, and then retain these loans in their portfolios. The Company holds a limited amount of 15-year fixed rate residential real estate loans originated in prior years that met certain credit guidelines. In addition, the Company has not originated any subprime, Alt-A, no documentation, or stated income residential real estate loans throughout its history.

46

Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the remaining maturities by loan/lease type as of December 31, 2021 and 2020. Maturities are based on contractual dates.

As of December 31, 2021

 

Maturities After One Year

 

Due in one

Due after one

Due after 5

Due after

Predetermined

Adjustable

 

    

year or less

    

through 5 years

    

through 15 years

15 years

    

interest rates

    

interest rates

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

C&I - revolving

$

198,861

$

44,927

$

4,695

$

$

10,852

$

38,770

C&I - other

 

320,932

 

591,103

 

222,408

 

212,159

 

725,568

 

300,102

CRE - owner occupied

39,959

188,408

163,862

29,472

228,247

153,495

CRE - non-owner occupied

97,300

347,215

156,558

45,427

342,349

206,851

Construction and land development

144,624

159,408

45,608

568,931

161,195

612,752

Multi-family

27,483

67,407

134,919

370,603

67,055

505,874

Direct financing leases

 

2,514

 

42,253

 

424

 

 

42,677

 

1-4 family real estate

 

21,190

 

92,443

 

113,049

 

150,679

 

316,356

 

39,815

Consumer

 

8,968

 

32,787

 

32,654

 

902

 

17,860

 

48,483

$

861,831

$

1,565,951

$

874,177

$

1,378,173

$

1,912,159

$

1,906,142

As of December 31, 2020

 

Maturities After One Year

 

Due in one

Due after one

Due after

Predetermined

Adjustable

 

    

year or less

    

through 5 years

    

5 years

    

interest rates

    

interest rates

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

C&I loans

$

362,104

$

942,702

$

421,917

$

995,910

$

368,709

CRE loans

 

277,248

 

866,614

 

963,767

 

788,442

 

1,041,939

Direct financing leases

 

3,617

 

61,504

 

895

 

62,399

 

Residential real estate loans

 

19,717

 

12,335

 

220,069

 

200,028

 

32,376

Installment and other consumer loans

 

17,671

 

41,634

 

31,997

 

30,975

 

42,656

$

680,357

$

1,924,789

$

1,638,645

$

2,077,754

$

1,485,680

See Note 4 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information on the Company’s loan/lease portfolio.

ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES ON LOANS/LEASES AND OFF-BALANCE SHEET EXPOSURES

On January 1, 2021, the Company adopted ASU 2016-13, “Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (Topic 326),” which replaces the incurred loss methodology with the CECL methodology.  Additionally, CECL required an ACL for OBS exposures to be calculated using a current expected credit loss methodology.

The adequacy of the allowance was determined by management based on factors that included the overall composition of the loan/lease portfolio, types of loans/leases, historical loss experience, loan/lease delinquencies, potential substandard and doubtful credits, economic conditions, collateral positions, government guarantees and other factors that, in management’s judgment, deserved evaluation. To ensure that an adequate ACL was maintained, provisions were made based on a number of factors, including the increase in loans/leases and a detailed analysis of the loan/lease portfolio. The loan/lease portfolio is reviewed and analyzed quarterly with specific detailed reviews completed on all credits risk-rated less than “fair quality” as described in Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements and carrying aggregate exposure in excess of $250 thousand. The adequacy of the allowance is monitored by the credit administration staff and reported to management and the Board of Directors.

Changes in the ACL for loans/leases for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 are presented as follows:

Year Ended

    

December 31, 2021

    

December 31, 2020

    

December 31, 2019

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

84,376

$

36,001

$

39,847

Impact of adopting ASU 2016-13

(8,102)

Reclassification of allowance related to held for sale loans

(6,122)

Provision

 

5,702

 

55,704

 

6,638

Charge-offs

 

(4,538)

 

(8,383)

 

(5,134)

Recoveries

 

1,283

 

1,054

 

772

Balance, ending

$

78,721

$

84,376

$

36,001

47

Table of Contents

Net charge-offs by segment and their percentage of average loans and leases are as follows:

Year ended December 31,

2021

2020

Amount

% of Average Loans

Amount

% of Average Loans

(dollars in thousands)

Average amount of loans/leases outstanding, before allowance

$

4,456,461

$

4,031,567

Net charge-offs:

C&I

$

0.00

%  

$

(3,550)

0.09

%  

C&I - Revolving

0.00

0.00

C&I - Other

(1,697)

0.04

0.00

CRE

0.00

(1,889)

0.05

CRE owner occupied

3

0.00

0.00

CRE non-owner occupied

(1,791)

0.04

0.00

Construction and land development

0.00

0.00

Multi-family

(150)

0.00

0.00

Direct financing leases

0.00

(1,848)

0.05

Residential real estate

0.00

29

0.00

1-4 family real estate

102

0.00

0.00

Consumer

278

(0.01)

(71)

0.00

Total net charge-offs

$

(3,255)

$

(7,329)

Changes in the ACL for OBS exposures for the year ended December 31, 2021:

Year Ended

December 31, 2021

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning (1)

$

Impact of adopting ASU 2016-13

9,117

Provisions credited to expense

 

(2,231)

Balance, ending

$

6,886

(1)Prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13, the Company did not calculate an ACL for OBS exposures, and therefore prior periods have not been shown in this table.

The ACL for OBS exposures totaled $9.1 million at the adoption of CECL on January 1, 2021.  Prior to January 1, 2021, the allowance for OBS exposures was not required.  The Company recorded negative $2.2 million of provision for credit losses related to OBS exposures, specifically unfunded commitments, in 2021 primarily due to increased line of credit usage resulting in lower exposure.  At December 31, 2021, the allowance for OBS exposures was $6.9 million.

The following is a table that reports the criticized and classified loan totals as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

As of December 31, 

Internally Assigned Risk Rating *

 

2021

    

2020

    

(dollars in thousands)

Special Mention (Rating 6)

$

62,510

 

$

71,481

 

Substandard (Rating 7)

53,296

 

66,081

 

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

$

115,806

 

$

137,562

 

Criticized Loans **

$

115,806

 

$

137,562

 

Classified Loans ***

$

53,296

 

$

66,081

 

Criticized Loans as a % of Total Loans/Leases

2.47

%

3.24

%

Classified Loans as a % of Total Loans/Leases

1.14

%

1.55

%

*    Amounts above exclude the government guaranteed portion, if any. The Company assigns internal risk ratings of Pass (Rating 2) for the government

guaranteed portion.

**   Criticized loans are defined as C&I and CRE loans with internally assigned risk ratings of 6, 7, or 8, regardless of performance.

*** Classified loans are defined as C&I and CRE loans with internally assigned risk ratings of 7 or 8, regardless of performance.

Criticized loans decreased 16% and classified loans decreased 20% in 2021 as compared to 2020.  The Company continues its strong focus on improving credit quality in an effort to limit NPLs.

48

Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the trend in allowance as a percentage of gross loans/leases and as a percentage of NPLs as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

As of December 31, 

2021

    

2020

    

ACL on loans/leases / Gross loans/leases

1.68

%  

1.98

%  

ACL on loans/leases / NPLs

2,825.21

%  

574.61

%  

The following table presents the allowance by type and the percentage of loan/lease type to total loans/leases.

As of December 31, 

2021

    

Amount

    

%

    

(dollars in thousands)

C&I - revolving

 

3,907

 

5

%  

C&I - other

 

25,982

 

30

%  

CRE - owner occupied

8,501

9

%  

CRE - non-owner occupied

8,549

14

%  

Construction and land development

16,972

20

%  

Multi-family

9,339

12

%  

1-4 family real estate

 

4,541

 

8

%  

Consumer

 

930

 

2

%  

$

78,721

 

100

%  

* Included within the C&I – Other segment is an ACL on leases of $1.5 million. Leases represent 1% of to total loans/leases.

As of December 31, 

2020

    

Amount

    

%

    

(dollars in thousands)

C&I loans

35,421

 

41

%  

CRE loans

42,161

 

50

%  

Direct financing leases

1,764

 

1

%  

Residential real estate loans

3,732

 

6

%  

Installment and other consumer loans

1,298

 

2

%  

$

84,376

 

100

%  

% Represents the percentage of the certain type of loan/lease to total loans/leases

Although management believes that the ACL for loans/leases at December 31, 2021 is at a level adequate to absorb losses on existing loans/leases, there can be no assurance that such losses will not exceed the estimated amounts or that the Company will not be required to make additional provisions in the future. Unpredictable future events could adversely affect cash flows for both commercial and individual borrowers, which could cause the Company to experience increases in problem assets, delinquencies and losses on loans/leases, and may require additional increases in the provision for credit losses. Asset quality is a priority for the Company and its subsidiaries. The ability to grow profitably is in part dependent upon the ability to maintain that quality. The Company continually focuses efforts at its subsidiary banks and its leasing company with the intention to improve the overall quality of the Company’s loan/lease portfolio.

See Note 4 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information on the Company’s ACL.

49

Table of Contents

NONPERFORMING ASSETS

The table below presents the amounts of NPAs and related ratios.

As of December 31,

2021

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Nonaccrual loans/leases (1) (2)

$

2,759

$

13,940

Accruing loans/leases past due 90 days or more

1

3

Total NPLs

 

2,760

13,943

OREO

20

Other repossessed assets

135

Total NPAs

$

2,760

$

14,098

NPLs to total loans/leases

0.06

%  

0.33

%  

NPAs to total loans/leases plus repossessed property

0.06

%  

0.33

%  

NPAs to total assets

0.05

%  

0.25

%  

Nonccrual loans/leases to total loans/leases

0.06

%  

0.33

%  

ACL to nonaccrual loans

2853.24

%  

605.28

%  

(1)Includes government guaranteed portions of loans, if applicable.
(2)Includes TDRs of $65 thousand, $984 thousand and $747 thousand at December 31, 2021, December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively.

The majority of the Company’s NPAs consists of nonaccrual loans/leases. For nonaccrual loans/leases, management thoroughly reviewed these loans/leases and provided specific allowances as appropriate.

OREO is carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell.

The policy of the Company is to place a loan/lease on nonaccrual status if:  (a) payment in full of interest or principal is not expected; or (b) principal or interest has been in default for a period of 90 days or more unless the obligation is both in the process of collection and well secured.  A loan/lease is well secured if it is secured by collateral with sufficient market value to repay principal and all accrued interest. A debt is in the process of collection if collection of the debt is proceeding in due course either through legal action, including judgment enforcement procedures, or in appropriate circumstances, through collection efforts not involving legal action which are reasonably expected to result in repayment of the debt or in its restoration to current status.

In 2021, the Company’s NPAs decreased $11.3 million, or 80% as compared to $14.1 million in 2020.   The decrease in NPAs in 2021 was primarily due to several isolated relationships that paid off in 2021 as well as one loan that was charged off to OREO and subsequently sold.  

The Company’s lending/leasing practices remain unchanged and asset quality remains a top priority for management.

Due to the economic impacts of COVID-19, the Company established its LRP for its clients.  The LRP allows borrowers to request the deferral of principal and interest payments for an agreed upon term.  Those deferred payments will be added to the end of the original term of the loan through a three-month extension of the maturity date.  The CARES Act includes provisions that allow financial institutions to elect to not apply GAAP requirements to loan modifications related to COVID-19 that would otherwise be categorized as a TDR, including arrangements that defer or delay payments of principal or interest for up to 90 days.  The relief from TDR guidance applies to modifications of loans that were not more than 30 days past due as of December 31, 2019, and that occur beginning on March 1, 2020 until the earlier of sixty days after the date on which the national emergency related to COVID-19 is terminated or December 31, 2020. On December 27, 2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act was established, which extended this relief to the earlier of the first day of the Company’s fiscal year after the date of the national emergency terminates or January 1, 2022. The Company believes that the majority of LRP participants will not be categorized as a TDR by meeting the CARES Act provisions. The Company implemented its LRP offerings to extend qualifying customers’ payments for 90 days.  As of December 31, 2021 there were no Bank modifications of loans to commercial and consumer clients and six m2 modifications of loans and leases totaling $2.4 million representing 0.05% of the total loan and lease portfolio currently on deferral. The Company intends to allow qualifying commercial and consumer clients to defer payments under the new guidance.

50

Table of Contents

On March 22, 2020, federal banking regulators issued an interagency statement that included guidance on their approach for the accounting of loan modifications in light of the economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic. The guidance interprets current accounting standards and indicates that a lender can conclude that a borrower is not experiencing financial difficulty if short-term modifications are made in response to COVID-19, such as payment deferrals, fee waivers, extensions of repayment terms or other delays in payment that are insignificant related to the loans in which the borrower is less than 30 days past due on its contractual payments at the time a modification program is implemented. The agencies confirmed in working with the staff of the FASB that short-term modifications made on a good faith basis in response to COVID-19 to borrowers who were current prior to any relief are not TDRs. The regulators clarified that this guidance could continue to be applied through December 31, 2021.

DEPOSITS

Deposits grew $323.6 million, or 7.0%, during 2021, primarily due to an increase in both non-interest bearing and interest bearing deposits.  The table below presents the composition of the Company’s deposit portfolio.

As of December 31, 

2021

    

2020

    

Amount

    

%

    

Amount

    

%

    

(dollars in thousands)

Noninterest bearing demand deposits

$

1,268,788

 

26

%  

$

1,145,378

 

25

%  

Interest bearing demand deposits

 

3,232,633

 

65

%  

 

2,987,469

 

65

%  

Time deposits

 

421,348

 

9

%  

 

460,659

 

10

%  

Brokered deposits

 

3

 

%  

 

5,631

 

%  

$

4,922,772

 

100

%  

$

4,599,137

 

100

%  

The Company has been successful in growing its noninterest-bearing deposit portfolio over the past several years, growing average balances 21% in 2021. Year-end balances can fluctuate a great deal due to large customer and correspondent bank activity. During the year, the Company had significant core deposit growth mostly from its correspondent banking clients.  The outsized deposit growth exceeded the strong loan growth and led to the Company carrying excess liquidity during the year. As a result of strong core deposit growth, the Company reduced its reliance on higher cost CDs and brokered deposits.

The Company’s correspondent bank deposits have grown significantly over the past two years.  The correspondent bank deposit portfolio consists of the following:

Noninterest-bearing deposits which represent the correspondent banks’ operating cash used for processing transactions with the Federal Reserve,
Money market deposits which represent some excess liquidity, and
The correspondent banks’ EBA at the FRB. 

The Company has modified the structure and interest rates paid for those correspondent bank deposits on the balance sheet which are the noninterest bearing deposits and the money market deposits.  This has led to more of the correspondent bank portfolio’s excess liquidity to shift to the EBAs at the FRB which is managed by the Company, but is off the Company’s balance sheet.  On average, over the past two years, the correspondent banks’ EBA ranges from $1.3 billion to $1.5 billion which is approximately $1 billion more than pre-pandemic levels. 

The Company had total uninsured deposits of $1.9 billion and $1.8 billion as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 respectively. The table below represents the time deposits in FDIC uninsured accounts by maturity:

As of December 31, 

As of December 31, 

2021

2020

    

(dollars in thousands)

U.S. Time Deposits in Amounts in Excess of FDIC insurance limit:

One to three months

 

$

61,278

 

$

88,295

Three to six months

 

45,451

 

35,977

Six to twelve months

 

81,290

 

76,478

Over twelve months

 

37,038

 

46,939

$

225,058

$

247,690

51

Table of Contents

There were no other time deposits otherwise uninsured. The Company had no deposits by foreign depositors in domestic offices as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Management will continue to focus on growing its core deposit portfolio, including its correspondent banking business at QCBT, as well as shifting the mix from brokered and other higher cost deposits to lower cost core deposits. With the significant success achieved by QCBT in growing its correspondent banking business, QCBT has developed procedures to proactively monitor this industry concentration of deposits and loans. Other deposit-related industry concentrations and large accounts are monitored by the internal asset liability management committee. See discussion regarding policy limits on bank stock loans in the Lending/Leasing section under Item 1 – Business in Part I of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS

The subsidiary banks purchase federal funds for short-term funding needs from the FRB or from their correspondent banks. The table below presents the composition of the Company’s short-term borrowings.

As of, December 31, 

 

2021

    

2020

    

(dollars in thousands)

Federal funds purchased

3,800

5,430

$

3,800

$

5,430

The Company’s federal funds purchased fluctuates based on the short-term funding needs of the Company’s subsidiary banks. See Note 9 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information on the Company’s short-term borrowings.

FHLB ADVANCES AND OTHER BORROWINGS

As a result of their membership in the FHLB of Des Moines, the subsidiary banks have the ability to borrow funds for short-term or long-term purposes under a variety of programs. The subsidiary banks can utilize FHLB advances for loan matching as a hedge against the possibility of rising interest rates or when these advances provide a less costly source of funds than customer deposits. There was no change in FHLB advances from 2020 to 2021.  

As of December 31, 

    

2021

2020

(dollars in thousands)

FHLB Advances

$

15,000

$

15,000

Weighted Average Interest Rate at Year-End

 

0.31

%  

 

0.29

%  

See Notes 10 and 11 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information regarding FHLB advances and other borrowings.

It is management’s intention to continue to reduce its reliance on wholesale funding, including FHLB advances, wholesale structured repurchase agreements, and brokered deposits. Replacement of this funding with core deposits helps to reduce interest expense as the wholesale funding tends to be higher cost. However, the Company may choose to utilize wholesale funding sources to supplement funding needs, as this is a way for the Company to effectively and efficiently manage interest rate risk.

SUBORDINATED NOTES

The Company had subordinated notes totaling $113.9 million and $118.7 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. The Company prepaid $5.0 million in subordinated debt in 2021 with no gain/loss.

See Note 12 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information regarding the subordinated notes.

52

Table of Contents

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

The table below presents the composition of the Company’s stockholders’ equity.

As of December 31, 

2021

    

2020

    

(dollars in thousands)

Common stock

$

15,613

$

15,806

Additional paid in capital

 

273,768

 

275,807

Retained earnings

 

386,077

 

300,804

AOCI

 

1,552

 

1,376

Total stockholders' equity

$

677,010

$

593,793

TCE / TA ratio (non-GAAP)

 

9.87

%  

 

9.05

%  

*   TCE/TA ratio is a non-GAAP measure. Refer to the GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliations section of this report for more information.

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, no preferred stock was outstanding.

The following table presents the rollforward of stockholders’ equity for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

For the Year Ended December 31, 

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Beginning balance

$

593,793

$

535,351

Impact of adoption of ASU 2016-13

(937)

Net income

 

98,905

 

60,582

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

 

176

 

2,474

Repurchase and cancellation of shares of common stock as a result of a share repurchase program

(14,168)

(3,779)

Common cash dividends declared

 

(3,781)

 

(3,779)

Other *

 

3,022

 

2,944

Ending balance

$

677,010

$

593,793

*   Includes primarily common stock issued for options exercised and the employee stock purchase plans, as well as stock-based compensation.

On February 13, 2020, the Board of Directors of the Company approved a share repurchase program under which the Company is authorized to repurchase, from time to time as the Company deems appropriate, up to 800,000 shares of its outstanding common stock, or approximately 5% of the outstanding shares as of December 31, 2019. To date, the Company has purchased 394,085 shares under the program and all shares purchased have been retired.

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

Liquidity measures the ability of the Company to meet maturing obligations and its existing commitments, to withstand fluctuations in deposit levels, to fund its operations, and to provide for customers’ credit needs. The Company monitors liquidity risk through contingency planning stress testing on a regular basis. The Company seeks to avoid over concentration of funding sources and to establish and maintain contingent funding facilities that can be drawn upon if normal funding sources become unavailable. One source of liquidity is cash and short-term assets, such as interest-bearing deposits in other banks, cash and due from banks and federal funds sold, which averaged $178.7 million and $398.2 million during 2021 and 2020, respectively. The Company’s on balance sheet liquidity position can fluctuate based on short-term activity in deposits and loans.

The Federal Reserve Bank has provided a lending facility that will allow the Company, if desired, to obtain funding specifically for loans that the Company makes under the PPP, which will allow the Company to retain existing sources of liquidity for traditional operations. The Company has been able to access other available funding sources to address liquidity needs during the COVID-19 pandemic.

53

Table of Contents

The subsidiary banks have a variety of sources of short-term liquidity available to them, including federal funds purchased from correspondent banks, FHLB advances, wholesale structured repurchase agreements, brokered deposits, lines of credit, borrowing at the Federal Reserve Discount Window, sales of securities AFS, and loan/lease participations or sales. The Company also generates liquidity from the regular principal payments and prepayments made on its loan/lease portfolio, and on the regular monthly payments on its securities portfolio.

At December 31, 2021, the subsidiary banks had 31 lines of credit totaling $517.7 million, of which $61.7 million was secured and $456.0 million was unsecured. At December 31, 2021, all of the $517.7 million was available.

At December 31, 2020, the subsidiary banks had 28 lines of credit totaling $743.1 million, of which $287.1 million was secured and $456.0 million was unsecured. At December 31, 2020, all of the $743.1 million was available.

The Company maintains a $25.0 million secured revolving credit note with a variable interest rate and a maturity of June 30, 2022. At December 31, 2021, the full $25.0 million was available. See Note 11 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information.

Investing activities used cash of $411.8 million during 2021 compared to $704.5 million during 2020. Proceeds from calls, maturities, pay downs, and sales of securities were $195.7 million for 2021 compared to $138.9 million for 2020. Purchases of securities used cash of $173.2 million for 2021 compared to $356.1 million for 2020. The net increase in loans/leases used cash of $433.5 million for 2021 compared to $564.7 million for 2020.

Financing activities provided cash of $299.7 million for 2021 compared to $577.4 million for 2020. Net increases in deposits totaled $323.6 million for 2021 as compared to $716.9 million for 2020. Net short-term borrowings decreased $1.6 million for 2021 and decreased $8.0 million for 2020. In 2021 the Company used $5.0 million to prepay select subordinated notes. In 2020 the Company used $55.3 million to prepay select FHLB advances and $29.2 million to prepay brokered and public time deposits.  Short-term FHLB advances decreased $94.3 million in 2020.

Total cash provided by operating activities was $88.2 million for 2021 compared to $112.2 million for 2020.

Throughout its history, the Company has secured additional capital through various resources, including common and preferred stock and the issuance of trust preferred securities and subordinated notes.

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the subsidiary banks remained “well-capitalized” in accordance with regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking authorities. See Note 17 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for detail of the capital amounts and ratios for the Company and its subsidiary banks.

COMMITMENTS, CONTINGENCIES, CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS, AND OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

In the normal course of business, the subsidiary banks make various commitments and incur certain contingent liabilities that are not presented in the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements. The commitments and contingent liabilities include various guarantees, commitments to extend credit, and standby letters of credit.

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The subsidiary banks evaluate each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the banks upon extension of credit, is based upon management’s credit evaluation of the counterparty. Collateral held varies but may include accounts receivable, marketable securities, inventory, property, plant and equipment, and income-producing commercial properties.

Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the subsidiary banks to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Those guarantees are primarily issued to support public and private borrowing arrangements and, generally, have terms of one year or less. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The banks hold collateral, as described above, supporting those commitments if deemed necessary. In the event the customer does not perform in accordance with the terms of the

54

Table of Contents

agreement with the third party, the banks would be required to fund the commitments. The maximum potential amount of future payments the banks could be required to make is represented by the contractual amount. If the commitment is funded, the banks would be entitled to seek recovery from the customer. At December 31, 2021 and 2020, no amounts had been recorded as liabilities for the banks’ potential obligations under these guarantees.

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, commitments to extend credit aggregated $1.2 billion and $1.4 billion, respectively. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, standby letters of credit aggregated $21.7 million and $24.8 million, respectively. Management does not expect that all of these commitments will be funded.

Additional information regarding commitments, contingencies, and off-balance sheet arrangements is described in Note 19 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Company has various financial obligations, including contractual obligations and commitments, which may require future cash payments. The significant fixed and determinable contractual obligations to third parties are deposits without a stated maturity, certificates of deposit, short-term borrowings, subordinated notes, and junior subordinated debentures and totaled $5.1 billion as of December 31, 2021.

The Company’s operating contract obligations represent short and long-term contractual payments for data processing equipment and services, software, and other equipment and professional services and totaled $49.8 million as of December 31, 2021.

IMPACT OF INFLATION AND CHANGING PRICES

The Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company and the accompanying notes have been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP, which requires the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollar amounts without considering the changes in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation. The impact of inflation is reflected in the increased cost of the Company’s operations. Unlike industrial companies, nearly all of the assets and liabilities of the Company are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates have a greater impact on the Company’s performance than do the effects of general levels of inflation. Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction or to the same extent as the price of goods and services.

FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS

This document (including information incorporated by reference) contains, and future oral and written statements of the Company and its management may contain, forward-looking statements, within the meaning of such term in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, with respect to the financial condition, results of operations, plans, objectives, future performance and business of the Company. Forward-looking statements, which may be based upon beliefs, expectations and assumptions of the Company’s management and on information currently available to management, are generally identifiable by the use of words such as “believe,” “expect,” “anticipate,” “bode,” “predict,” “suggest,”  “project,” “appear,” “plan,” “intend,” “estimate,” “may,” “will,” “would,” “could,” “should,” “likely,” or other similar expressions. Additionally, all statements in this document, including forward-looking statements, speak only as of the date they are made, and the Company undertakes no obligation to update any statement in light of new information or future events.

The Company’s ability to predict results or the actual effect of future plans or strategies is inherently uncertain. The factors that could have a material adverse effect on the operations and future prospects of the Company and its subsidiaries are detailed in the “Risk Factors” section included under Item 1A. of Part I of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. In addition to the risk factors described in that section, there are other factors that could have a material adverse effect on the operations and future prospects of the Company and its subsidiaries. These additional factors include, but are not limited to, the following:

The strength of the local, state, national and international economies.

The economic impact of any future terrorist threats and attacks, widespread disease or pandemics (including the COVID-19 pandemic in the United States), acts of war or threats thereof and other adverse events that could cause economic deterioration or instability in credit markets, and the response of the local, state and national governments to any such adverse events.

55

Table of Contents

Changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by state and federal regulatory agencies, the FASB, the SEC or the PCAOB, including FASB’s CECL impairment standards.

Changes in state and federal laws, regulations and governmental policies concerning the Company’s general business.

Changes in the interest rates and prepayment rates of the Company’s assets (including the impact of LIBOR phase-out).

Increased competition in the financial services sector and the inability to attract new customers.

Changes in technology and the ability to develop and maintain secure and reliable electronic systems.

Unexpected results of acquisitions which may include failure to realize the anticipated benefits of the acquisitions and the possibility that transaction costs may be greater than anticipated.

The loss of key executives and employees.

Changes in consumer spending.

The costs, effects and outcomes of existing or future litigation.

Unexpected outcomes of existing or new litigation involving the Company.

The economic impact of exceptional weather occurrences such as tornadoes, floods and blizzards.

The ability of the Company to manage the risks associated with the foregoing as well as anticipated.

These risks and uncertainties should be considered in evaluating forward-looking statements and undue reliance should not be placed on such statements.

Item 7A.    Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

The Company, like other financial institutions, is subject to direct and indirect market risk. Direct market risk exists from changes in interest rates. The Company’s net income is dependent on its net interest income. Net interest income is susceptible to interest rate risk to the degree that interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice on a different basis than interest-earning assets. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly than interest-earning assets in a given period, a significant increase in market rates of interest could adversely affect net interest income. Similarly, when interest-earning assets mature or reprice more quickly than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates could result in a decrease in net interest income.

In an attempt to manage the Company’s exposure to changes in interest rates, management monitors the Company’s interest rate risk. Each subsidiary bank has an asset/liability management committee of its board of directors that meets quarterly to review the bank’s interest rate risk position and profitability, and to make or recommend adjustments, as necessary, for consideration by the full board of each bank.

Internal asset/liability management teams consisting of members of the subsidiary banks’ management meet bi-weekly to manage the mix of assets and liabilities to maximize earnings and liquidity and minimize interest rate and other risks. Management also reviews the subsidiary banks’ securities portfolios, formulates investment strategies, and oversees the timing and implementation of transactions to assure attainment of the board’s objectives in the most effective manner. Notwithstanding the Company’s interest rate risk management activities, the potential for changing interest rates is an uncertainty that can have an adverse effect on net income.

In adjusting the Company’s asset/liability position, the Board of Directors and management attempt to manage the Company’s interest rate risk while maintaining or enhancing net interest margins. At times, depending on the level of

56

Table of Contents

general interest rates, the relationship between long-term and short-term interest rates, market conditions and competitive factors, the Board of Directors and management may decide to increase the Company’s interest rate risk position somewhat in order to increase its net interest margin. The Company’s results of operations and net portfolio values remain vulnerable to increases in interest rates and to fluctuations in the difference between long-term and short-term interest rates.

One method used to quantify interest rate risk is a short-term earnings at risk summary, which is a detailed and dynamic simulation model used to quantify the estimated exposure of net interest income to sustained interest rate changes. This simulation model captures the impact of changing interest rates on the interest income received and interest expense paid on all interest sensitive assets and liabilities reflected on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. This sensitivity analysis demonstrates net interest income exposure annually over a five-year horizon, assuming no balance sheet growth, no balance sheet mix change, and various interest rate scenarios including no change in rates; 100, 200, 300 and 400 basis point upward shifts; and 100 and 200 basis point downward shifts in interest rates, where interest-bearing assets and liabilities reprice at their earliest possible repricing date.

The model assumes parallel and pro rata shifts in interest rates over a twelve-month period for the 200 basis point upward shift and 100 and 200 basis point downward shifts. For the 400 basis point upward shift, the model assumes a parallel and pro rata shift in interest rates over a twenty-four month period.

Further, in recent years, the Company added additional interest rate scenarios where interest rates experience a parallel and instantaneous shift (“shock”) upward of 100, 200, 300, and 400 basis points and a parallel and instantaneous  shock downward of 100 and 200 basis points. The Company will run additional interest rate scenarios on an as-needed basis.

The asset/liability management committees of the subsidiary bank boards of directors have established policy limits of a 10% decline in net interest income for the 200 basis point upward parallel shift and the 100 basis point downward parallel shift. For the 300 basis point upward shock, the established policy limit is a 25% decline in net interest income. The increased policy limit is appropriate as the shock scenario is extreme and unlikely and warrants a higher limit than the more realistic and traditional parallel/pro-rata shift scenarios.

Application of the simulation model analysis for select interest rate scenarios at December 31, 2021 and 2020 demonstrated the following:

NET INTEREST INCOME EXPOSURE in YEAR 1

    

    

As of December 31, 

    

As of December 31, 

    

INTEREST RATE SCENARIO

POLICY LIMIT

 

2021

 

2020

 

100 basis point downward shift

 

(10.0)

%  

(0.1)

%  

%  

200 basis point upward shift

 

(10.0)

%  

3.1

%  

2.5

%  

300 basis point upward shock

 

(30.0)

%  

11.6

%  

10.3

%  

The simulation is within the board-established policy limits for all three scenarios. Additionally, for all of the various interest rate scenarios modeled and measured by management (as described above), the results at December 31, 2021 were well within established risk tolerances as established by policy or by best practice (if the interest rate scenario didn’t have a specific policy limit).

Interest rate risk is considered to be one of the most significant market risks affecting the Company. For that reason, the Company engages the assistance of a national consulting firm and its risk management system to monitor and control the Company’s interest rate risk exposure.  Other types of market risk, such as foreign currency exchange rate risk and commodity price risk, do not arise in the normal course of the Company’s business activities.

57

Table of Contents

Item 8.    Financial Statements

QCR HOLDINGS, INC.

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (PCAOB ID: 49)

59

Financial Statements

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2021 and 2020

62

Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

63

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

64

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

65

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

66

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements:

    Note 1:  Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies

68

    Note 2:  Sales/Mergers/Acquisitions

85

    Note 3:  Investment Securities

87

    Note 4:  Loans/Leases Receivable

91

    Note 5:  Premises and Equipment

105

    Note 6:  Goodwill and Intangibles

107

    Note 7:  Derivatives and Hedging Activities

109

    Note 8:  Deposits

112

    Note 9:  Short-Term Borrowings

113

    Note 10: FHLB Advances

113

    Note 11: Other Borrowings and Unused Lines of Credit

114

    Note 12: Subordinated Notes

114

    Note 13: Junior Subordinated Debentures

115

    Note 14: Federal and State Income Taxes

117

    Note 15: Employee Benefit Plans

119

    Note 16: Stock-Based Compensation

120

    Note 17: Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Dividends

123

    Note 18: Earnings Per Share

125

    Note 19: Commitments and Contingencies

125

127

130

133

133

58

Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

 

To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of QCR Holdings, Inc.

 

 

Opinion on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of QCR Holdings, Inc. and its

subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders' equity and cash flows for each of the three

years in the period ended December 31, 2021, and the related notes to the consolidated financial

statements (collectively, the financial statements). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in

all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2021, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight

Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of

December 31, 2021, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by

the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013, and our report dated March 11, 2022 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control

over financial reporting.

 

Adoption of New Accounting Standard

As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company changed its method of accounting for credit losses on financial instruments in 2021 due to the adoption of Accounting Standards Update 2016-13, Financial Instruments—Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments (Credit Losses).

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public

accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the

Company in accordance with U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that

we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements

are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing

procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error

or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on

a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as

well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide

a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Critical Audit Matters

The critical audit matters communicated below are matters arising from the current period audit of the financial statements that were communicated or required to be communicated to the Audit Committee

and that: (1) relate to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and

(2) involved our especially challenging, subjective or complex judgments. The communication of critical

audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we

are not, by communicating the critical audit matters below, providing separate opinions on the critical

audit matters or on the accounts or disclosures to which they relate.

 

59

Table of Contents

Allowance for credit losses on loans and leases

As described in Notes 1 and 4 to the consolidated financial statements, the allowance for credit losses on loans and leases (allowance) totaled $78.7 million at December 31, 2021. On January 1, 2021, the

Company adopted ASU 2016-13, which changes the impairment model from an incurred loss model to an expected loss model. Under the expected loss model, the allowance is measured on a collective (pool)

basis when similar risk characteristics exist (general reserve). Loans that do not share similar risk characteristics are evaluated on an individual basis at the balance sheet date (specific reserve). At

December 31, 2021 the general reserve on loans and leases collectively evaluated for impairment totaled $76.2 million and the specific reserve on loans and leases individually evaluated totaled $2.5 million.

The measurement of the general reserve is based on relevant past events, including historical

experience, current conditions and reasonable and supportable forecasts that affect collectability. The Company’s reserve on collectively evaluated loans and leases includes a quantitative allowance based

upon estimates of losses over the life of the loans and leases that is calculated using an existing

probability of default and loss given default framework, as well as a qualitative component for factors not reflected in the historical loss experience. The qualitative component is determined based on an

assessment of internal and external influences on credit quality at the present time (qualitative factors), as well as a projection of the impact in the future (future factors). Qualitative factors of significant influence include the general economic environment in the Company’s markets, both locally and nationally, as well

as the impact of economic conditions on certain industries, the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, and

credit quality indicators. The Company’s future factors represent an estimate of forecasted economic conditions. The calculation also contemplates that the Company may not have sufficient information to

make reasonable and supportable forecasts for the entire life of the loans and leases, which would result

in a reversion to historical credit loss information. The evaluation of these qualitative factors and future

factors requires that management make significant judgments, which may significantly impact the

estimated allowance.

We identified the implementation of ASU 2016-13 and both the qualitative and future factors, applied to

the general reserve of the allowance as critical audit matters because auditing management’s

implementation of the new standard as well as auditing management’s determination of the qualitative

and future factors required significant auditor judgement as amounts determined by management rely on analysis that is highly subjective and includes significant estimation uncertainty.

Our audit procedures related to the implementation of ASU 2016-13 included the following, among others:

We obtained an understanding of the relevant controls related to implementation of the new

accounting guidance and tested such controls for design and operating effectiveness, including management’s review and approval of the methodology and assumptions in its model.

We evaluated the reasonableness of managements assumptions and methodology as well as model selection and validation over the implementation of ASU 2016-13.

We tested the completeness and accuracy of the data used in the initial calculations by management by agreeing the data to internal or external sources.

Our audit procedures related to the Company’s qualitative factors and future factors in the general

reserve included the following, among others:

We obtained an understanding of the relevant controls related to the qualitative and future factors of

the general reserve and tested such controls for design and operating effectiveness, including

controls relating to management’s review and approval of the qualitative and future factors and the underlying data used in determining those factors.

We tested management’s process and evaluated the reasonableness of their judgments and assumptions to develop the qualitative and future factors, which included:

oTesting the accuracy and relevancy of the data inputs used by management as a basis for the adjustments for qualitative and future factors by comparing to internal and external source data.

60

Table of Contents

oEvaluating the magnitude and directional consistency of the adjustments for such.

oEvaluating whether management’s conclusions were consistent with Company provided internal data and external, independently sourced data and agreeing the impact to the allowance calculation.

 

 

/s/ RSM US LLP

We have served as the Company's auditor since 1993.

Davenport, Iowa

March 11, 2022

 

61

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Balance Sheets

December 31, 2021 and 2020

December 31, 

December 31,

2021

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Assets

Cash and due from banks

$

37,490

$

61,329

Federal funds sold

 

12,370

 

9,080

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

75,292

 

86,596

Securities held to maturity, at amortized cost, net of allowance for credit losses

 

472,385

 

476,165

Securities available for sale, at fair value

 

337,830

 

361,966

Total securities

810,215

 

838,131

Loans receivable held for sale

 

3,828

 

3,758

Loans/leases receivable held for investment

 

4,676,304

 

4,247,371

Gross loans/leases receivable

 

4,680,132

 

4,251,129

Less allowance for credit losses

 

(78,721)

 

(84,376)

Net loans/leases receivable

 

4,601,411

 

4,166,753

 

  

 

  

Bank-owned life insurance

 

62,424

 

60,586

Premises and equipment, net

 

78,530

 

72,693

Restricted investment securities

 

19,353

 

18,103

Other real estate owned, net

 

 

20

Goodwill

 

74,066

 

74,066

Intangibles

 

9,349

 

11,381

Derivatives

222,220

222,757

Other assets

 

93,412

 

83,548

Total assets

$

6,096,132

$

5,705,043

 

  

 

  

Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity

 

  

 

  

Liabilities:

 

  

 

  

Deposits:

 

  

 

  

Noninterest-bearing

$

1,268,788

$

1,145,378

Interest-bearing

 

3,653,984

 

3,453,759

Total deposits

 

4,922,772

 

4,599,137

 

  

 

  

Short-term borrowings

 

3,800

 

5,430

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

15,000

 

15,000

Subordinated notes

113,850

118,691

Junior subordinated debentures

 

38,155

 

37,993

Derivatives

225,135

229,270

Other liabilities

 

100,410

 

105,729

Total liabilities

 

5,419,122

 

5,111,250

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Stockholders' Equity:

 

  

 

  

Preferred stock, $1 par value; shares authorized 250,000 December 2021 and December 2020 - no shares issued or outstanding

 

 

Common stock, $1 par value; shares authorized 20,000,000 December 2021 - 15,613,460 shares issued and outstanding December 2020 - 15,805,711 shares issued and outstanding

 

15,613

 

15,806

Additional paid-in capital

 

273,768

 

275,807

Retained earnings

 

386,077

 

300,804

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss):

 

 

Securities available for sale

 

5,925

 

9,008

Derivatives

(4,373)

(7,632)

Total stockholders' equity

 

677,010

 

593,793

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

$

6,096,132

$

5,705,043

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

62

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Income

Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Interest and dividend income:

Loans/leases, including fees

$

173,940

$

173,967

$

190,324

Securities:

Taxable

 

8,923

 

7,787

 

6,607

Nontaxable

 

16,167

 

14,900

 

13,858

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

173

 

669

 

3,910

Restricted investment securities

 

950

 

1,031

 

1,174

Federal funds sold

 

2

 

19

 

203

Total interest and dividend income

 

200,155

 

198,373

 

216,076

Interest expense:

Deposits

 

13,300

 

23,269

 

50,875

Short-term borrowings

 

5

 

84

 

363

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

70

 

1,087

 

2,894

Other borrowings

 

 

 

513

Subordinated notes

6,272

4,697

3,564

Junior subordinated debentures

 

2,275

 

2,286

 

2,308

Total interest expense

 

21,922

 

31,423

 

60,517

Net interest income

 

178,233

 

166,950

 

155,559

Provision for credit losses

 

3,486

 

55,704

 

7,066

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

 

174,747

 

111,246

 

148,493

Noninterest income:

Trust department fees

 

11,206

 

9,207

 

9,559

Investment advisory and management fees

 

4,080

 

5,318

 

6,995

Deposit service fees

 

6,132

 

6,041

 

6,812

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans, net

 

4,397

 

4,680

 

2,571

Gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans, net

 

227

 

224

 

748

Swap fee income/capital markets revenue

 

60,992

 

74,821

 

28,295

Securities gains (losses), net

 

(88)

 

2,484

 

(30)

Earnings on bank-owned life insurance

 

1,838

 

1,904

 

1,973

Debit card fees

 

4,216

 

3,402

 

3,357

Correspondent banking fees

 

1,114

 

903

 

773

Gain on sale of assets and liabilities of subsidiary

12,286

Other

 

6,308

 

4,814

 

5,429

Total noninterest income

 

100,422

 

113,798

 

78,768

Noninterest expense:

Salaries and employee benefits

 

100,907

 

96,268

 

92,063

Occupancy and equipment expense

 

15,918

 

16,504

 

15,106

Professional and data processing fees

 

14,579

 

14,644

 

13,381

Acquisition costs

 

624

 

 

Post-acquisition compensation, transition and integration costs

 

 

214

 

3,582

Disposition costs

13

690

3,325

FDIC insurance, other insurance and regulatory fees

 

4,475

 

4,164

 

2,955

Loan/lease expense

 

1,671

 

1,435

 

1,097

Net income from and gains/losses on operations of other real estate

 

(1,420)

 

(307)

 

3,789

Advertising and marketing

 

4,254

 

3,260

 

4,548

Bank service charges

 

2,173

 

2,016

 

2,009

Losses on liability extinguishment

 

 

3,907

 

436

Correspondent banking expense

 

799

 

838

 

836

Intangibles amortization

 

2,032

 

2,149

 

2,266

Goodwill impairment

500

3,000

Loss on sale of subsidiary

158

Other

 

7,677

 

5,315

 

6,841

Total noninterest expense

 

153,702

 

151,755

 

155,234

Net income before income taxes

 

121,467

 

73,289

 

72,027

Federal and state income tax expense

 

22,562

 

12,707

 

14,619

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

$

57,408

Basic earnings per common share

$

6.30

$

3.84

$

3.65

Diluted earnings per common share

$

6.20

$

3.80

$

3.60

Weighted average common shares outstanding

 

15,708,744

 

15,771,650

 

15,730,016

Weighted average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

 

15,944,708

 

15,952,637

 

15,967,775

Cash dividends declared per common share

$

0.24

$

0.24

$

0.24

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

63

Table of Contents

QCR HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

$

57,408

Other comprehensive income:

Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale:

Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the period before tax

 

(4,158)

 

10,657

 

8,761

Less reclassification adjustment for gains (losses) included in net income before tax

(88)

2,484

(30)

 

(4,070)

 

8,173

 

8,791

Unrealized gains (losses) on derivatives:

Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the period before tax

 

3,427

 

(6,854)

 

(3,806)

Less reclassification adjustment for unhedging caplet

(649)

Less reclassification adjustment for swap termination

(792)

Less reclassification adjustment for caplet amortization before tax

(697)

(551)

 

4,124

 

(4,862)

 

(3,806)

Unrealized gains on assets held for sale:

Unrealized holding gains arising during the period before tax on securities held for sale

587

Less realized holding gains on securities sold

(61)

Unrealized holding losses arising during the period before tax on derivatives held for sale

(446)

Less reclassification adjustment for caplet ineffectiveness before tax

422

Less realized holding losses on derivatives sold

392

894

Other comprehensive income, before tax

 

54

 

3,311

 

5,879

Tax expense (benefit)

 

(122)

 

837

 

1,433

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

 

176

 

2,474

 

4,446

Comprehensive income

$

99,081

$

63,056

$

61,854

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

64

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity

Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

Accumulated

Additional

Other

Common

Paid-In

Retained

Comprehensive

    

Stock

    

Capital

    

Earnings

    

(Loss) Income

    

Total

(dollars in thousands)

Balance December 31, 2018

$

15,718

$

270,761

$

192,203

$

(5,544)

$

473,138

Net income

 

 

 

57,408

 

 

57,408

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

 

 

 

 

4,446

 

4,446

Issuance of 9,400 shares of common stock as a result of the acquisition of the Bates Companies

9

390

399

Impact of adoption of ASU 2016-13

 

 

 

 

 

Common cash dividends declared, $0.24 per share

 

 

 

(3,775)

 

 

(3,775)

Stock-based compensation expense

 

 

2,469

 

 

 

2,469

Issuance of common stock under employee benefit plans

 

101

 

1,165

 

 

 

1,266

Balance, December 31, 2019

$

15,828

$

274,785

$

245,836

$

(1,098)

$

535,351

Net income

 

 

 

60,582

 

 

60,582

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

 

 

 

 

2,474

 

2,474

Common cash dividends declared, $0.24 per share

 

 

 

(3,779)

 

 

(3,779)

Repurchase and cancellation of 100,932 shares of common stock

as a result of a share repurchase program

(101)

(1,843)

(1,835)

(3,779)

Stock-based compensation expense

 

2,150

 

 

 

2,150

Issuance of common stock under employee benefit plans

 

79

 

714

 

 

 

794

Balance, December 31, 2020

$

15,806

$

275,807

$

300,804

$

1,376

$

593,793

Impact of adoption of ASU 2016-13

(937)

(937)

Net income

 

 

 

98,905

 

 

98,905

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

 

 

 

 

176

 

176

Repurchase and cancellation of 293,153 shares of common stock

 

 

 

 

 

as a result of a share repurchase program

(293)

(4,961)

(8,914)

(14,168)

Common cash dividends declared, $0.24 per share

 

 

 

(3,781)

 

 

(3,781)

Stock-based compensation expense

 

2,352

 

 

 

2,352

Issuance of common stock under employee benefit plans

 

100

 

570

 

 

 

670

Balance, December 31, 2021

$

15,613

$

273,768

$

386,077

$

1,552

$

677,010

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

65

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES

  

 

  

 

  

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

$

57,408

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Depreciation

 

5,359

 

5,333

 

5,225

Provision for credit losses

 

3,486

 

55,704

 

7,066

Deferred income taxes

 

15,272

 

(14,530)

 

6,364

Stock-based compensation expense

 

2,352

 

2,150

 

2,469

Deferred compensation expense accrued

 

4,580

 

3,821

 

2,773

(Gains) losses on other real estate owned, net

 

(1,754)

 

(317)

 

3,361

Amortization of premiums on securities, net

 

1,933

 

969

 

1,561

Caplet amortization

697

551

Mark to market gains on unhedged derivatives, net

(170)

Securities (gains) losses, net

 

88

 

(2,484)

 

30

Loans originated for sale

 

(204,449)

 

(236,734)

 

(151,692)

Proceeds on sales of loans

 

209,003

 

241,553

 

152,633

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans

 

(4,397)

 

(4,680)

 

(2,571)

Gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans

 

(227)

 

(224)

 

(748)

Loss on liability extinguishment, net

3,907

436

Losses (gains) on sales and disposals of premises and equipment

1,059

(19)

753

Amortization of intangibles

 

2,032

 

2,149

 

2,266

Accretion of acquisition fair value adjustments, net

 

(1,340)

 

(3,271)

 

(4,344)

Increase in cash value of bank-owned life insurance

 

(1,838)

 

(1,904)

 

(1,973)

Loss (gain) on sale of subsidiary/certain assets and liabilities of subsidiary

158

(12,286)

Goodwill impairment

500

3,000

Increase in other assets

 

(47,006)

 

(9,445)

 

(19,152)

Increase in other liabilities

4,633

8,408

23,915

Net cash provided by operating activities

88,218

112,177

76,494

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES

 

  

 

  

 

  

Net decrease (increase) in federal funds sold

 

(3,290)

 

720

 

16,598

Net decrease (increase) in interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

11,304

 

61,295

 

(69,984)

Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned

 

4,742

 

4,477

 

840

Activity in securities portfolio:

 

 

 

Purchases

 

(173,204)

 

(356,127)

 

(71,963)

Calls, maturities and redemptions

 

106,442

 

53,007

 

25,193

Paydowns

 

65,410

 

47,313

 

50,830

Sales

 

23,874

 

38,562

 

30,055

Activity in restricted investment securities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Purchases

 

(1,280)

 

(4,600)

 

(5,859)

Redemptions

 

30

 

9,749

 

7,621

Proceeds from the liquidation of bank-owned life insurance

10,999

Net increase in loans/leases originated and held for investment

 

(433,544)

 

(564,748)

 

(320,368)

Purchase of premises and equipment

 

(13,981)

 

(4,268)

 

(12,429)

Proceeds from sales of premises and equipment

1,726

101

2,562

Purchase of derivatives

(4,347)

Payment for termination of derivative

(808)

Net cash (transferred out) transferred in sale of subsidiary

(154)

42,587

Net cash used in investing activities

(411,771)

(704,482)

(308,664)

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES

 

  

 

  

 

  

Net increase in deposit accounts

 

323,635

 

716,898

 

335,580

Net decrease in short-term borrowings

 

(1,630)

 

(7,993)

 

(14,193)

Activity in Federal Home Loan Bank advances:

 

 

 

  

Term advances

 

 

125,000

 

25,000

Calls and maturities

 

 

(121,600)

 

(35,000)

Net change in short-term and overnight advances

 

 

(94,300)

 

(52,465)

Prepayments

 

 

(55,274)

 

(30,323)

Activity in other borrowings:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Calls, maturities and scheduled principal payments

 

 

 

(11,937)

Prepayments

 

 

 

(46,313)

Paydown of revolving line of credit

 

 

 

(9,000)

Prepayments on brokered and public time deposits

(29,153)

Prepayments of subordinated notes

(5,000)

Proceeds from subordinated notes

50,000

63,393

Payment of cash dividends on common stock

 

(3,793)

 

(3,779)

 

(3,767)

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net

670

1,360

1,926

Repurchase and cancellation of shares

(14,168)

(3,779)

Net cash provided by financing activities

 

299,714

 

577,380

 

222,901

Net decrease in cash and due from banks

 

(23,839)

 

(14,925)

 

(9,269)

Cash and due from banks, beginning

 

61,329

 

76,254

 

85,523

Cash and due from banks, ending

$

37,490

$

61,329

$

76,254

66

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries - Continued

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

2021

    

2020

    

2019

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information, cash payments for:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Interest

$

23,373

$

32,178

$

59,292

Income/franchise taxes

 

48,988

 

24,567

 

2,719

 

  

 

  

 

  

Supplemental schedule of noncash investing activities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Change in accumulated other comprehensive income, unrealized losses on securities available for sale and derivative instruments, net

 

176

 

2,474

 

4,446

Change in retained earnings from adoption of ASU 2016-13

(937)

Transfers of loans to other real estate owned

 

2,962

 

51

 

1,086

Due to broker for purchases of securities

 

1,000

 

 

Increase (decrease) in the fair value of back-to-back interest rate swap assets and liabilities

 

(1,376)

 

137,752

 

62,483

Dividends payable

 

935

 

947

 

947

Consideration received on sale of the Bates Companies

1,523

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information for sale of subsidiary/certain assets and certain liabilities of subsidiary:

Cash proceeds**

$

$

195

$

46,560

Assets Sold:

Cash and due from banks

$

$

349

$

3,973

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

55,291

Securities held to maturity, at amortized cost

3,243

Securities available for sale, at fair value

21,874

Loans/leases receivable held for investment, net

357,931

Premises and equipment, net

19

5,612

Restricted investment securities

675

Other real estate owned, net

2,134

Other assets

2,259

3,228

Total assets sold

$

$

2,627

$

453,961

Liabilities Sold:

Noninterest-bearing deposits

$

$

$

69,802

Interest-bearing deposits

331,486

Short-term borrowings

1,158

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

15,000

Other liabilities

946

2,241

Total liabilities sold

$

$

946

$

419,687

Net Assets Sold

$

1,681

34,274

Forgiveness of earn-out consideration

$

$

880

$

Note receivable consideration

448

Gain (loss) on sale of subsidiary and certain assets and certain liabilities of subsidiary:

$

$

(158)

$

12,286

**Net cash paid at closing totaled $42.6 million for the sale of certain assets and certain liabilities of RB&T in 2019.

**Net cash transferred at closing totaled $154 thousand for the sale of the Bates Companies in 2020.

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

67

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

able of Contents

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies

Basis of presentation:

The acronyms and abbreviations identified below are used in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, as well as in the other sections of this Annual Report on Form 10-K (including appendices). It may be helpful to refer back to this page as you read this report.

ACL: Allowance for credit losses

AFS: Available for sale

HTM: Held to maturity

Allowance: Allowance for credit losses

Iowa Superintendent: Iowa Superintendent of Banking

AOCI: Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

LCR: Liquidity Coverage Ratio

ARRC: Alternative Reference Rate Committee

LIBOR: London Inter-Bank Offered Rate

ASC: Accounting Standards Codification

LIHTC: Low-income housing tax credit

ASC 805: Business Combination Standard

LRP: Loan Relief Program

ASU: Accounting Standards Update

m2: m2 Equipment Finance, LLC

Bates Companies: Bates Financial Advisors, Inc., Bates

MD&A: Management’s Discussion & Analysis

Financial Services, Inc., Bates Securities, Inc. and Bates

Missouri Division of Finance: Missouri Department of

Financial Group, Inc.

Commerce and Insurance

BHCA: Bank Holding Company Act of 1956

NIM: Net interest margin

BOLI: Bank-owned life insurance

NPA: Nonperforming asset

Caps: Interest rate cap derivatives

NPL: Nonperforming loan

CARES Act: Coronavirus Aid, Relief and Economy Security

Act

CECL: Current Expected Credit Losses

CFPB: Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection

NSFR: Net Stable Funding Ratio

OBS: Off-balance sheet

OREO: Other real estate owned

OTTI: Other-than-temporary impairment

CNB: Community National Bank

PCAOB: Public Company Accounting Oversight Board

Community National: Community National Bancorporation

COVID-19: Coronavirus Disease 2019

CRA: Community Reinvestment Act

PCD: Purchased credit deteriorated loan

PCI: Purchased credit impaired

PPP: Paycheck Protection Program

CRBT: Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust Company

Provision: Provision for credit losses

CRE: Commercial real estate

PUD LOC: Public Unit Deposit Letter of Credit

CRE Guidance: Interagency Concentrations in Commercial

QCBT: Quad City Bank & Trust Company

Real Estate Lending, Sound Risk Management Practices

RB&T: Rockford Bank & Trust Company

guidance

ROAA: Return on Average Assets

CSB: Community State Bank

ROACE: Return on Average Common Equity

C&I: Commercial and industrial

ROAE: Return on Average Equity

Dodd-Frank Act: Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and

ROU: Right of use

Consumer Protection Act

SBA: U.S. Small Business Administration

DGCL: Delaware General Corporation Law

SEC: Securities and Exchange Commission

DIF: Deposit Insurance Fund

SERPs: Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans

EBA: Excess Balance Account

SFCB: Springfield First Community Bank

EPS: Earnings per share

SFG: Specialty Finance Group

ESG: Environmental, Social and Governance

SOFR: Secured Overnight Financing Rate

Exchange Act: Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended

Springfield Bancshares: Springfield Bancshares, Inc.

FASB: Financial Accounting Standards Board

TA: Tangible assets

FDIC: Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation

TCE: Tangible common equity

Federal Reserve: Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve

TDRs: Troubled debt restructurings

System

TEY: Tax equivalent yield

FHLB: Federal Home Loan Bank

The Company: QCR Holdings, Inc.

FRB: Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago

TRBC: Total risk-based capital

FTEs: Full-time equivalents

Treasury: U.S. Department of the Treasury

GAAP: Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

USA Patriot Act: Uniting and Strengthening America by

GFED: Guaranty Federal Bancshares

Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept

Goldman Sachs: Goldman Sachs and Company

and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001

Guaranty: Guaranty Bankshares, Ltd.

USDA: U.S. Department of Agriculture

Guaranty Bank: Guaranty Bank and Trust Company

68

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Nature of business:

QCR Holdings, Inc. is a bank holding company that has elected to operate as a financial holding company under the BHCA. The Company provides bank and bank-related services through its banking subsidiaries, QCBT, CRBT, CSB and SFCB. The Company also engages in direct financing lease contracts through its wholly-owned equity investment by QCBT in m2, headquartered in Brookfield, Wisconsin.  The Company also engages in wealth management services through its banking subsidiaries.

On August 12, 2020, the Company sold the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiaries, the Bates Companies, which were originally acquired on October 1, 2018. On November 30, 2019, the Company sold substantially all of the assets and transferred substantially all of the deposits and certain other liabilities of the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiary, RB&T.  The financial results of the Bates Companies and RB&T prior to their respective sales are included in this report.  See Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information.

QCBT is a commercial bank that serves the Iowa and Illinois Quad Cities and adjacent communities. CRBT is a commercial bank that serves Cedar Rapids, Iowa, and adjacent communities including Cedar Falls and Waterloo, Iowa. CSB is a commercial bank that serves Des Moines, Iowa, and adjacent communities. SFCB is a commercial bank that serves Springfield, Missouri.

QCBT, CRBT, and CSB are chartered and regulated under the laws of the state of Iowa. SFCB is chartered and regulated under the laws of the state of Missouri. All four subsidiary banks are insured and subject to regulation by the FDIC.  All four subsidiary banks are members of and regulated by the Federal Reserve System.  

The remaining direct subsidiaries of the Company consist of a consolidated subsidiary formed during 2021 for the risk management of insurance and six non-consolidated subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities. See Note 13 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a listing of these subsidiaries and additional information.

Significant accounting policies:

Accounting estimates: The preparation of financial statements, in conformity with GAAP, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the determination of the allowance, impairment of goodwill, fair value of financial instruments, and the fair value of securities.

Principles of consolidation: The accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements include the accounts of the Company and its subsidiaries, except those six subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities which do not meet the criteria for consolidation. All material intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

Presentation of cash flows: For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and due from banks include cash on hand and noninterest bearing amounts due from banks. Cash flows from federal funds sold, interest bearing deposits at financial institutions, loans/leases, deposits, short-term borrowings and overnight and short-term FHLB advances are treated as net increases or decreases.

69

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Cash and due from banks: The subsidiary banks are required by federal banking regulations to maintain certain cash and due from bank reserves. There was no reserve requirement as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Investment securities: Investment securities HTM are those debt securities that the Company has the ability and intent to hold until maturity regardless of changes in market conditions, liquidity needs, or changes in general economic conditions. Such securities are carried at cost, net of ACL, adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts.  If the ability or intent to hold to maturity is not present for certain specified securities, such securities are considered AFS as the Company intends to hold them for an indefinite period of time but not necessarily to maturity. Any decision to sell a security classified as AFS would be based on various factors, including movements in interest rates, changes in the maturity mix of the Company’s assets and liabilities, liquidity needs, regulatory capital considerations, and other factors. Securities AFS are carried at fair value. Unrealized gains or losses, net of taxes, are reported as increases or decreases in AOCI. Realized gains or losses, determined on the basis of the cost of specific securities sold, are included in earnings.

All debt securities are evaluated to determine whether declines in fair value below their amortized cost require an allowance.  See further discussion in the Allowance section following.

Loans receivable, held for sale: Residential real estate loans which are originated and intended for resale in the secondary market in the foreseeable future are classified as held for sale. These loans are carried at the lower of cost or estimated market value in the aggregate. As assets specifically acquired for resale, the origination of, disposition of, and gain/loss on these loans are classified as operating activities in the statement of cash flows.

Loans receivable, held for investment: Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future, or until pay-off or maturity occurs, are classified as held for investment. These loans are reported at amortized cost, net of the ACL.  Amortized cost is the amount of unpaid principal adjusted for charge-offs, any discounts or premiums, and any deferred fees and/or costs on originated loans.  Accrued interest receivable totaled $15 million at December 31, 2021 and was reported in other assets on the consolidated balance sheet.  Interest is credited to earnings as earned based on the principal amount outstanding. Deferred direct loan origination fees and/or costs are amortized as an adjustment of the related loan’s yield. As assets held for and used in the production of services, the origination and collection of these loans are classified as investing activities in the statement of cash flows.

The ACL is measured on a collective (pool) basis when similar risk characteristics exist.  The Company discloses the ACL (also known as the allowance) by portfolio segment, and credit quality information, nonaccrual status, and past due status by class of financing receivable. A portfolio segment is the level at which the Company develops and documents a systematic methodology to determine its ACL. A class of financing receivable is a further disaggregation of a portfolio segment based on risk characteristics and the Company’s method for monitoring and assessing credit risk. See the following information and Note 4 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Company’s portfolio segments are as follows:

C&I – revolving
C&I - other
CRE – owner occupied
CRE – non-owner occupied
Construction and land development
Multi-family
1-4 family real estate
Consumer

70

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

The Company’s classes of loans receivable are as follows:

C&I – revolving
C&I - other
CRE – owner occupied
CRE – non-owner occupied
Construction and land development
Multi-family
Direct financing leases
1-4 family real estate
Consumer

Direct financing leases are considered a class of financing receivable within the overall loan/lease portfolio and are included in the C&I – other loan segments for ACL. The accounting policies for direct financing leases are disclosed below.

Generally, for all classes of loans receivable, loans are considered past due when contractual payments are delinquent for 30 days or greater.

For all classes of loans receivable, loans will generally be placed on nonaccrual status when the loan has become 90 days past due (unless the loan is well secured and in the process of collection); or if any of the following conditions exist:

It becomes evident that the borrower will not make payments, or will not or cannot meet the terms for renewal of a matured loan;
When full repayment of principal and interest is not expected;
When the loan is graded “doubtful”
When the borrower files bankruptcy and an approved plan of reorganization or liquidation is not anticipated in the near future; or
When foreclosure action is initiated.

When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, income recognition is ceased. Previously recorded but uncollected amounts of interest on nonaccrual loans are reversed at the time the loan is placed on nonaccrual status. Generally, cash collected on nonaccrual loans is applied to principal. Should full collection of principal be expected, cash collected on nonaccrual loans can be recognized as interest income.

For all classes of loans receivable, nonaccrual loans may be restored to accrual status provided the following criteria are met:

The loan is current, and all principal and interest amounts contractually due have been made;
All principal and interest amounts contractually due, including past due payments, are reasonably assured of repayment within a reasonable period; and
There is a period of minimum repayment performance, as follows, by the borrower in accordance with contractual terms:

o

Six months of repayment performance for contractual monthly payments, or

o

One year of repayment performance for contractual quarterly or semi-annual payments.

71

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Direct finance leases receivable, held for investment: The Company leases machinery and equipment to customers under leases that qualify as direct financing leases for financial reporting and as operating leases for income tax purposes. Under the direct financing method of accounting, the minimum lease payments to be received under the lease contract, together with the estimated unguaranteed residual values (approximately 3% to 25% of the cost of the related equipment), are recorded as lease receivables when the lease is signed and the lease property delivered to the customer. The excess of the minimum lease payments and residual values over the cost of the equipment is recorded as unearned lease income. Unearned lease income is recognized over the term of the lease on a basis that results in an approximate level rate of return on the unrecovered lease investment.

Lease income is recognized on the interest method. Residual value is the estimated fair market value of the equipment on lease at lease termination. In estimating the equipment’s fair value at lease termination, the Company relies on historical experience by equipment type and manufacturer and, where available, valuations by independent appraisers, adjusted for known trends.

The Company’s estimates are reviewed continuously to ensure reasonableness; however, the amounts the Company will ultimately realize could differ from the estimated amounts. If the review results in a lower estimate than had been previously established, a determination is made as to whether the decline in estimated residual value is other-than-temporary. If the decline in estimated unguaranteed residual value is judged to be other-than-temporary, the accounting for the transaction is revised using the changed estimate. The resulting reduction in the investment is recognized as a loss in the period in which the estimate is changed. An upward adjustment of the estimated residual value is not recorded.

The policies for delinquency and nonaccrual for direct financing leases are materially consistent with those described above for all classes of loan receivables.

TDRs: TDRs exist when the Company, for economic or legal reasons related to the borrower’s/lessee’s financial difficulties, grants a concession (either imposed by court order, law, or agreement between the borrower/lessee and the Company) to the borrower/lessee that it would not otherwise consider. The Company attempts to maximize its recovery of the balances of the loans/leases through these various concessionary restructurings.

The following criteria, related to granting a concession, together or separately, create a TDR:

A modification of terms of a debt such as one or a combination of:

o

The reduction of the stated interest rate to a rate lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk.

o

The extension of the maturity date or dates at a stated interest rate lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk.

o

The reduction of the face amount or maturity amount of the debt as stated in the instrument or other agreement.

o

The reduction of accrued interest.

A transfer from the borrower/lessee to the Company of receivables from third parties, real estate, other assets, or an equity position in the borrower to fully or partially satisfy a loan.
The issuance or other granting of an equity position to the Company to fully or partially satisfy a debt unless the equity position is granted pursuant to existing terms for converting the debt into an equity position.

72

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Allowance:

Allowance for Credit Losses on Loans and Leases

The ACL on loans/leases is measured on a collective (pool) basis when similar risk characteristics exist.  The Company has identified the eight portfolio segments at which the allowance will be measured.  For all portfolio segments, the allowance is established as losses are estimated to have occurred through a provision that is charged to earnings. Credit losses on loans and leases, for all portfolio segments, are charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectability of a loan/lease balance is confirmed. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance.

The Company’s methodologies for estimating the ACL consider available relevant information about the collectability of cash flows, including information about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts.  The methodologies apply historical loss information adjusted for asset-specific characteristics, economic conditions at the measurement date, and forecasts about future economic conditions that are expected to exist through the contractual lives of the financial assets and that are reasonable and supportable – to the identified pools of financial assets with similar risk characteristics for which the historical loss experience was observed.  The Company will immediately and fully revert back to average historical losses when it can no longer develop reasonable and supportable forecasts.

A discussion of the risk characteristics and the allowance by each portfolio segment follows:

For C&I loans, the Company focuses on small and mid-sized businesses with primary operations as wholesalers, manufacturers, building contractors, business services companies, other banks, and retailers. The Company provides a wide range of C&I loans, including lines of credit for working capital and operational purposes, and term loans for the acquisition of facilities, equipment and other purposes. Approval is generally based on the following factors:

Ability and stability of current management of the borrower;
Stable earnings with positive financial trends;
Sufficient cash flow to support debt repayment;
Earnings projections based on reasonable assumptions;
Financial strength of the industry and business; and
Value and marketability of collateral.

Collateral for C&I loans generally includes accounts receivable, inventory and equipment. The Company’s lending policy specifies approved collateral types and corresponding maximum advance percentages. The value of collateral pledged on loans must exceed the loan amount by a margin sufficient to absorb potential erosion of its value in the event of foreclosure and cover the loan amount plus costs incurred to convert it to cash.

The Company’s lending policy specifies maximum term limits for C&I loans. For term loans, the maximum term is generally seven years with average terms ranging from three to five years. For lines of credit, the maximum term is generally 365 days.

In addition, the Company often takes personal guarantees or cosigners to help assure repayment. Loans may be made on an unsecured basis if warranted by the overall financial condition of the borrower.

CRE is segmented into the following categories generally based on source of repayment: Owner occupied CRE, non-owner occupied CRE and multi-family.  CRE loans are also embedded in the following segments: construction and land development and 1-4 family real estate.  The Company is an active lender of LIHTC project loans which includes both the construction and permanent loan. CRE loans are subject to underwriting standards and processes similar

73

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

to C&I loans, in addition to those standards and processes specific to real estate loans. Collateral for CRE loans generally includes the underlying real estate and improvements, and may include additional assets of the borrower. The Company’s lending policy specifies maximum loan-to-value limits based on the category of CRE (CRE loans on improved property, raw land, land development, and commercial construction). These limits are the same limits, or in some situations, more conservative than those established by regulatory authorities.

Multi-family loans are typically repaid from rental income. LIHTC permanent loans are included in multi-family loans and the maximum term is generally up to 20 years.

The Company’s lending policy also includes guidelines for real estate appraisals, including minimum appraisal standards based on certain transactions. In addition, the Company often takes personal guarantees to help assure repayment.

Construction loans include any loans to finance the construction of any new residential property, CRE property, low-income housing project or major rehabilitation or expansion of existing commercial structures.  Construction lending carries a higher degree of risk because of the difficulty of protecting the bank against various factors.  The following components are evaluated when underwriting these types of loans:

Borrowers/contractors experience and ability is analyzed with the type and size of project being considered.
Financial ability to cover cost overruns.
Reliability and thoroughness of cost projections and reasonable assurance that significant provisions are made for contingencies for soft costs especially interest and operating deficits.
Reliability of the estimate of time to complete the project.

The land development portfolio also includes other land loans such as raw land.  The raw land component involves considerable risk to the bank and is reserved for the bank’s most credit worthy borrowers.  Land development loans are typically only made to experienced local developers with successful track records.

For all loans the allowance consists of pooled and individually analyzed components.  Pooled loan allowances consist of quantitative and qualitative factors and cover loan classes that share similar risk characteristics with other assets in the segmented pool.

Quantitative Factors:

The quantitative factors are based on the probability of default and loss given default derived from historical net charge-off experience, repayment activity and default, remaining life, and current economic conditions as well as economic outlook.

Qualitative Factors:

The Company’s allowance methodology also has a qualitative component, the purpose of which is to take into consideration changes in current conditions that are not reflected in the quantitative analysis performed in determining its base credit loss rates.

The Company utilizes the following qualitative factors:

National and local economy
Loan volume and trend
Loan quality

74

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Loan policies and procedures
Management and staff experience
Concentrations
Collateral
Loan review system
Regulatory environment and oversight

The Company also provides for unique circumstances with qualitative adjustments as needed.  The Company has been providing a separate qualitative allocation for the COVID-19 pandemic since the second quarter of 2020. The qualitative adjustments are based on the current conditions and applied as a percentage adjustment in addition to the calculated historical loss rates.  The adjustment amount can be either positive or negative.  These adjustments reflect the extent to which the Company expects current conditions to differ from the conditions that existed for the period over which historical information was evaluated.

Economic forecasting:

The Company uses reasonable and supportable forecasts over the contractual term of the financial assets for each entity.  This measurement is based upon relevant past events, historical experience and current conditions to determine the forecasted data which requires significant judgement.  When management no longer has sufficient information to make a reasonable and supportable forecast, the data will then immediately revert back to the average historical performance for each entity.  These forecasted adjustments are added to the qualitative adjustments and applied as a percentage adjustment in addition to the historical loss rates.

It is expected that actual economic conditions will, in many circumstances, turn out differently than forecasted because the ultimate outcomes during the forecast period may be affected by events that were unforeseen, such as, but not limited to, economic disruption and fiscal or monetary policy actions, which are exacerbated by longer forecasting periods.  This uncertainty would be relevant to the entity’s confidence level as to the outcomes being forecasted.  That is, an entity is likely less confident in the ultimate outcome of events that will occur at the end of the forecast period as compared to the beginning.  As a result, actual future economic conditions may not be an effective indicator of the quality of the Company’s forecasting process, including the length of the forecast period.

Loans are determined to no longer share similar risk characteristics with other assets in the segmented pool when their scheduled payments of principal and interest according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement, have a greater probability of uncollectability based on current information and events.  Such events include past due status of 90 days

or more, non-accrual status or classification of a substandard or doubtful risk rating.

Factors considered by management in determining risk rating and non-accrual status include payment status, collateral value, and the probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due.  Loans that experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not considered low quality.  Management determines the significance of payment delays and payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan and the borrower, including the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower’s prior payment record, and the amount of the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed.  Allowances for these low quality loans with outstanding principal balances greater than $250,000 are measured on a case-by-case basis by either the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, the loan’s obtainable market price, or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent.

75

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Low quality loans with principal balances equal to or less than $250,000 are placed into a unique pool and have the overall effective loss rate for that period applied to this low quality pool.  However, should an asset within the low quality pool no longer have the same risk characteristic of the unique pool, it will be removed and individually analyzed as described above.

Some loans that are determined to no longer share risk characteristics with other assets in the segmented pool, may be deemed collateral dependent.  A financial asset is collateral-dependent when the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and repayment is expected to be provided substantially through the sale or operation of the collateral.  When

it is determined that foreclosure is probable, the collateral’s fair value is used to estimate the financial assets expected credit losses for the current reporting period.  This fair value is then reduced by the present value of estimated costs to sell.  If it is determined that the asset is collateral-dependent but foreclosure is not probable, an institution can elect

to apply the practical expedient to use the collateral’s fair value to estimate the asset’s expected credit loss.  The Company is choosing to utilize the practical expedient.  When using the practical expedient on a collateral dependent

loan where repayment is reliant upon the sale of the collateral, the fair value of that collateral will be adjusted for estimated costs to sell.  However, if the repayment is dependent on the operations of the company, the fair market value less estimated cost to sell cannot be used.  Thus, the net present value of the cash-flow will be utilized.

For non-homogenous loans, the Company utilizes the following internal risk rating scale:

1.Highest Quality (Pass) – loans of the highest quality with no credit risk, including those fully secured by subsidiary bank certificates of deposit and U.S. government securities.
2.Superior Quality (Pass) – loans with very strong credit quality. Borrowers have exceptionally strong earnings, liquidity, capital, cash flow coverage, and management ability. Includes loans secured by high quality marketable securities, certificates of deposit from other institutions, and cash value of life insurance. Also includes loans supported by U.S. government, state, or municipal guarantees.
3.Satisfactory Quality (Pass) – loans with satisfactory credit quality. Established borrowers with satisfactory financial condition, including credit quality, earnings, liquidity, capital and cash flow coverage. Management is capable and experienced. Collateral coverage and guarantor support, if applicable, are more than adequate. Includes loans secured by personal assets and business assets, including equipment, accounts receivable, inventory, and real estate.
4.Fair Quality (Pass) – loans with moderate but still acceptable credit quality. The primary repayment source remains adequate; however, management’s ability to maintain consistent profitability is unproven or uncertain. Borrowers exhibit acceptable leverage and liquidity. May include new businesses with inexperienced management or unproven performance records in relation to peer, or borrowers operating in highly cyclical or declining industries.
5.Early Warning (Pass) – loans where the borrowers have generally performed as agreed, however unfavorable financial trends exist or are anticipated. Earnings may be erratic, with marginal cash flow or declining sales. Borrowers reflect leveraged financial condition and/or marginal liquidity. Management may be new and a track record of performance has yet to be developed. Financial information may be incomplete, and reliance on secondary repayment sources may be increasing.
6.Special Mention – loans where the borrowers exhibit credit weaknesses or unfavorable financial trends requiring close monitoring. Weaknesses and adverse trends are more pronounced than Early Warning loans, and if left uncorrected, may jeopardize repayment according to the contractual terms. Currently, no loss of principal or interest is expected. Borrowers in this category have deteriorated to the point that it would be difficult to refinance with another lender. Special Mention should be assigned to borrowers in turnaround

76

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

situations. This rating is intended as a transitional rating, therefore, it is generally not assigned to a borrower for a period of more than one year.

7.Substandard – loans which are inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if applicable. These loans have a well-defined weakness or weaknesses which jeopardize repayment according to the contractual terms. There is distinct loss potential if the weaknesses are not corrected. Includes loans with insufficient cash flow coverage which are collateral dependent, OREO, and repossessed assets.
8.Doubtful – loans which have all the weaknesses inherent in a Substandard loan, with the added characteristic that existing weaknesses make full principal collection, on the basis of current facts, conditions and values, highly doubtful. The possibility of loss is extremely high, but because of pending factors, recognition of a loss is deferred until a more exact status can be determined. All doubtful loans will be placed on non-accrual, with all payments, including principal and interest, applied to principal reduction

For term C&I and CRE loans equal to or greater than $1,000,000, the subsidiary banks with an asset size of $1.0 billion or less as of the most recent fiscal year-end require a term loan review within 15 months of the most recent credit review. For the subsidiary banks with an asset size of over $1.0 billion as of the most recent fiscal year-end, a term loan review is required within 15 months of the most recent credit review for term C&I and CRE loans of $2.0 million or more. A credit review encompasses any new debt issuances or renewed debt facilities that are part of the borrower’s credit relationship. The term loan/credit review is completed in enough detail to, at a minimum, validate the risk rating. Additionally, the review shall include an analysis of debt service requirements, covenant compliance, if applicable, and collateral adequacy. The frequency of the review is generally accelerated for loans with poor risk ratings.

The Company’s Loan Quality area performs a documentation review of a sampling of C&I and CRE loans, the primary purpose of which is to ensure the credit is properly documented and closed in accordance with approval authorities and conditions. A review is also performed by the Company’s Internal Audit Department of a sampling of C&I and CRE loans for proper documentation, according to an approved schedule. Validation of the risk rating is also part of Internal Audit’s review (performed by Internal Loan Review). Additionally, the Company has contracted an independent outside third party to review a sampling of C&I and CRE loans. Validation of the risk rating is part of this review as well.

The Company leases machinery and equipment to C&I customers under direct financing leases. All lease requests are subject to the credit requirements and criteria as set forth in the lending/leasing policy. In all cases, a formal independent credit analysis of the lessee is performed.  Direct financing leases are included in the C&I-other segment and allowance is established in the same manner as C&I loans.

Generally, the Company’s residential real estate loans conform to the underwriting requirements of Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae to allow the subsidiary banks to resell loans in the secondary market. The subsidiary banks structure most loans that will not conform to those underwriting requirements as adjustable rate mortgages that mature or adjust in one to five years or fixed rate mortgages that mature in 15 years, and then retain these loans in their portfolios. Servicing rights are not presently retained on the loans sold in the secondary market. The Company’s lending policy establishes minimum appraisal and other credit guidelines.

The Company provides many types of installment and other consumer loans including motor vehicle, home improvement, home equity, signature loans and small personal credit lines. The Company’s lending policy addresses specific credit guidelines by consumer loan type.

77

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

For residential real estate loans, and installment and other consumer loans, these large groups of smaller balance homogenous loans follow the same methodology as commercial loans in terms of evaluation of risk characteristics, other than these may not be risk rated due to homogenous nature.

TDRs follow the same allowance methodology as described above for all loans. Once a loan is classified as a TDR, it will remain a TDR until the loan is paid off, charged off, moved to OREO or restructured into a new note without a concession. TDR status may also be removed if the TDR was restructured in a prior calendar year, is current, accruing interest and shows sustained performance.

Allowance for Credit Losses on Off-Balance Sheet Exposures

The Company estimates expected credit losses over the contractual term of the loan for the unfunded portion of the loan commitment that is not unconditionally cancellable by the Company.  Management uses an estimated average utilization rate to determine the exposure of default.  The allowance on OBS exposures is calculated using probability of default and loss given default using the same segmentation and qualitative factors used for loans and leases.  The allowance for OBS exposures is recorded in the Other Liabilities section of the consolidated balance sheet.  The Company recorded an ACL on OBS exposures upon adoption of ASU 2016-13.  See Note 4.

Allowance for Credit Losses on Held to Maturity Debt Securities

The Company measures expected credit losses on held to maturity debt securities on a collective basis based on security type.  The estimate of expected credit losses considers historical credit information from external sources.  The Company’s held to maturity debt securities consist primarily of investment grade obligations of states and political subdivisions.  The Company recorded an ACL on HTM debt securities upon adoption of ASU 2016-13.  See Note 3.

Allowance for Credit Losses on Available for Sale Debt Securities

Available for sale debt securities in unrealized loss positions are evaluated for credit related loss at least quarterly.  The decline in fair value of an available for sale debt security due to credit loss results in recording an ACL to the extent the fair value is less than the amortized cost basis.  Declines in fair value that have not been recorded through an ACL, such as declines due to changes in market interest rates, are recorded through other comprehensive income, net of applicable taxes.  Although these evaluations involve significant judgment, an unrealized loss in the fair value of a debt security is generally considered to not be related to credit when the fair value of the security is below the carrying value primarily due to the changes in risk-free interest rates, there has not been significant deterioration in the financial condition of the issues, and the Company does not intend to sell nor does it believe it will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its cost basis.   The Company did not record an ACL on AFS debt securities upon adoption of ASU 2016-13.  See Note 3.

Credit related financial instruments: In the ordinary course of business, the Company has entered into commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. Such financial instruments are recorded when they are funded.

Transfers of financial assets: Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales only when control over the assets has been surrendered. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when: (1) the assets have been isolated from the Company, (2) the transferee obtains the right to pledge or exchange the assets it received, and no condition both constrains the transferee from taking advantage of its right to pledge or exchange and provides more than a modest benefit to the transferor, and (3) the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity or the ability to unilaterally cause the holder to return specific assets. In addition, for transfers of a portion of financial assets (for example, participations of loan

78

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

receivables), the transfer must meet the definition of a “participating interest” in order to account for the transfer as a sale.

Following are the characteristics of a “participating interest”:

Pro-rata ownership in an entire financial asset.
From the date of the transfer, all cash flows received from entire financial assets are divided proportionately among the participating interest holders in an amount equal to their share of ownership.
The rights of each participating interest holder have the same priority, and no participating interest holder’s interest is subordinated to the interest of another participating interest holder. That is, no participating interest

holder is entitled to receive cash before any other participating interest holder under its contractual rights as a participating interest holder.

No party has the right to pledge or exchange the entire financial asset unless all participating interest holders agree to pledge or exchange the entire financial asset.

BOLI: BOLI is carried at cash surrender value with increases/decreases reflected as income/expense in the statement of income.

Premises and equipment: Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is computed primarily by the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets.

Restricted investment securities: Restricted investment securities represent FHLB and FRB common stock. The stock is carried at cost. These equity securities are “restricted” in that they can only be sold back to the respective institution or another member institution at par. Therefore, they are less liquid than other tradable equity securities. The Company views its investment in restricted stock as a long-term investment. Accordingly, when evaluating for impairment, the value is determined based on the ultimate recovery of the par value, rather than recognizing temporary declines in value. There have been no other-than-temporary write-downs recorded on these securities.

OREO: Real estate acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosures, is held for sale and initially recorded at fair value less costs to sell, establishing a new cost basis. Any write down to fair value taken at the time of foreclosure is charged to the allowance. Subsequent to foreclosure, valuations are periodically performed by management and the assets are carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell. Subsequent write-downs to fair value are charged to earnings.

Goodwill: The Company has recorded goodwill from various business combinations. The goodwill is not being amortized, but is evaluated at least annually for impairment.  The Company’s most recent analysis was performed as of November 30, 2021 and it was determined no goodwill impairment existed.  See further information in Note 6 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Core deposit intangible: The Company has recorded a core deposit intangible from historical acquisitions. The core deposit intangible was the portion of the acquisition purchase price which represented the value assigned to the existing deposit base at acquisition. See Notes 2 and 6 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information. The core deposit intangibles have a finite life and are amortized over the estimated useful life of the deposits (estimated to be 10 years).

Customer list intangible: The Company had recorded a customer list intangible from the Bates Companies acquisition.  The customer list intangible was the portion of the acquisition purchase price which represented the value assigned to the existing customer base at acquisition.  See Notes 2 and 6 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for addition information.  The customer list intangible had a finite life and was to be amortized over the estimated useful life

79

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

(estimated to be fifteen years). With the sale of the Bates Companies in August 2020, the remaining balance of the customer list intangible was written off.

Swap transactions: The Company offers a loan swap program to certain commercial loan customers including C&I, CRE, and multi-family which includes LIHTC permanent loans. Through this program, the Company originates a variable rate loan with the customer. The Company and the swap customer will then enter into a fixed interest rate swap. Separately, an identical offsetting swap is entered into by the Company with a counterparty. These “back-to-back” swap arrangements are intended to offset each other and allow the Company to book a variable rate loan, while providing the customer with a contract for fixed interest payments. In these arrangements, the Company’s net cash flow is equal to the interest income received from the variable rate loan originated with the customer. These customer swaps are not designated as hedging instruments and are recorded at fair value in other assets and other liabilities.

Additionally, the Company receives an upfront, non-refundable fee from the counterparty, dependent upon the pricing, that is recognized upon receipt from the counterparty. This upfront, non-refundable fee is recorded as noninterest income and classified as swap fee income/capital markets revenue.

Derivatives and hedging activities: The Company enters into derivative financial instruments as part of its strategy to manage its exposure to changes in interest rates.

Derivative instruments represent contracts between parties that result in one party delivering cash to the other party based on a notional amount and an underlying index (such as a rate, security price or price index) as specified in the contract. The amount of cash delivered from one party to the other is determined based on the interaction of the notional amount of the contract with the underlying index.

The derivative financial instruments currently used by the Company to manage its exposure to interest rate risk include: (1) interest rate lock commitments provided to customers to fund certain mortgage loans to be sold into the secondary market (although this type of derivative is negligible); (2) interest rate caps to manage the interest rate risk of certain variable rate deposits and short-term fixed rate liabilities; and (3) interest rate swaps on variable rate trust preferred securities and floating rate loans.

Interest rate caps and interest rate swaps are valued by a third party monthly and corroborated by the transaction counterparty. The Company uses the hypothetical derivative method to assess and measure effectiveness in accordance with ASC 815, Derivative and Hedging.

Preferred stock: The Company currently has 250,000 shares of preferred stock authorized, but none outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020. Should the Company have preferred stock outstanding in the future, dividends declared on those shares would be deducted from net income to arrive at net income available to common stockholders. Net income available to common stockholders would then be used in the earnings per share computation.

Stock-based compensation plans: The Company accounts for stock-based compensation with measurement of compensation cost for all stock-based awards at fair value on the grant date and recognition of compensation over the requisite service period for awards expected to vest.

As discussed in Note 16 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, during the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019, the Company recognized stock-based compensation expense for the grant-date fair value of stock based awards that are expected to vest over the requisite service period of $2.4 million, $2.2 million and $2.5 million, respectively. As required, management made an estimate of expected forfeitures and is recognizing compensation costs only for those equity awards expected to vest.

80

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

The Company uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock option grants with the following assumptions for the indicated periods:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

Dividend yield

0.55%

0.60% to 0.81%

0.67%

Expected volatility

 

23.57%

25.49% to 25.70%

28.28%

Risk-free interest rate

 

1.62%

0.79% to 1.31%

2.90%

Expected life of option grants

 

6.25 years

6.25 years

6.25 years

Weighted-average grant date fair value

$

10.85

$

10.07

$

11.29

The Company also uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock purchase grants with the following assumptions for the indicated periods:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

Dividend yield

    

0.49% to 0.61%

0.55% to 0.81%

0.69% to 0.75%

Expected volatility

 

37.51% to 38.65%

24.59% to 36.38%

20.15% to 21.06%

Risk-free interest rate

 

0% to 0.06%

0.15% to 1.65%

2.02 % to 2.46%

Expected life of purchase grants

 

3 to 6 months

3 to 6 months

3 to 6 months

Weighted-average grant date fair value

$

7.67

$

6.03

$

4.81

The fair value is amortized on a straight-line basis over the vesting periods of the grants and will be adjusted for subsequent changes in estimated forfeitures. The expected dividend yield assumption is based on the Company’s current expectations about its anticipated dividend policy. Expected volatility is based on historical volatility of the Company’s common stock price. The risk-free interest rate for periods within the contractual life of the option or purchase is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of the grant. The expected life of the option and purchase grants is derived using the “simplified” method and represents the period of time that options and purchases are expected to be outstanding. Historical data is used to estimate forfeitures used in the model. Two separate groups of employees (employees subject to broad based grants, and executive employees and directors) are used.

As of December 31, 2021, there was $382 thousand of unrecognized compensation cost related to stock options granted, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.98 years.

The aggregate intrinsic value is calculated as the difference between the exercise price of the underlying awards and the quoted price of the Company’s common stock for the 367,998 options that were in-the-money at December 31, 2021. The aggregate intrinsic value at December 31, 2021 was $11.6 million on options outstanding and $10.8 million on options exercisable. During the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019, the aggregate intrinsic value of options exercised under the Company’s stock-based compensation was $419 thousand, $270 thousand, and $303 thousand, respectively, and determined as of the date of the option exercise.

Restricted stock awards granted may not be sold or otherwise transferred until the service periods have lapsed. During the vesting periods, participants have voting rights and receive dividends. Upon termination of employment, common shares upon which the service periods have not lapsed must be returned to the Company.

All restricted share awards are classified as equity awards. The grant-date fair value of equity-classified restricted stock awards is amortized as compensation expense on a straight-line basis over the period restrictions lapse.

As of December 31, 2021, there was $2.7 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested restricted stock awards expected to be recognized over a period of 1.7 years.

81

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Income taxes: The Company files its tax return on a consolidated basis with its subsidiaries. The entities follow the direct reimbursement method of accounting for income taxes under which income taxes or credits which result from the inclusion of the subsidiaries in the consolidated tax return are paid to or received from the parent company.

Deferred income taxes are provided under the liability method whereby deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences and net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards and deferred tax liabilities are recognized for taxable temporary differences. Temporary differences are the differences between the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and their tax basis. Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effects of changes in tax laws and rates on the date of enactment.

When tax returns are filed, it is highly certain that some positions taken would be sustained upon examination by the taxing authorities, while others are subject to uncertainty about the merits of the position taken or the amount of the position that would be ultimately sustained. The benefit of a tax position is recognized in the financial statements in the period during which, based on all available evidence, management believes it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained upon examination, including the resolution of appeals or litigation processes, if any. Tax positions taken are not offset or aggregated with other positions. Tax positions that meet the more likely than not recognition threshold are measured as the largest amount of tax benefit that is more than 50 percent likely of being realized upon settlement with the applicable taxing authority. The portion of the benefits associated with tax positions taken that exceeds the amount measured as described above is reflected as a liability for unrecognized tax benefits in the accompanying balance sheet along with any associated interest and penalties that would be payable to the taxing authorities upon examination.

Interest and penalties associated with unrecognized tax benefits are classified as additional income taxes in the statements of income.

Trust assets: Trust assets held by the subsidiary banks in a fiduciary, agency, or custodial capacity for their customers, other than cash on deposit at the subsidiary banks, are not included in the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements since such items are not assets of the subsidiary banks.

Earnings per share: See Note 18 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a complete description and calculation of basic and diluted earnings per share.

Revenue Recognition:

Trust department and Investment advisory and management fees: This is a contract between the Company and its customers for fiduciary and/or investment administration services on trust and brokerage accounts. Trust services and brokerage fee income is determined as a percentage of assets under management and is recognized over the period the underlying trust account is serviced. Such contracts are generally cancellable at any time, with the customer subject to a pro-rated fee in the month of termination.

Deposit service fees: The deposit contract obligates the Company to serve as a custodian of the customer's deposited funds and is generally terminable at will by either party. The contract permits the customer to access the funds on deposit and request additional services related to the deposit account. Deposit account related fees, including analysis charges, overdraft/nonsufficient fund charges, service charges, debit card usage fees, overdraft fees and wire transfer fees are within the scope of the guidance; however, revenue recognition practices did not change under the guidance, as deposit agreements are considered day-to-day contracts. Income for deposit accounts is recognized over the statement cycle period (typically on a monthly basis) or at the time the service is provided, if additional services are requested.

82

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Correspondent banking fees: This is a contract between the Company and its correspondent banks for corresponding banking services. This line of business provides a strong source of noninterest bearing and interest bearing deposits, fee income, high-quality loan participations and bank stock loans. Correspondent banking fee income is tied to transaction activity and revenue is recognized monthly as earned for services provided.

Reclassifications: Certain amounts in the prior year’s Consolidated Financial Statements have been reclassified, with no effect on net income or stockholders’ equity, to conform with the current period presentation.

Recent accounting developments: In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-13, Financial Instruments – Credit Losses.  Under the standard, assets measured at amortized cost (including loans, leases and HTM securities) will be presented at the net amount expected to be collected.  Rather than the “incurred” model previously utilized, the standard requires the use of a forward-looking approach to recognizing all expected credit losses at the beginning of an asset’s life.  For public companies, ASU 2016-13 became effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019, including items periods within those fiscal years.

On March 27, 2020, the CARES Act, a stimulus package designed in response to the economic disruption created by COVID-19, was signed into law.  The CARES Act includes provisions that, if elected, temporarily delay the required implementation date of ASU 2016-13.  Section 4014 of the CARES Act stipulates that no insured depository institution, bank holding company, or affiliate will be required to comply with ASU 2016-13, beginning on the date of the CARES Act’s enactment and continuing until the earlier of: (1) the date on which the national emergency related to the COVID-19 outbreak is terminated or (2) December 31, 2020.  

On December 27, 2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act was established, which extended this relief to the earlier of the first day of the Company’s fiscal year after the date of the national emergency terminates or January 1, 2022. Based upon guidance from regulators it was determined the Company could adopt ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2021, which the Company did on January 1, 2021.

Results for reporting periods beginning after December 31, 2020 are presented under ASU 2016-13 while prior period amounts continue to be reported in accordance with previously applicable GAAP, which includes a change in terminology from “Allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases” to “Allowance for credit losses.”  The Company adopted the standard using a modified retrospective approach and recorded an after-tax decrease to retained earnings of $937 thousand as of January 1, 2021 due to the adoption of ASU 2016-13. This transition adjustment included an $8.1 million decrease in the allowance related to loans and leases, established an ACL on held to maturity debt securities of $183 thousand and established an ACL on OBS credit exposures of $9.1 million.  The Company did not record an ACL on available for sale securities upon adoption of ASU 2016-13.

The Company elected to not measure an ACL on accrued interest as such accrued interest is written off in a timely manner when deemed uncollectible.  Any such write-off of accrued interest will reverse previously recognized interest income.  The Company elected not to include accrued interest within the presentation and disclosures of the carrying amount of financial assets held at amortized cost.  This election is applicable to the various disclosures included within the financial statements and notes included on the following pages of this Form 10-K.

The Company elected not to utilize the regulatory transition relief issued by federal regulatory authorities in the first quarter of 2020, which allowed banking institutions to delay the impact of CECL on regulatory capital, because the impact on the capital ratios of the Company and its subsidiary banks was not significant.

83

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

The following table illustrated the impact of ASU 2016-13 as of January 1, 2021:

As Reported

Pre-

Impact of

Under

ASU 2016-13

ASU 2016-13

ASU 2016-13

Adoption

    

Adoption

(dollars in thousands)

Assets:

Allowance for credit losses HTM securities

$

183

$

$

183

Loans*:

C&I

35,421

(35,421)

C&I - revolving

2,982

2,982

C&I - other

29,130

29,130

CRE

42,161

(42,161)

CRE - owner occupied

8,696

8,696

CRE - non owner occupied

11,428

11,428

Construction & Land Development

11,999

11,999

Multi-family

5,836

5,836

Direct financing leases

1,764

(1,764)

1-4 family real estate

5,042

5,042

Residential real estate

3,732

(3,732)

Consumer

1,161

1,298

(137)

Allowance for credit losses on loans

76,274

84,376

(8,102)

Liabilities:

Allowance for credit losses on OBS credit exposures

9,117

9,117

*Loan segmentation under ASU 2016-13 follows different methodology where that segmentation is collateral driven, causing certain segments to contain commercial and non-commercial borrowers, whereas pre-ASU 2016-13 segments were borrower driven.

Further discussion contained in this report regarding the loan and lease portfolio as well as ACL on HTM securities and OBS exposures is only relevant for the year 2021 and forward.  Discussion in Note 1 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2020 is still applicable for years prior to 2021.

Pending accounting developments:

In March 2020, the FASB issued ASU 2020-4, “Reference Rate Reform,” which provides optional expedients and exceptions for applying GAAP to loan and lease arrangements, derivative contracts, and other transactions affected by the anticipated transition away from LIBOR toward new interest rate benchmarks.  ASU 2020-04 is effective March 12, 2020 through December 31, 2022.  An entity may elect to apply ASU 2020-04 for contract modifications as of January 1, 2020, or prospectively from a date within an interim period that includes or is subsequent to March 12, 2020, up to the date that the financial statements are available to be issued.  

Management has assessed the impacts of ASU 2020-4 and the related opportunities and risks involved in the LIBOR transition.  Specifically, management has identified all of the financial instruments with LIBOR exposure which includes certain commercial loans, interest rate swaps, interest rate caps, and certain securities.  In all cases, management has determined a plan of transition from LIBOR to a different index.  The transition will happen prior to the expiration of published LIBOR rates on June 30, 2023.  Management expects the transition to have a minimal impact to the Company’s financial statements.  

Risks and uncertainties:

On January 30, 2020, the World Health Organization declared the COVID-19 outbreak a “Public Health Emergency of International Concern” and on March 11, 2020, declared it to be a pandemic.  Actions taken around the world to help mitigate the spread of COVID-19 include restrictions on travel, quarantines in certain areas, and forced closures for certain types of public places and businesses.  COVID-19 and actions taken to mitigate the spread of it have had and are expected to continue to have an adverse impact on the economies and financial markets of many countries, including the geographical area in which the Company operates.  On March 27, 2020, the CARES Act was enacted to, among other things, provide emergency assistance for individuals, families and businesses affected by the COVID-

84

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1. Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

19 pandemic. The extent to which COVID-19 will continue to affect business operations, financial condition, credit quality, and results of operations will depend on future developments that cannot be predicted, including the duration and scope of the pandemic.  

In the past year, the United States economy began to rebound from severe disruptions caused by the onset of the pandemic in March 2020.  Economic conditions have begun to normalize with the availability of vaccines and treatments, increasing workforce employment and participation, the lessening of business and education restrictions, and demand for services beginning to return.  The financial conditions of households and businesses was bolstered significantly by government stimulus, which contributed to the economic recovery but also brought about growing pains as evidenced by supply chain problems and rising prices.  Although current economic conditions are more favorable than the prior year, the outlook for continued growth is characterized by elevated uncertainty with potential for unevenness across markets and sectors.  Although household and business credit and liquidity is strong currently, further pandemic-related disruptions could result in increased risk of delinquencies, defaults, foreclosures, and losses on our loans; declines in assets under management, affecting wealth management revenues; negative impacts on regional economic conditions resulting in declines in local loan demand, liquidity of loan guarantors, loan collateral (particularly in real estate), loan originations, and deposit availability; and impacts on the implementation of our growth strategy.  While the recovery this past year has been strong, the pace of growth in the United States and globally could decline as a result of rising inflation, the pervasiveness of supply chain challenges across industries, and the persistence of the virus in variant forms.

Overall, we believe that the economic impact from COVID-19 will continue for some time and could have a material and adverse impact on our business and result in significant losses in our loan portfolio, all of which would adversely and materially impact our earnings and capital.  Even after the COVID-19 pandemic has subsided, we may continue to experience materially adverse impacts to our business as a result of the global economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, including the availability of credit, adverse impacts on liquidity, and any recession that has occurred or may occur in the future.  There are no comparable recent events that provide guidance as to the effect the spread of COVID-19 as a global pandemic may have, nor are there historical indicators to rely on in terms of how markets will react, and as a result, the ultimate impact of the pandemic is highly uncertain and subject to change.

Note 2. Sales/Mergers/Acquisitions

Sale of the Bates Companies

On August 12, 2020, the Company sold all of the issued and outstanding capital stock of the Bates Companies.  The aggregate consideration paid to the Company was a $500 thousand note receivable, less imputed interest of $52 thousand, plus cancellation of all future amounts otherwise to become payable to the purchaser by the Company under an earn-out agreement entered into between the same parties in 2018 with a non-discounted value of approximately $880 thousand at the sale date.

85

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Assets and liabilities of the Bates Companies sold are summarized as follows as of the date of closing:

As of

    

August 12, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

ASSETS

Cash and due from banks

$

349

Premises and equipment, net

19

Other assets

2,259

Total assets sold

$

2,627

LIABILITIES

Other liabilities

$

946

Total liabilities sold

$

946

Net assets sold

$

1,681

Cash consideration

$

195

Forgiveness of earn-out consideration

880

Note receivable consideration

448

Loss on sale of subsidiary

$

158

Disposition costs in 2020 related to the sale totaled $227 thousand and were comprised primarily of legal, accounting and personnel costs.

Sale of Assets and Liabilities of Rockford Bank & Trust Company

On November 30, 2019, the Company sold substantially all of the assets and transferred substantially all of the deposits and certain other liabilities of the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiary, RB&T, to IB&T, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Heartland Financial USA, Inc., for a cash payment.  The cash payment amount was determined substantially by the following formula: (1) the “Purchase Price Premium”, plus (2) the aggregate net book value of the acquired assets, minus (3) the aggregate book value of the assumed liabilities.  The Purchase Price Premium was equal to: (A) 8% of RB&T’s tangible assets, multiplied by (B) 0.345.  The Purchase Price Premium totaled $12.5 million and the total payment by IB&T to the Company at closing was $46.6 million.

Assets and liabilities of RB&T sold are summarized as follows as of the date of closing:

    

As of

11/30/2019

(dollars in thousands)

ASSETS

Cash and due from banks

$

3,973

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

55,291

Securities held to maturity, at amortized cost

3,243

Securities available for sale, at fair value

 

21,874

Loans/leases receivable held for investment, net

 

357,931

Premises and equipment, net

 

5,612

Restricted investment securities

 

675

Other real estate owned, net

 

2,134

Other assets

 

3,228

Total assets acquired

$

453,961

LIABILITIES

 

  

Noninterest-bearing deposits

$

69,802

Interest-bearing deposits

331,486

Short-term borrowings

 

1,158

FHLB advances

 

15,000

Other liabilities

2,241

Total liabilities assumed

$

419,687

Net assets sold

$

34,274

Cash consideration received

$

46,560

Gain on sale of assets and liabilities

$

12,286

86

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 2. Sales/Mergers/Acquisitions (continued)

The Company retained certain assets, mainly comprised of BOLI, and certain liabilities, mainly comprised of deferred compensation and income tax accruals. These assets and liabilities totaling $12.0 million and $5.0 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2019, were liquidated in 2020.

Disposition costs in 2019 related to the sale totaled $3.3 million and were comprised primarily of legal and accounting costs, costs in connection with the disposal of fixed assets and prepaids, personnel costs and IT deconversion costs related to the sale of RB&T.

Note 3. Investment Securities

The amortized cost and fair value of investment securities as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are summarized as follows:

Gross

Gross

Amortized

Unrealized

Unrealized

Fair

    

Cost*

    

Gains

    

(Losses)

    

Value

    

(dollars in thousands)

December 31, 2021:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Securities HTM:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Municipal securities

$

471,533

$

49,715

$

$

521,248

Other securities

 

1,050

 

 

(1)

 

1,049

$

472,583

$

49,715

$

(1)

$

522,297

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

U.S. treasuries and govt. sponsored agency securities

$

23,370

$

254

$

(296)

$

23,328

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

92,431

 

2,672

 

(780)

 

94,323

Municipal securities

 

163,253

 

5,228

 

(215)

 

168,266

Asset-backed securities

26,372

752

27,124

Other securities

 

24,568

 

251

 

(30)

 

24,789

$

329,994

$

9,157

$

(1,321)

$

337,830

* HTM securities shown on the balance sheet of $472.4 million represent amortized cost of $472.6 million, net of allowance for credit losses of $198 thousand as of December 31, 2021.

Gross

Gross

Amortized

Unrealized

Unrealized

Fair

    

Cost

    

Gains

    

(Losses)

Value

(dollars in thousands)

December 31, 2020:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities HTM:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Municipal securities

$

475,115

$

45,360

$

(248)

$

520,227

Other securities

 

1,050

 

 

 

1,050

$

476,165

$

45,360

$

(248)

$

521,277

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

$

14,936

$

447

$

(47)

$

15,336

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

127,670

 

5,510

 

(338)

 

132,842

Municipal securities

 

147,241

 

5,215

 

(48)

 

152,408

Asset-backed securities

39,663

1,111

(91)

40,683

Other securities

 

20,550

 

147

 

 

20,697

$

350,060

$

12,430

$

(524)

$

361,966

The Company’s HTM municipal securities consist largely of private issues of municipal debt. The municipalities are located primarily within the Midwest. The municipal debt investments are underwritten using specific guidelines with ongoing monitoring.

87

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 3. Investment Securities (continued)

The Company’s residential mortgage-backed and related securities portfolio consists entirely of government sponsored or government guaranteed securities. The Company has not invested in commercial mortgage-backed securities or pooled trust preferred securities.

Gross unrealized losses and fair value, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, are summarized as follows:

Less than 12 Months

12 Months or More

Total

Gross

Gross

Gross

Fair

Unrealized

Fair

Unrealized

Fair

Unrealized

    

Value

    

Losses

    

Value

    

Losses

    

Value

    

Losses

(dollars in thousands)

December 31, 2021:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities HTM:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Other securities

$

1,049

$

(1)

$

$

$

1,049

$

(1)

 

  

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

U.S. treasuries and govt. sponsored agency securities

$

9,802

$

(156)

$

3,035

$

(140)

$

12,837

$

(296)

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

5,363

 

(67)

 

19,406

 

(713)

 

24,769

 

(780)

Municipal securities

 

13,287

 

(211)

 

1,001

 

(4)

 

14,288

 

(215)

Other securities

 

4,528

 

(30)

 

 

 

4,528

 

(30)

$

32,980

$

(464)

$

23,442

$

(857)

$

56,422

$

(1,321)

Less than 12 Months

12 Months or More

Total

Gross

Gross

Gross

Fair

Unrealized

Fair

Unrealized

Fair

Unrealized

    

Value

    

Losses

    

Value

    

Losses

    

Value

    

Losses

(dollars in thousands)

December 31, 2020:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities HTM:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Municipal securities

$

8,407

$

(248)

$

$

$

8,407

$

(248)

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

$

3,199

$

(47)

$

$

$

3,199

$

(47)

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

37,549

 

(338)

 

 

 

37,549

 

(338)

Municipal securities

 

10,110

 

(48)

 

 

 

10,110

 

(48)

Asset-backed securities

6,884

(52)

9,945

(39)

16,829

(91)

$

57,742

$

(485)

$

9,945

$

(39)

$

67,687

$

(524)

At December 31, 2021, the investment portfolio included 622 securities. Of this number, 42 securities were in an unrealized loss position. The aggregate losses of these securities totaled approximately 0.17% of the total aggregate amortized cost. Of these 42 securities, 13 securities had an unrealized loss for 12 months or more.

On January 1, 2021, the Company adopted ASU 2016-13, which replaced the legacy GAAP OTTI model with a credit loss model.  ASU 2016-13 requires an allowance on lifetime expected credit losses on held to maturity debt securities.  The following table presents the activity in the allowance for credit losses held to maturity securities by major security type for the year ended December 31, 2021.

Year Ended December 31, 2021

Municipal

Other

    

securities

    

securities

    

Total

 

(dollars in thousands)

Allowance for credit losses:

Beginning balance

$

$

$

Impact of adopting ASU 2016-13

182

1

183

Provision for credit loss expense

16

(1)

15

Balance, ending

$

198

$

$

198

88

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 3. Investment Securities (continued)

The credit loss model under ASU 2016-13, applicable to AFS debt securities, requires the recognition of credit losses through an allowance account, but retains the concept from the OTTI model that credit losses are recognized once securities become impaired.  See Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” included in this Form 10-K, for a discussion of the impact of the adoption of ASU 2016-13.

All sales of securities for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019, respectively, were from securities identified as AFS. Information on proceeds received, as well as the gains and losses from the sale of those securities are as follows:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Proceeds from sales of securities

$

23,874

$

38,562

$

30,055

Gross gains from sales of securities

 

 

2,553

 

176

Gross losses from sales of securities

 

(88)

 

(69)

 

(206)

The amortized cost and fair value of securities as of December 31, 2021, by contractual maturity are shown below. Expected maturities of residential mortgage-backed and related securities and asset-backed securities may differ from contractual maturities because the mortgages underlying the securities may be called or prepaid without any penalties. Therefore, these securities are not included in the maturity categories in the following table.

    

Amortized Cost

    

Fair Value

(dollars in thousands)

Securities HTM:

 

  

 

  

Due in one year or less

$

2,636

$

2,651

Due after one year through five years

 

23,246

 

23,800

Due after five years

 

446,701

 

495,846

$

472,583

$

522,297

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

  

Due in one year or less

$

5,873

$

5,943

Due after one year through five years

 

5,600

 

5,764

Due after five years

 

199,718

 

204,676

211,191

216,383

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

92,431

94,323

Asset-backed securities

 

26,372

 

27,124

$

329,994

$

337,830

Portions of the U.S. government sponsored agencies and municipal securities contain call options, at the discretion of the issuer, to terminate the security at predetermined dates prior to the stated maturity, summarized as follows:

    

Amortized Cost

    

Fair Value

(dollars in thousands)

Securities HTM:

 

  

 

  

Municipal securities

$

278,699

$

289,939

 

  

 

  

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

  

Municipal securities

158,262

163,070

Other securities

 

24,568

 

24,789

$

182,830

$

187,859

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, investment securities with a carrying value of $246.5 million and $212.8 million, respectively, were pledged on public deposits, FHLB advances, customer repurchase agreements, derivative liabilities, in connection with a Goldman Sachs cash management program and for other purposes as required or permitted by law.

89

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 3. Investment Securities (continued)

As of December 31, 2021, the Company’s municipal securities portfolios were comprised of general obligation bonds issued by 113 issuers with fair values totaling $114.5 million and revenue bonds issued by 165 issuers, primarily consisting of states, counties, towns, villages and school districts with fair values totaling $575.0 million. The Company held investments in general obligation bonds in 20 states, including seven states in which the aggregate fair value exceeded $5.0 million. The Company held investments in revenue bonds in 25 states, including 13 states in which the aggregate fair value exceeded $5.0 million.

As of December 31, 2020, the Company’s municipal securities portfolios were comprised of general obligation bonds issued by 117 issuers with fair values totaling $116.7 million and revenue bonds issued by 191 issuers, primarily consisting of states, counties, towns, villages and school districts with fair values totaling $555.9 million. The Company held investments in general obligation bonds in 21 states, including eight states in which the aggregate fair value exceeded $5.0 million. The Company held investments in revenue bonds in 26 states, including 12 states in which the aggregate fair value exceeded $5.0 million.

Both general obligation and revenue bonds are diversified across many issuers.  As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the Company held revenue bonds of two issuers, located in Ohio, the aggregate book or market value of which exceeded 5% of the Company’s stockholders’ equity.  The issuers’ financial condition is strong and the source of repayment is diversified.  The Company monitors the investment and concentration closely. Of the general obligation and revenue bonds in the Company’s portfolio, the majority are unrated bonds that represent small, private issuances. All unrated bonds were underwritten according to loan underwriting standards and have an average risk rating of 2, indicating very high quality. Additionally, many of these bonds are funding essential municipal services (water, sewer, education, medical facilities).

The Company’s municipal securities are owned by each of the four charters, whose investment policies set forth limits for various subcategories within the municipal securities portfolio. Each charter is monitored individually and as of December 31, 2021, all were within policy limitations approved by the charter’s board of directors. Policy limits are calculated as a percentage of total risk-based capital.

As of December 31, 2021, the Company’s standard monitoring of its municipal securities portfolio had not uncovered any facts or circumstances resulting in significantly different credits ratings than those assigned by a nationally recognized statistical rating organization, or in the case of unrated bonds, the rating assigned using the credit underwriting standards.

90

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable

The composition of the loan/lease portfolio as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 is presented as follows:

    

December 31, 2021

(dollars in thousands)

C&I:

C&I - revolving

$

248,483

C&I - other *

1,346,602

1,595,085

 

  

CRE - owner occupied

 

421,701

CRE - non-owner occupied

 

646,500

Construction and land development

 

918,571

Multi-family

600,412

Direct financing leases**

 

45,191

1-4 family real estate***

377,361

Consumer

 

75,311

 

4,680,132

Allowance for credit losses

 

(78,721)

$

4,601,411

** Direct financing leases:

 

  

Net minimum lease payments to be received

$

49,362

Estimated unguaranteed residual values of leased assets

 

165

Unearned lease/residual income

 

(4,336)

 

45,191

Plus deferred lease origination costs, net of fees

 

568

 

45,759

Less allowance for credit losses

 

(1,546)

$

44,213

    

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

C&I loans*

$

1,726,723

CRE loans

 

  

Owner-occupied CRE

 

496,471

Commercial construction, land development, and other land

 

541,455

Other non owner-occupied CRE

 

1,069,703

 

2,107,629

Direct financing leases **

 

66,016

Residential real estate loans ***

 

252,121

Installment and other consumer loans

 

91,302

 

4,243,791

Plus deferred loan/lease origination costs, net of fees

 

7,338

 

4,251,129

Less allowance

 

(84,376)

$

4,166,753

** Direct financing leases:

 

  

Net minimum lease payments to be received

$

72,940

Estimated unguaranteed residual values of leased assets

 

239

Unearned lease/residual income

 

(7,163)

 

66,016

Plus deferred lease origination costs, net of fees

 

1,072

 

67,088

Less allowance

 

(1,764)

$

65,324

*   Includes equipment financing agreements outstanding at m2, totaling $225.1 million and $171.5 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively and PPP loans totaling $28.2 million and $273.1 million as of December 31, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively.

**

Management performs an evaluation of the estimated unguaranteed residual values of leased assets on an annual basis, at a minimum. The evaluation consists of discussions with reputable and current vendors and management’s expertise and understanding of the current states of particular industries to determine informal valuations of the equipment. As necessary and where available, management will utilize valuations by independent appraisers. The majority of leases with residual values contain a lease options rider which requires the lessee to pay the residual

91

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

value directly, finance the payment of the residual value, or extend the lease term to pay the residual value. In these cases, the residual value is protected and the risk of loss is minimal.

At December 31, 2021, the Company had two leases remaining with residual values totaling $165 thousand that were not protected with a lease end options rider. At December 31, 2020, the Company had three leases remaining with residual values totaling approximately $239 thousand that were not protected with a lease end options rider. Management has performed specific evaluations of these unguaranteed residual values and determined that the valuations are appropriate. There were no losses related to unguaranteed residual values during the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019.

***Includes residential real estate loans held for sale totaling $3.8 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Changes in accretable yield for the loans acquired in mergers and acquisitions are as follows:

For the year ended December 31, 2021

PCI

    

Performing

    

Loans

Loans

Total

(dollars in thousands)

Balance at the beginning of the period

$

$

(3,139)

$

(3,139)

Accretion recognized

 

 

1,606

 

1,606

Balance at the end of the period

$

$

(1,533)

$

(1,533)

For the year ended December 31, 2020

PCI

    

Performing

    

Loans

Loans

Total

(dollars in thousands)

Balance at the beginning of the period

$

(57)

$

(6,378)

$

(6,435)

Reclassification of nonaccretable discount to accretable

(530)

(530)

Reclassification of nonaccretable discount to allowance

353

353

Accretion recognized

 

587

 

2,886

 

3,473

Balance at the end of the period

$

$

(3,139)

$

(3,139)

For the year ended December 31, 2019

PCI

    

Performing

    

Loans

Loans

Total

(dollars in thousands)

Balance at the beginning of the period

$

(667)

$

(10,127)

$

(10,794)

Reclassification of nonaccretable discount to accretable

(275)

(275)

Accretion recognized

 

885

 

3,749

 

4,634

Balance at the end of the period

$

(57)

$

(6,378)

$

(6,435)

92

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

The aging of the loan/lease portfolio by classes of loans/leases as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 is presented as follows:

2021

 

Accruing Past

 

30-59 Days

60-89 Days

Due 90 Days or

Nonaccrual

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

    

Current

    

Past Due

    

Past Due

    

More

    

Loans/Leases

    

Total

 

(dollars in thousands)

C&I:

C&I - revolving

$

248,483

$

$

$

$

$

248,483

C&I - other

1,337,034

859

7,308

1

1,400

1,346,602

CRE - owner occupied

 

421,701

 

 

 

 

 

421,701

CRE - non-owner occupied

 

646,500

 

 

 

 

 

646,500

Construction and land development

918,498

73

918,571

Multi-family

 

600,412

 

 

 

 

 

600,412

Direct financing leases

 

44,174

 

10

 

160

 

 

847

 

45,191

1-4 family real estate

 

374,912

 

1,325

 

716

 

 

408

 

377,361

Consumer

 

75,272

 

8

 

 

 

31

 

75,311

$

4,666,986

$

2,202

$

8,184

$

1

$

2,759

$

4,680,132

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

As a percentage of total loan/lease portfolio

 

99.72

%  

 

0.05

%  

 

0.17

%  

 

0.00

%  

 

0.06

%  

 

100.00

%

2020

 

Accruing Past

 

30-59 Days

60-89 Days

Due 90 Days or

Nonaccrual

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

    

Current

    

Past Due

    

Past Due

    

More

    

Loans/Leases

    

Total

 

(dollars in thousands)

C&I

$

1,720,058

$

1,535

$

323

$

$

4,807

$

1,726,723

CRE

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

  

Owner-occupied CRE

 

496,459

 

 

 

 

12

 

496,471

Commercial construction, land development, and other land

 

541,455

 

 

 

 

 

541,455

Other non-owner occupied CRE

 

1,062,215

 

 

 

 

7,488

 

1,069,703

Direct financing leases

 

64,918

 

501

 

191

 

 

406

 

66,016

Residential real estate

 

249,364

 

1,512

 

223

 

 

1,022

 

252,121

Installment and other consumer

 

91,047

 

43

 

4

 

3

 

205

 

91,302

$

4,225,516

$

3,591

$

741

$

3

$

13,940

$

4,243,791

As a percentage of total loan/lease portfolio

 

99.57

%  

 

0.08

%  

 

0.02

%  

 

0.00

%  

 

0.33

%  

 

100.00

%

93

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

NPLs by classes of loans/leases as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 is presented as follows:

2021

Accruing Past

Nonaccrual

Nonaccrual

Due 90 Days or

Loans/Leases

Loans/Leases

Percentage of

Classes of Loans/Leases

    

More

    

with an ACL

    

without an ACL

    

Total NPLs

    

Total NPLs

 

 

(dollars in thousands)

C&I:

 

C&I - revolving

$

$

$

$

 

-

%

C&I - other

1

1,130

270

1,401

50.77

CRE - owner occupied

 

 

 

 

 

-

CRE - non-owner occupied

 

 

 

 

 

-

Construction and land development

73

73

2.64

Multi-family

 

 

 

 

 

-

Direct financing leases

 

 

115

 

732

 

847

 

30.69

1-4 family real estate

 

 

408

 

 

408

 

14.78

Consumer

 

 

31

 

 

31

 

1.12

$

1

$

1,757

$

1,002

$

2,760

 

100.00

%

The Company did not recognize any interest income on nonaccrual loans during the year ended December 31, 2021.

2020

 

Accruing Past

 

Due 90 Days or

Nonaccrual

Percentage of

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

    

More

    

Loans/Leases *

    

Accruing TDRs

    

Total NPLs

    

Total NPLs

 

 

(dollars in thousands)

C&I

$

$

4,807

$

606

$

5,413

 

36.87

%

CRE

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Owner-occupied CRE

 

 

12

 

 

12

 

0.08

%

Commercial construction, land development, and other land

 

 

 

 

 

-

%

Other non-owner occupied CRE

 

 

7,488

 

 

7,488

 

50.99

%

Direct financing leases

 

 

406

 

135

 

541

 

3.68

%

Residential real estate

 

 

1,022

 

 

1,022

 

6.96

%

Installment and other consumer

 

3

 

205

 

 

208

 

1.42

%

$

3

$

13,940

$

741

$

14,684

100.00

%

*  At December 31, 2020, accruing past due 90 days or more included $984 thousand of TDRs, including $836 thousand in CRE loans, $100

thousand in direct financing leases, and $48 thousand in installment loans.

94

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

Changes in the ACL loans/leases by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019 are presented as follows:

Year Ended December 31, 2021

CRE

CRE

Construction

Direct

Residential

1-4

C&I -

C&I -

Owner

Non-Owner

and Land

Multi-

Financing

Real

Family

    

C&I

Revolving

Other*

    

CRE

Occupied

Occupied

Development

Family

    

Leases

    

Estate

Real Estate

    

Consumer

Total

 

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

35,421

$

$

$

42,161

$

$

$

$

$

1,764

$

3,732

$

$

1,298

$

84,376

Adoption of ASU 2016-13

(35,421)

2,982

29,130

(42,161)

8,696

11,428

11,999

5,836

(1,764)

(3,732)

5,042

(137)

(8,102)

Provision

 

 

925

 

(1,451)

 

 

(198)

 

(1,088)

 

4,973

 

3,653

 

 

 

(603)

 

(509)

 

5,702

Charge-offs

 

 

 

(2,287)

 

 

 

(1,876)

 

 

(150)

 

 

 

(179)

 

(46)

 

(4,538)

Recoveries

 

 

 

590

 

 

3

 

85

 

 

 

 

 

281

 

324

 

1,283

Balance, ending

$

$

3,907

$

25,982

$

$

8,501

$

8,549

$

16,972

$

9,339

$

$

$

4,541

$

930

$

78,721

*Included within the C&I-other column are ACL on leases with a beginning balance of $1.78 million, adoption impact of $685 thousand, negative provision of negative $703 thousand, charge-offs of $458 thousand and recoveries of $258 thousand. ACL on leases was $1.5 million as of December 31, 2021.

Year Ended December 31, 2020

Direct Financing

Residential Real

Installment and

    

C&I

    

CRE

    

Leases

    

Estate

    

Other Consumer

    

Total

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

16,072

$

15,379

$

1,464

$

1,948

$

1,138

$

36,001

Provision

 

22,899

 

28,671

 

2,148

 

1,755

 

231

 

55,704

Charge-offs

 

(4,199)

 

(2,071)

 

(1,993)

 

 

(120)

 

(8,383)

Recoveries

 

649

 

182

 

145

 

29

 

49

 

1,054

Balance, ending

$

35,421

$

42,161

$

1,764

$

3,732

$

1,298

$

84,376

Year Ended December 31, 2019

    

    

    

Direct Financing

    

Residential Real

    

Installment and

    

C&I

CRE

Leases

Estate

Other Consumer

Total

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

16,420

$

17,719

$

1,792

$

2,557

$

1,359

$

39,847

Reclassification of allowance related to held for sale assets

(2,814)

(2,392)

(628)

(288)

(6,122)

Provision

 

3,666

 

1,566

 

1,129

 

163

 

114

 

6,638

Loans/leases charged off

 

(1,476)

 

(1,722)

 

(1,647)

 

(191)

 

(98)

 

(5,134)

Recoveries on loans/leases previously charged off

 

276

 

208

 

190

 

47

 

51

 

772

Balance, ending

$

16,072

$

15,379

$

1,464

$

1,948

$

1,138

$

36,001

*Excludes provision related to loans included in assets held for sale during the year of $428 thousand for the year ending December 31, 2019.

The composition of the ACL loans/leases by portfolio segment based on evaluation method are as follows:

2021

Amortized Cost of Loans Receivable

Allowance for Credit Losses

Individually

Collectively

Individually

Collectively

Evaluated for

Evaluated for

Evaluated for

Evaluated for

    

Credit Losses

    

Credit Losses

Total

Credit Losses

    

Credit Losses

Total

(dollars in thousands)

C&I :

C&I - revolving

$

2,638

$

245,845

$

248,483

$

168

$

3,739

$

3,907

C&I - other*

 

13,456

 

1,378,337

 

1,391,793

 

743

 

25,239

 

25,982

 

16,094

 

1,624,182

 

1,640,276

 

911

 

28,978

 

29,889

CRE - owner occupied

 

3,841

 

417,860

 

421,701

 

1,264

 

7,237

 

8,501

CRE - non-owner occupied

 

25,006

 

621,494

 

646,500

 

 

8,549

 

8,549

Construction and land development

 

10,436

 

908,135

 

918,571

 

11

 

16,961

 

16,972

Multi-family

600,412

600,412

9,339

9,339

1-4 family real estate

 

2,950

 

374,411

 

377,361

 

329

 

4,212

 

4,541

Consumer

 

350

 

74,961

 

75,311

 

39

 

891

 

930

$

58,677

$

4,621,455

$

4,680,132

$

2,554

$

76,167

$

78,721

*Included within the C&I – other category are leases individually evaluated of $847 thousand with a related allowance for credit losses of $35 thousand and leases collectively evaluated of $44.4 million with a related allowance for credit losses of $1.5 million.

95

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

2020

 

Direct Financing

Residential Real

Installment and

 

    

C&I

    

CRE

    

Leases

    

Estate

    

Other Consumer

    

Total

 

 

(dollars in thousands)

Allowance for impaired loans/leases

$

650

$

1,938

$

$

20

$

72

$

2,680

Allowance for nonimpaired loans/leases

 

34,771

 

40,223

 

1,764

 

3,712

 

1,226

 

81,696

$

35,421

$

42,161

$

1,764

$

3,732

$

1,298

$

84,376

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Impaired loans/leases

$

5,381

$

7,487

$

578

$

977

$

205

$

14,628

Nonimpaired loans/leases

 

1,721,342

 

2,100,142

 

65,438

 

251,144

 

91,097

 

4,229,163

$

1,726,723

$

2,107,629

$

66,016

$

252,121

$

91,302

$

4,243,791

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Allowance as a percentage of impaired loans/leases

 

12.08

%  

 

25.88

%  

 

%  

 

2.05

%  

 

35.12

%  

 

18.32

%

Allowance as a percentage of nonimpaired loans/leases

 

2.02

%  

 

1.92

%  

 

2.70

%  

 

1.48

%  

 

1.35

%  

 

1.93

%

Total allowance as a percentage of total loans/leases

 

2.05

%  

 

2.00

%  

 

2.67

%  

 

1.48

%  

 

1.42

%  

 

1.99

%

 

Information for impaired loans/leases prior to adoption of ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2021, is presented in the tables below.  The recorded investment represents customer balances net of any partial charge-offs recognized on the loan/lease.  The unpaid principal balance represents the recorded balance outstanding on the loan/lease prior to any partial charge-offs.

96

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

Loans/leases, by classes of financing receivable, considered to be impaired as of and for the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 are presented as follows:

2020

Interest Income

Average

Recognized for

Recorded

Unpaid Principal

Related

Recorded

Interest Income

Cash Payments

Classes of Loans/Leases

    

Investment

    

Balance

    

Allowance

    

Investment

    

Recognized

    

Received

(dollars in thousands)

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Impaired Loans/Leases with No Specific Allowance Recorded:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C&I

$

1,361

$

1,441

$

$

1,002

$

33

$

33

CRE

 

  

 

 

 

 

 

Owner-occupied CRE

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial construction, land development, and other land

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other non-owner occupied CRE

 

1,133

 

1,933

 

 

494

 

29

 

29

Direct financing leases

 

578

 

578

 

 

483

 

17

 

17

Residential real estate

 

719

 

719

 

 

476

 

 

Installment and other consumer

 

133

 

133

 

 

121

 

 

$

3,924

$

4,804

$

$

2,576

$

79

$

79

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Impaired Loans/Leases with Specific Allowance Recorded:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

  

C&I

$

4,020

$

4,020

$

650

$

1,555

$

$

CRE

 

 

  

 

 

 

 

Owner-occupied CRE

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial construction, land development, and other land

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other non-owner occupied CRE

 

6,354

 

6,354

 

1,938

 

5,726

 

 

Direct financing leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential real estate

 

258

 

258

 

20

 

227

 

 

Installment and other consumer

 

72

 

72

 

72

 

70

 

 

$

10,704

$

10,704

$

2,680

$

7,578

$

$

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total Impaired Loans/Leases:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C&I

$

5,381

$

5,461

$

650

$

2,557

$

33

$

33

CRE

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Owner-occupied CRE

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial construction, land development, and other land

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other non-owner occupied CRE

 

7,487

 

8,287

 

1,938

 

6,220

 

29

 

29

Direct financing leases

 

578

 

578

 

 

483

 

17

 

17

Residential real estate

 

977

 

977

 

20

 

703

 

 

Installment and other consumer

 

205

 

205

 

72

 

191

 

 

$

14,628

$

15,508

$

2,680

$

10,154

$

79

$

79

97

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

2019

    

    

    

    

    

    

Interest Income

Average

Recognized for

Recorded

Unpaid Principal

Related

Recorded

Interest Income

Cash Payments

Classes of Loans/Leases

Investment

Balance

Allowance

Investment

Recognized

Received

(dollars in thousands)

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Impaired Loans/Leases with No Specific Allowance Recorded:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C&I

$

1,607

$

1,647

$

$

970

$

27

$

27

CRE

 

  

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Owner-Occupied CRE

 

34

 

50

 

 

24

 

 

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other Non Owner-Occupied CRE

 

684

 

686

 

 

738

 

29

 

29

Direct Financing Leases

 

1,642

 

1,642

 

 

1,322

 

30

 

30

Residential Real Estate

 

469

 

614

 

 

481

 

 

Installment and Other Consumer

 

476

 

476

 

 

474

 

 

$

4,912

$

5,115

$

$

4,009

$

86

$

86

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Impaired Loans/Leases with Specific Allowance Recorded:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C&I

$

239

$

239

$

170

$

124

$

$

CRE

 

  

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Owner-Occupied CRE

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other Non Owner-Occupied CRE

 

2,867

 

2,867

 

125

 

1,958

 

 

Direct Financing Leases

 

383

 

383

 

270

 

196

 

2

 

2

Residential Real Estate

 

180

 

180

 

15

 

72

 

 

Installment and Other Consumer

 

80

 

80

 

80

 

62

 

 

$

3,749

$

3,749

$

660

$

2,412

$

2

$

2

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total Impaired Loans/Leases:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C&I

$

1,846

$

1,886

$

170

$

1,094

$

27

$

27

CRE

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Owner-Occupied CRE

 

34

 

50

 

 

24

 

 

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other Non Owner-Occupied CRE

 

3,551

 

3,553

 

125

 

2,696

 

29

 

29

Direct Financing Leases

 

2,025

 

2,025

 

270

 

1,518

 

32

 

32

Residential Real Estate

 

649

 

794

 

15

 

553

 

 

Installment and Other Consumer

 

556

 

556

 

80

 

536

 

 

$

8,661

$

8,864

$

660

$

6,421

$

88

$

88

*Impaired loans/leases prior to adoption of ASU 2016-13 and those individually evaluated under ASU 2016-13 for which no allowance has been provided have adequate collateral, based on management’s current estimates.

98

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

The following table present the amortized cost basis of collateral dependent loans, by the primary collateral type, which are individually evaluated to determine expected credit losses:

2021

Non

Commercial

Owner-Occupied

Owner Occupied

    

Assets

    

Real Estate

Real Estate

Securities

Equipment

Other

Total

(dollars in thousands)

C & I:

C&I - revolving

$

2,518

$

$

$

$

120

$

$

2,638

C&I - other*

 

683

 

 

2,471

 

134

 

9,877

 

291

 

13,456

 

3,201

 

 

2,471

 

134

 

9,997

 

291

 

16,094

CRE - owner occupied

 

 

 

3,841

 

 

 

 

3,841

CRE - non-owner occupied

 

 

25,006

 

 

 

 

 

25,006

Construction and land development

 

 

10,362

 

74

 

 

 

 

10,436

Multi-family

1-4 family real estate

 

 

817

 

2,133

 

 

 

 

2,950

Consumer

 

 

 

340

 

 

1

 

9

 

350

$

3,201

$

36,185

$

8,859

$

134

$

9,998

$

300

$

58,677

*Included within the C&I – other category are leases individually evaluated of $847 thousand with primary collateral of equipment.

For certain C&I loans, all CRE loans, certain construction and land development loans, all multifamily loans and certain 1-4 family real estate loans, the Company’s credit quality indicator consists of internally assigned risk ratings.  Each such loan is assigned a risk rating upon origination.  The risk rating is reviewed every 15 months, at a minimum, and on an as-needed basis depending on the specific circumstances of the loan.

For certain C&I loans (including equipment financing agreements and direct financing leases), certain construction and land development, certain 1-4 family real estate loans, and all consumer loans, the Company’s credit quality indicator is performance determined by delinquency status.  Prior to adoption of ASU 2016-13, this included C&I equipment financing agreements, direct financing leases, residential real estate loans, and installment and other consumer loans.  Delinquency status is updated daily by the Company’s loan system.

99

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

The following tables show the credit quality indicator of  loans by class of receivable and year of origination as of December 31, 2021;

2021

Term Loans

 

Amortized Cost Basis by Origination Year

 

Revolving

Loans

Internally Assigned

Amortized

Risk Rating

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

    

2018

    

2017

Prior

Cost Basis

Total

(dollars in thousands)

C&I - revolving

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

245,212

$

245,212

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

633

 

633

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,638

 

2,638

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total C&I - revolving

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

248,483

$

248,483

C&I - other

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

391,532

$

362,256

$

133,678

$

82,177

$

83,419

$

53,310

$

$

1,106,372

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

3,580

 

373

 

349

 

 

336

 

2

 

 

4,640

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

506

 

2,366

 

7,138

 

396

 

55

 

46

 

 

10,507

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total C&I - other

$

395,618

$

364,995

$

141,165

$

82,573

$

83,810

$

53,358

$

$

1,121,519

CRE - owner occupied

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

118,014

$

143,045

$

47,660

$

30,523

$

17,038

$

46,185

$

11,477

$

413,942

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

637

 

 

 

233

 

1,846

 

1,202

 

 

3,918

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

 

 

2,080

 

1,239

 

522

 

 

 

3,841

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total CRE - owner occupied

$

118,651

$

143,045

$

49,740

$

31,995

$

19,406

$

47,387

$

11,477

$

421,701

CRE - non-owner occupied

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

176,813

$

145,712

$

88,697

$

63,849

$

55,752

$

28,808

$

8,592

$

568,223

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

7,295

 

20,881

 

1,802

 

12,230

 

5,494

 

5,580

 

 

53,282

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

1,105

 

6,297

 

15,563

 

1,087

 

943

 

 

 

24,995

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total CRE - non-owner occupied

$

185,213

$

172,890

$

106,062

$

77,166

$

62,189

$

34,388

$

8,592

$

646,500

Construction and land development

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

394,045

$

248,360

$

126,941

$

106,790

$

3,012

$

$

13,277

$

892,425

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

10,362

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10,362

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Construction and land development

$

404,407

$

248,360

$

126,941

$

106,790

$

3,012

$

$

13,277

$

902,787

Multi-family

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

266,120

$

197,224

$

74,033

$

47,486

$

5,609

$

7,376

$

2,564

$

600,412

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Multi-family

$

266,120

$

197,224

$

74,033

$

47,486

$

5,609

$

7,376

$

2,564

$

600,412

1-4 family real estate

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

47,097

$

24,029

$

16,188

$

7,569

$

5,845

$

5,213

$

3,079

$

109,020

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

37

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

37

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

 

178

 

 

437

 

201

 

 

 

816

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total 1-4 family real estate

$

47,134

$

24,207

$

16,188

$

8,006

$

6,046

$

5,213

$

3,079

$

109,873

Consumer

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

1,558

$

487

$

108

$

216

$

$

824

$

2,031

$

5,224

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

 

 

 

137

 

 

 

 

137

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Consumer

$

1,558

$

487

$

108

$

353

$

$

824

$

2,031

$

5,361

Total

$

1,418,701

$

1,151,208

$

514,237

$

354,369

$

180,072

$

148,546

$

289,503

$

4,056,636

100

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

2021

Term Loans

 

Amortized Cost Basis by Origination Year

Revolving

Loans

Amortized

Delinquency Status *

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

    

2018

    

2017

Prior

Cost Basis

Total

 

(dollars in thousands)

C&I - other

Performing

$

117,163

$

54,261

$

33,390

$

14,274

$

4,200

$

455

$

$

223,743

Nonperforming

 

95

 

177

 

644

 

368

 

42

 

14

 

 

1,340

Total C&I - other

$

117,258

$

54,438

$

34,034

$

14,642

$

4,242

$

469

$

$

225,083

Direct financing leases

Performing

$

6,690

$

12,130

$

11,638

$

9,235

$

3,695

$

956

$

$

44,344

Nonperforming

 

 

732

 

 

52

 

18

 

45

 

 

847

Total Direct financing leases

$

6,690

$

12,862

$

11,638

$

9,287

$

3,713

$

1,001

$

$

45,191

Construction and land development

Performing

$

12,857

$

2,080

$

$

494

$

$

$

280

$

15,711

Nonperforming

 

 

 

 

 

73

 

 

 

73

Total Construction and land development

$

12,857

$

2,080

$

$

494

$

73

$

$

280

$

15,784

1-4 family real estate

Performing

$

104,005

$

78,713

$

19,001

$

10,784

$

10,533

$

43,976

$

68

$

267,080

Nonperforming

 

 

 

 

106

 

 

302

 

 

408

Total 1-4 family real estate

$

104,005

$

78,713

$

19,001

$

10,890

$

10,533

$

44,278

$

68

$

267,488

Consumer

Performing

$

4,891

$

4,020

$

2,114

$

1,660

$

593

$

1,230

$

55,411

$

69,919

Nonperforming

 

 

 

15

 

 

15

 

1

 

 

31

Total Consumer

$

4,891

$

4,020

$

2,129

$

1,660

$

608

$

1,231

$

55,411

$

69,950

Total

$

245,701

$

152,113

$

66,802

$

36,973

$

19,169

$

46,979

$

55,759

$

623,496

*Performing = loans/leases accruing and less than 90 days past due.  Nonperforming = loans/leases on nonaccrual and accruing loans/leases that are greater than or equal to 90 days past due.

101

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

For each class of financing receivable, the following presents the recorded investment by credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2020 and 2019:

2020

 

CRE

Non-Owner Occupied

Commercial

 

Construction,

 

Land

 

Owner-Occupied

Development,

As a % of

 

Internally Assigned Risk Rating

    

C&I

    

CRE

    

and Other Land

    

Other CRE

    

Total

    

Total

 

 

(dollars in thousands)

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

1,506,578

$

488,478

$

530,297

$

999,931

$

3,525,284

 

96.25

%

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

23,929

 

3,087

 

680

 

43,785

 

71,481

 

1.95

%

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

24,710

 

4,906

 

10,478

 

25,987

 

66,081

 

1.80

%

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

$

1,555,217

$

496,471

$

541,455

$

1,069,703

$

3,662,846

 

100.00

%

2020

 

Direct Financing

Residential Real

Installment and

As a % of

 

Delinquency Status *

    

C&I

    

Leases

    

Estate

    

Other Consumer

    

Total

    

Total

 

(dollars in thousands)

Performing

$

170,712

$

65,475

$

251,099

$

91,094

$

578,380

 

99.56

%

Nonperforming

 

794

 

541

 

1,022

 

208

 

2,565

 

0.44

%

$

171,506

$

66,016

$

252,121

$

91,302

$

580,945

 

100.00

%

2019

CRE

Non-Owner Occupied

Commercial

 

Construction,

 

Land

 

Owner-Occupied

Development,

As a % of

 

Internally Assigned Risk Rating

    

C&I

    

CRE

    

and Other Land

    

Other CRE

    

Total

    

Total

 

 

(dollars in thousands)

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

$

1,334,446

$

439,418

$

378,572

$

896,206

$

3,048,642

 

98.28

%

Special Mention (Rating 6)

 

12,962

 

3,044

 

41

 

3,905

 

19,952

 

0.64

%

Substandard (Rating 7)

 

18,439

 

1,527

 

184

 

13,499

 

33,649

 

1.08

%

Doubtful (Rating 8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

$

1,365,847

$

443,989

$

378,797

$

913,610

$

3,102,243

100.00

%

2019

 

Direct Financing

Residential Real

Installment and

As a % of

 

Delinquency Status *

    

C&I

    

Leases

    

Estate

    

Other Consumer

    

Total

    

Total

 

(dollars in thousands)

Performing

$

140,992

$

86,019

$

239,198

$

108,763

$

574,972

 

99.29

%

Nonperforming

 

986

 

1,850

 

706

 

589

 

4,131

 

0.71

%

$

141,978

$

87,869

$

239,904

$

109,352

$

579,103

 

100.00

%

*   Prior to adoption of ASU 2016-13: Performing = loans/leases accruing and less than 90 days past due. Nonperforming = loans/leases on nonaccrual, accruing loans/leases that are greater than or equal to 90 days past due, and accruing TDRs.

102

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

TDRs totaled $494 thousand and $1.7 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

For each class of financing receivable, the following presents the number and recorded investment of TDRs, by type of concession, that were restructured during the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. The difference between the pre-modification recorded investment and the post-modification recorded investment would be any partial charge-offs at the time of restructuring.

2021

    

Pre-

    

Post-

    

Modification

Modification

Number of

Recorded

Recorded

Specific

Classes of Loans/Leases

Loans / Leases

Investment

Investment

Allowance

(dollars in thousands)

CONCESSION - Extension of Maturity

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

1-4 family real estate

1

$

2,532

$

2,532

$

182

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

CONCESSION - Interest Rate Adjusted Below Market

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

1-4 family real estate

1

$

54

$

54

$

6

Consumer

1

13

13

1

2

$

67

$

67

$

7

TOTAL

3

$

2,599

$

2,599

$

189

2020

    

Pre-

    

Post-

    

Modification

Modification

Number of

Recorded

Recorded

Specific

Classes of Loans/Leases

Loans / Leases

Investment

Investment

Allowance

(dollars in thousands)

CONCESSION - Significant Payment Delay

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

C&I

1

$

75

$

75

$

Direct Financing Leases

2

112

112

3

$

187

$

187

$

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

CONCESSION - Extension of Maturity

CRE Other

1

$

835

$

835

$

TOTAL

4

$

1,022

$

1,022

$

Of the loans restructured reported above, one with a post-modification recorded investment totaling $54 thousand was on nonaccrual as of December 31, 2021 and two with a post-modification recorded investment totaling $880 thousand were on nonaccrual as of December 31, 2020.

For the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company did not have any TDRs that redefaulted within 12 months subsequent to restructure, where default is defined as delinquency of 90 days or more and/or placement on nonaccrual status. For the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company had one TDR totaling $44 thousand that redefaulted within 12 months subsequent to restructure, where default is defined as delinquency of 90 days or more and/or placement on nonaccrual status.

The Company did not have any TDRs that were restructured and charged off in 2021. There were five TDRs that were both restructured and charged off in 2020, totaling $266 thousand.

103

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

On March 22, 2020, federal banking regulators issued an interagency statement that included guidance on their approach for the accounting of loan modifications in light of the economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic. The guidance interprets current accounting standards and indicates that a lender can conclude that a borrower is not experiencing financial difficulty if short-term modifications are made in response to COVID-19, such as payment deferrals, fee waivers, extensions of repayment terms or other delays in payment that are insignificant related to the loans in which the borrower is less than 30 days past due on its contractual payments at the time a modification program is implemented. The agencies confirmed in working with the staff of the FASB that short-term modifications made on a good faith basis in response to COVID-19 to borrowers who were current prior to any relief are not TDRs. The regulators clarified that this guidance could continue to be applied through December 31, 2021.

In addition, the CARES Act provides financial institutions the option to temporarily suspend certain requirements under GAAP related to TDRs for a limited period of time to account for the effects of COVID-19. To be eligible, the modification must be (1) related to COVID-19, (2) executed on a loan that was not more than 30 days past due as of December 31, 2019 and (3) executed between March 1, 2020 and the earlier of (A) 60 days after the termination of the presidentially-declared emergency or (B) December 31, 2020. If a modification does not meet the criteria of the CARES act, a deferral can still be excluded from TDR treatment as long as the modifications meet the banking regulatory criteria discussed in the preceding paragraph. On December 27, 2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act was established, which extended the eligibility window for TDR relief to the earlier of (A) 60 days after the termination of the presidentially-declared emergency or (B) January 1, 2022.  Accordingly, the Company has ended the LRP.

The Company implemented its LRP during the first quarter of 2020 offering to extend qualifying customers’ payments for 90 days.  As of December 31, 2021, there were no bank modifications of loans and six m2 modifications of loans and leases totaling $2.4 million, representing 0.05% of the total loan and lease portfolio that remained on deferral as of such date.

The adoption of ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2021 required an allowance for OBS exposures, specifically on unfunded commitments.  Changes in the ACL for OBS exposures for the year ended December 31, 2021 is presented as follows:

For the Year Ended

December 31, 2021

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

Impact of adopting ASU 2016-13

9,117

Provisions credited to expense

 

(2,231)

Balance, ending

$

6,886

104

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 4. Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

Loans are made in the normal course of business to directors, executive officers, and their related interests. All such loans, in the opinion of management, were made in the ordinary course of business, on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with persons not related to the lenders and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features. An analysis of the changes in the aggregate committed amount of loans to insiders greater than or equal to $60,000 during the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019, is as follows:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

100,361

$

112,830

$

125,496

Net decrease due to change in related parties

 

(18,832)

 

(1,601)

 

(12,161)

Advances

 

42,817

 

43,238

 

98,708

Repayments

 

(23,448)

 

(54,106)

 

(99,213)

Balance, ending

$

100,898

$

100,361

$

112,830

The Company’s loan portfolio includes a geographic concentration in the Midwest. Additionally, the loan portfolio includes a concentration of loans in certain industries as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 as follows:

2021

2020

 

Percentage of

Percentage of

 

Total

Total

 

Industry Name

    

Balance

    

Loans/Leases

    

Balance

    

Loans/Leases

 

(dollars in thousands)

Lessors of Residential Buildings*

$

1,706,092

 

36

%  

$

1,134,178

 

27

%

Lessors of Non-Residential Buildings

586,672

 

13

%  

591,398

 

14

%

Administration of Urban Planning & Community & Rural Development

 

120,416

 

3

%  

 

138,514

 

3

%

* Includes loans on LIHTC projects

Note 5. Premises and Equipment

The following summarizes the components of premises and equipment as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Land

$

12,513

$

13,403

Buildings (useful lives 15 to 39 years)

 

70,555

 

67,844

Furniture and equipment (useful lives 3 to 15 years)

 

47,822

 

42,667

Premises and equipment

 

130,890

 

123,914

Less accumulated depreciation

 

52,360

 

51,221

Premises and equipment, net

$

78,530

$

72,693

105

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 5. Premises and Equipment (continued)

As a lessee, the Company has entered into operating leases for certain branch locations.  Total lease expenses were $636 thousand and $662 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

At December 31, 2021 and 2020, the Company’s ROU assets (included in other assets on the consolidated balance sheets) and operating lease liabilities (included in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets) were both $1.3 million and $1.7 million, respectively. No new ROU assets were capitalized during the year ended December 31, 2021 or 2020.

At December 31, 2021, the contractual maturities of operating lease liabilities were as follows:

    

Amount

Year ending December 31:

    

(dollars in thousands)

2022

 

269

2023

 

200

2024

 

144

2025

 

153

2026

 

159

Thereafter

 

544

$

1,469

As a lessor, the Company leases certain types of commercial vehicles and industrial equipment to its customers.  The Company recognized lease-related revenue, primarily interest income from direct financing leases of $4.0 million and $5.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.  At December 31, 2021 and 2020, the Company’s net investment in direct financing leases was $44.2 million and $65.3 million, respectively.

As of December 31, 2021, the contractual maturities of sales-type and direct financing lease receivables were as follows:

    

Amount

Year ending December 31:

    

(dollars in thousands)

2022

 

2,590

2023

 

12,461

2024

 

14,319

2025

 

14,508

2026

 

5,019

Thereafter

 

465

Total lease payments receivable

$

49,362

Unguaranteed residual values

165

Unearned lease/residual income

(4,336)

$

45,191

Plus deferred origination costs, net of fees

568

$

45,759

Less allowance

(1,546)

Total lease payments receivable

$

44,213

106

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

The

Note 6. Goodwill and Intangibles

The following table presents the changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Balance at the beginning of period

$

74,066

$

74,748

$

77,832

Acquisition of Bates Companies - measurement period adjustment

(84)

Sale of Bates Companies

(182)

Goodwill impairment - Bates Companies

(500)

(3,000)

Balance at the end of period

$

74,066

$

74,066

$

74,748

The following table presents the goodwill by reportable segment:

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

December 31, 2019

(dollars in thousands)

Commercial banking:

QCBT

$

3,223

$

3,223

$

3,223

CRBT

 

14,980

 

14,980

 

14,980

CSB

9,888

9,888

9,888

SFCB

 

45,975

 

45,975

 

45,975

Other, Parent Company Only

682

$

74,066

$

74,066

$

74,748

At November 30, 2021 and 2020 the Company’s management performed an annual internal assessment at the reporting unit level and determined no goodwill impairment existed.

Due to the economic impact that COVID-19 had on the Company during 2020, management concluded that factors such as the decline in macroeconomic conditions led to the occurrence of a triggering event during the first quarter of 2020, and therefore an interim impairment test over goodwill was performed as of March 31, 2020.   Based upon the results of the interim goodwill assessment during the first quarter of 2020, the Company concluded that an impairment did not exist on the bank reporting units as of the time of the assessment.  There was no occurrence of a triggering event during the second or third quarter of 2020 and therefore no impairment test over goodwill was needed.

During the first quarter of 2020, the Company incurred goodwill impairment expense of $500 thousand related to the Bates Companies reporting unit.  This was the result of the announcement of a sale of the Bates Companies, as discussed in Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.  

As of November 30, 2019, the Company’s management performed an internal assessment of the goodwill for the Bates Companies reporting unit.  With the Bates Companies located in Rockford, Illinois, the Company had intended to achieve synergies and cross-selling opportunities that significantly enhanced the value of the Bates Companies.  With the sale of the assets and liabilities of RB&T, which was the Company’s bank subsidiary located

in Rockford, Illinois, the Company’s valuation analysis determined the value had declined and the goodwill was impaired.  Specifically, the Company determined a goodwill impairment charge of $3 million was required for the Bates Companies.  The Company used a combination of methods to determine the value and related goodwill impairment charge.  The methods included prices of comparable businesses as well as discussions with existing wealth management providers in the surrounding Rockford market. 

107

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 6. Goodwill and Intangibles (continued)

The following table presents the changes in core deposit intangibles (included in Intangibles on the consolidated balance sheets) during the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019:

    

2021

2020

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Balance at the beginning of the period

$

11,381

$

13,466

$

15,595

Amortization expense

 

(2,032)

 

(2,085)

 

(2,129)

Balance at the end of the period

$

9,349

$

11,381

$

13,466

 

  

 

  

 

  

Gross carrying amount

$

19,255

$

19,255

$

19,255

Accumulated amortization

 

(9,906)

 

(7,874)

 

(5,789)

Net book value

$

9,349

$

11,381

$

13,466

The following table presents the core deposit intangibles by reportable segment:

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

December 31, 2019

(dollars in thousands)

Commercial Banking:

CRBT

$

1,702

$

2,189

$

2,684

CSB

2,653

3,305

3,980

SFCB

4,994

5,887

6,802

$

9,349

$

11,381

$

13,466

The following table presents the estimated amortization of the core deposit intangibles:

    

Amount

Years ending December 31,

(dollars in thousands)

2022

$

1,971

2023

 

1,776

2024

 

1,623

2025

 

1,535

2026

 

1,284

Thereafter

 

1,160

$

9,349

The following table presents the changes in customer list intangible (included in Intangibles on the Consolidated Balance Sheets) during the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019.  There was no activity during the year ended December 31, 2021.

    

2020

    

2019

Balance at the beginning of period

$

1,504

$

1,855

Acquisition of Bates Companies - measurement period adjustment

(214)

Sale of Bates Companies

(1,440)

Amortization

 

(64)

 

(137)

Balance at the end of period

$

$

1,504

The customer list intangible relates to the Parent Company Only (“All Other”) reportable segment.

108

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 7. Derivatives and Hedging Activities

Derivatives are summarized as follows as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

December 31, 2021

    

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

Assets:

Interest rate caps - hedged

$

927

$

259

Interest rate caps

 

238

 

67

Interest rate swaps

 

221,055

 

222,431

$

222,220

$

222,757

Liabilities:

Interest rate swaps - hedged

$

(4,080)

$

(6,839)

Interest rate swaps

(221,055)

(222,431)

$

(225,135)

$

(229,270)

The Company uses interest rate swap and cap instruments to manage interest rate risk related to the variability of interest payments due to changes in interest rates.

The Company entered into interest rate caps to hedge against the risk of rising interest rates on liabilities.  The liabilities consist of $300.0 million of deposits and the benchmark rates hedged vary at 1-month LIBOR, 3-month LIBOR and the Prime Rate. The interest rate caps are designated as cash flow hedges in accordance with ASC 815.  An initial premium of $3.5 million was paid upfront for the caps executed.    The details of the interest rate caps are as follows:

Balance Sheet

Fair Value as of

Hedged Item

Effective Date

Maturity Date

Location

Notional Amount

Strike Rate

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2023

Derivatives - Assets

$

25,000

1.75

%  

$

5

$

3

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2023

Derivatives - Assets

50,000

1.57

11

5

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2023

Derivatives - Assets

25,000

1.80

5

3

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2024

Derivatives - Assets

25,000

1.75

60

15

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2024

Derivatives - Assets

50,000

1.57

125

31

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2024

Derivatives - Assets

25,000

1.80

62

15

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2025

Derivatives - Assets

25,000

1.75

161

46

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2025

Derivatives - Assets

50,000

1.57

332

94

Deposits

1/1/2020

1/1/2025

Derivatives - Assets

25,000

1.80

166

47

$

300,000

$

927

$

259

In December 2020, the Company redesignated three of its interest rate caps, which had been purchased in 2019 for $800 thousand.  The caps, which were designated as cash flow hedges at the time of purchase, are now designated as

unhedged.  A loss of $649 thousand was recognized due to the change in designation as the underlying hedged item no longer exists. For derivative instruments that are designated as unhedged, the change in fair value of the derivative

instrument is recognized into current earnings. The details of the unhedged interest rate caps are as follows:

Balance Sheet

Fair Value as of

Effective Date

Maturity Date

Location

Notional Amount

Strike Rate

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

1/1/2020

1/1/2023

Derivatives - Assets

$

25,000

1.90

%  

$

3

$

2

2/1/2020

2/1/2024

Derivatives - Assets

25,000

1.90

62

15

3/1/2020

3/1/2025

Derivatives - Assets

25,000

1.90

173

50

$

75,000

$

238

$

67

109

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 7. Derivatives and Hedging Activities (continued)

The Company entered into interest rate swaps to hedge against the risk of declining interest rates on floating rate loans.  All of the interest rate swaps are designated as cash flow hedges in accordance with ASC 815.  The details of the interest rate swaps are as follows:

Balance Sheet

Fair Value as of

Hedged Item

Effective Date

Maturity Date

Location

Notional Amount

Receive Rate

Pay Rate

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

Loans

 

7/1/2021

7/1/2031

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

35,000

1.40

%  

 

2.81

%  

(17)

N/A

Loans

 

7/1/2021

7/1/2031

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

50,000

1.40

%  

 

2.81

%  

(25)

N/A

Loans

 

7/1/2021

7/1/2031

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

40,000

1.40

%  

 

2.81

%  

(34)

N/A

Loans

 

7/1/2021

7/1/2031

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

25,000

1.40

%  

 

2.81

%  

(13)

N/A

 

  

 

$

150,000

$

(89)

$

N/A

The Company entered into interest rate swaps to hedge against the risk of rising rates on its variable rate trust preferred securities.  All of the interest rate swaps are designated as cash flow hedges in accordance with ASC 815.  The details of the interest rate swaps are as follows:

Balance Sheet

Fair Value as of

Hedged Item

Effective Date

Maturity Date

Location

Notional Amount

Receive Rate

Pay Rate

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust II

 

9/30/2018

9/30/2028

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

10,000

3.07

%  

 

5.85

%  

(1,035)

(1,767)

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust III

 

9/30/2018

9/30/2028

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

8,000

3.07

%  

 

5.85

%  

(828)

(1,414)

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust V

 

7/7/2018

7/7/2028

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

10,000

1.67

%  

 

4.54

%  

(996)

(1,721)

Community National Statutory Trust II

 

9/20/2018

9/20/2028

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

3,000

2.38

%  

 

5.17

%  

(309)

(529)

Community National Statutory Trust III

 

9/15//2018

9/15/2028

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

3,500

1.95

%  

 

4.75

%  

(360)

(616)

Guaranty Bankshares Statutory Trust I

 

9/15/2018

9/15/2028

Derivatives - Liabilities

 

4,500

1.95

%  

 

4.75

%  

(463)

(792)

 

  

 

$

39,000

$

(3,991)

$

(6,839)

In the first quarter of 2020, the Company entered into $40 million of interest rate swaps which were then terminated in the fourth quarter of 2020, resulting in a loss of $808 thousand.

Changes in the fair values of derivative financial instruments accounted for as cash flow hedges to the extent they are included in the assessment of effectiveness, are recorded as a component of AOCI. The following is a summary of how AOCI was impacted during the reporting periods:

Year Ended

    

December 31, 2021

    

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

Unrealized loss at beginning of period, net of tax

$

(7,632)

$

(3,915)

Amount reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income to noninterest expense related to unhedging caplet

 

 

513

Amount reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income to noninterest expense related to swap termination

625

Amount reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income to interest expense related to caplet amortization

 

697

 

551

Amount of gain (loss) recognized in other comprehensive income, net of tax

 

2,562

 

(5,406)

Unrealized loss at end of period, net of tax

$

(4,373)

$

(7,632)

As discussed under “Swap Transactions” in Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, the Company has also entered into interest rate swap contracts that are not designated as hedging instruments.  These derivative contracts relate to transactions in which the Company enters into an interest rate swap with a customer while at the same time entering into an offsetting interest rate swap with a third party financial institution. Additionally, the Company receives an upfront, non-refundable fee from the counterparty, dependent upon the pricing that is recognized upon receipt from the counterparty. Because the Company acts as an intermediary for the customer, changes in the fair value of the underlying derivative contracts, for the most part, offset each other and do not significantly impact the Company’s results of operations.

110

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 7. Derivatives and Hedging Activities (continued)

Interest rate swaps that are not designated as hedging instruments are summarized as follows:

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

Notional Amount

Estimated Fair Value

Notional Amount

Estimated Fair Value

(dollars in thousands)

Non-Hedging Interest Rate Derivatives Assets:

Interest rate swap contracts

$

2,024,599

$

221,055

$

1,495,251

$

222,431

Non-Hedging Interest Rate Derivatives Liabilities:

Interest rate swap contracts

$

2,024,599

$

221,055

$

1,495,251

$

222,431

The effect of cash flow hedging and fair value accounting on the consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 are as follows:

Year Ended December 31, 2021

Year Ended December 31, 2020

Year Ended December 31, 2019

Interest and

Interest

Interest and

Interest

Interest and

Interest

Dividend Income

Expense

Dividend Income

Expense

Dividend Income

Expense

(dollars in thousands)

Income and expense line items presented in the consolidated statements of income

$

200,155

$

21,922

$

198,373

$

31,423

$

216,076

$

60,517

The effects of cash flow hedging:

Gain (loss) on cash flow hedges:

Interest rate caps on deposits

-

697

-

551

-

-

Interest rate swaps on variable rate loans

1,006

-

-

185

-

-

Interest rate swaps on TRUPS

-

1,114

-

832

-

215

The Company’s hedged interest rate swaps and non-hedged interest rate swaps are collateralized with cash and investment securities with carrying values as follows:

    

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

(dollars in thousands)

Cash

$

21,100

$

45,719

U.S treasuries and govt. sponsored agency securities

3,555

3,628

Municipal securities

65,104

85,937

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

139,166

 

89,646

$

228,925

$

224,930

The Company may be exposed to credit risk in the event of non-performance by the counterparties to its interest rate derivative agreements.  The Company assesses the credit risk of its financial institution counterparties by monitoring publicly available credit rating and financial information.  Additionally, the Company manages financial institution counterparty credit risk by entering into interest rate derivatives only with primary and highly rated counterparties, the use of ISDA master agreements, central clearing mechanisms and counterparty limits.  The agreements contain bilateral collateral arrangements with the amount of collateral to be posted generally governed by the settlement value of outstanding swaps.  The Company manages the risk of default by its borrower counterparties through its normal loan underwriting and credit monitoring policies and procedures.  The Company underwrites the combination of the

base loan amount and potential swap exposure and focuses on high quality borrowers with strong collateral values.  The majority of the Company’s swapped loan portfolio consists of loans on projects, with loan-to-values including the potential swap exposure well below 65%.  The Company does not currently anticipate any losses from failure of interest rate derivative counterparties to honor their obligations.

111

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 8. Deposits

The aggregate amount of certificates of deposit, each with a minimum denomination of $250,000, was $169.0 million and $175.6 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

As of December 31, 2021, the scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit were as follows:

Amount

(dollars in thousands)

Year ending December 31:

    

2022

$

334,214

2023

 

57,712

2024

 

16,747

2025

 

9,802

2026

 

2,873

Thereafter

 

$

421,348

The Company has public entity interest-bearing demand deposits and certificates of deposit that are collateralized by investment securities with carrying values as follows:

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

$

3,080

$

3,668

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

3,270

 

4,772

$

6,350

$

8,440

The Company had a $129.5 million PUD LOC with the FHLB of Des Moines for the purpose of providing additional collateral on public deposits as of December 31, 2021. As of December 31, 2020, the Company had a $110.5 million PUD LOC with the FHLB of Des Moines. There were no amounts outstanding under these letters of credit as of December 31, 2021 or 2020.

There were no prepayments of brokered certificates of deposits in 2021. The Company prepaid brokered and public time deposits totaling $29.2 million in 2020 resulting in a loss of $576 thousand.

112

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 9. Short-Term Borrowings

Short-term borrowings as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are summarized as follows:

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Federal funds purchased

 

3,800

 

5,430

$

3,800

$

5,430

Information concerning federal funds purchased is summarized as follows for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

2021

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Average daily balance

$

6,280

$

19,573

Average daily interest rate

 

0.08

%  

 

0.36

%

Maximum month-end balance

$

11,320

$

30,430

Weighted average rate as of December 31

 

0.08

%  

 

0.06

%

Note 10. FHLB Advances

The subsidiary banks are members of the FHLB of Des Moines. Maturity and interest rate information on advances from the FHLB as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 is as follows:

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

 

Weighted

Weighted

 

Average

Average

 

Interest Rate

Interest Rate

 

    

Amount Due

    

at Year-End

    

Amount Due

    

at Year-End

 

(dollars in thousands)

Maturity:

Year ending December 31:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

2021

$

%

$

15,000

0.29

%

2022

15,000

0.31

Total FHLB advances

$

15,000

 

0.31

%  

$

15,000

 

0.29

%

The Company prepaid $55.3 million of FHLB advances in 2020 with excess funds generated by strong deposit growth. The loss on the prepayment of the FHLB advances totaled $1.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2020.

Advances are collateralized by loans of $1.3 billion and $1.1 billion as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively, in aggregate. On pledged loans, the FHLB applies varying collateral maintenance levels from 125% to 333% based on the loan type. Advances are also collateralized by securities of $334 thousand and $590 thousand as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively, in aggregate. The Company continues to pledge loans under blanket liens to provide off balance sheet liquidity.

All advances outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are short-term advances from the FHLB. These advances have maturities ranging from 1 day to 1 month.

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the subsidiary banks held $7.8 million and $6.6 million, respectively, of FHLB stock, which is included in restricted investment securities on the consolidated balance sheet.

113

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 11. Other Borrowings and Unused Lines of Credit

In the second quarter of 2021, the Company renewed its revolving line of credit.  At renewal, the line amount remained unchanged at $25.0 million for which there was no outstanding balance as of December 31, 2021. Interest on the revolving line of credit is calculated at the effective Prime Rate plus 2.25% per annum (5.50% at December 31, 2021). The collateral on the revolving line of credit is 100% of the outstanding capital stock of the Company’s bank subsidiaries.

Unused lines of credit of the subsidiary banks as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are summarized as follows:

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Secured

$

61,657

$

287,076

Unsecured

 

456,000

 

456,000

$

517,657

$

743,076

Included in the Secured category above, the Company pledges select C&I, CRE and PPP loans to the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago for borrowing as part of the Borrower-In-Custody program.

Note 12. Subordinated Notes

Subordinated notes as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are summarized as follows:

Amount Outstanding

Interest Rate

Amount Outstanding

Interest Rate

as of December 31, 2021

as of December 31, 2021

as of December 31, 2020

as of December 31, 2020

Maturity Date

(dollars in thousands)

Subordinated debenture dated 9/14/20

$

50,000

5.125

%

$

50,000

5.125

%

9/15/2030

Subordinated debenture dated 2/1/19

65,000

5.375

%

65,000

5.375

%

2/15/2029

Subordinated debenture dated 4/30/16*

-

%

2,000

4.00

%

4/30/2026

Subordinated debenture dated 9/15/16*

-

%

3,000

4.00

%

9/15/2026

Debt issuance costs

(1,150)

(1,309)

Total Subordinated Debentures

$

113,850

$

118,691

*Assumed in acquisition of SFCB

On September 14, 2020, the Company completed a private offering of $50.0 million in aggregate principal amount of fixed-to-floating subordinated notes that mature on September 15, 2030. The subordinated notes, which qualify as Tier 2 capital for the Company, bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.125% per year, from and including September 14, 2020 to, but excluding, September 15, 2025 or earlier redemption date.  From and including September 15, 2025 to,

but excluding, the maturity date or earlier redemption date, the interest rate will reset quarterly at a variable rate, which is expected to be the then current three-month term SOFR plus 500 basis points.  Interest on the subordinated notes is payable quarterly, commencing on December 15, 2020. The subordinated notes are redeemable by the Company at its option, in whole or in part, on any interest payment date on or after September 15, 2025.  The subordinated notes are redeemable by the Company in whole but not in part, under certain limited circumstances set forth in the subordinated notes.  Any redemption by the Company would be at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the subordinated notes being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest on the subordinated notes being

redeemed to, but excluding, the date of redemption.  The subordinated notes are subordinate in the right of payment to the Company’s senior indebtedness and the indebtedness and other liabilities of the subsidiary banks.

In addition, the Company has $65.0 million in aggregate principal amount of fixed-to-floating subordinated notes that mature on February 15, 2029. Net proceeds, after deducting the underwriting discount and estimated expenses, were $63.4 million.  The subordinated notes, which qualify as Tier 2 capital for the Company, bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.375% per year from and after February 12, 2019 to, but excluding, February 15, 2024 or earlier redemption date.  From and after February 15, 2024 to, but excluding, the maturity date or earlier redemption date, the interest

114

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 12. Subordinated Notes (continued)

will reset quarterly to the then current three-month LIBOR plus 282 basis points.  Interest on the subordinated notes is payable semi-annually, commencing on August 15, 2019 during the five year fixed term and thereafter quarterly, commencing on February 15, 2024.  The subordinated notes are redeemable by the Company at its option, in whole or in part, on any interest payment date on or after February 15, 2024.  The subordinated notes are redeemable by the Company in whole but not in part, under certain limited circumstances set forth in the subordinated notes.  Any redemption by the Company would be at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the subordinated notes being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest on the subordinated notes being redeemed to, but excluding, the date of redemption.  The subordinated notes are subordinate in the right of payment to the Company’s senior indebtedness and the indebtedness and other liabilities of the subsidiary banks.  Unamortized debt issuance costs related to the subordinated notes totaled $1.2 million and $1.3 million at December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.  The Company used a portion of the net proceeds from the offering to repay term notes totaling $21.3 million and the outstanding balance of $9.0 million on its revolving line of credit.   

As part of the merger with Springfield Bancshares, the Company assumed two subordinated debentures with a fair value of $4.8 million which were prepaid in full in 2021 with no resulting gain or loss.

Note 13. Junior Subordinated Debentures

Junior subordinated debentures are summarized as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 as follows:

    

2021

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Note Payable to QCR Holdings Capital Trust II

$

10,310

$

10,310

Note Payable to QCR Holdings Capital Trust III

 

8,248

 

8,248

Note Payable to QCR Holdings Capital Trust V

 

10,310

 

10,310

Note Payable to Community National Trust II*

 

3,093

 

3,093

Note Payable to Community National Trust III*

 

3,609

 

3,609

Note Payable to Guaranty Bankshares Statutory Trust I**

 

4,640

 

4,640

Market Value Discount per ASC 805***

 

(2,055)

 

(2,217)

$

38,155

$

37,993

*      As part of the acquisition of Community National in 2013, the Company assumed two junior subordinated debentures with a total fair value of $4.2 million.

**   As part of the acquisition of Guaranty Bank in 2017, the Company assumed one junior subordinated debenture with a fair value of $3.9 million.

***  Market value discount includes discount on junior subordinated debt acquired as described in * and **.

115

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 13. Junior Subordinated Debentures (continued)

A schedule of the Company’s non-consolidated subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities, including the amounts outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, is as follows:

    

Amount

    

Amount

    

    

  

 

Outstanding

Outstanding

 

December 31, 

December 31, 

Interest Rate as of

Interest Rate as of

 

Name

Date Issued

2021

2020

Interest Rate

December 31, 2021

December 31, 2020

 

(dollars in thousands)

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust II*

February 2004

$

10,310

$

10,310

 

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

 

3.07

%  

3.10

%

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust III

February 2004

 

8,248

 

8,248

 

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

 

3.07

%  

3.10

%

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust V

February 2006

 

10,310

 

10,310

 

1.55% over 3-month LIBOR

 

1.67

%  

1.79

%

Community National Statutory Trust II

September 2004

 

3,093

 

3,093

 

2.17% over 3-month LIBOR

 

2.38

%  

2.41

%

Community National Statutory Trust III

March 2007

 

3,609

 

3,609

 

1.75% over 3-month LIBOR

 

1.95

%  

1.97

%

Guaranty Bankshares Statutory Trust I

May 2005

 

4,640

 

4,640

 

1.75% over 3-month LIBOR

 

1.95

%  

1.97

%

$

40,210

$

40,210

 

Weighted Average Rate

 

2.43

%  

2.48

%

  

*    Original amount issued for QCR Holdings Statutory Trust II was $12,372,000.

Securities issued by all of the trusts listed above mature 30 years from the date of issuance, but all are currently callable at par at any time. Interest rate reset dates vary by Trust.

The Company uses interest rate swaps for the purpose of hedging interest rate risk on the variable rate junior subordinated debt.  See Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for the details of these instruments.

116

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 14. Federal and State Income Taxes

Federal and state income tax expense was comprised of the following components for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Current

$

7,290

$

27,237

$

8,255

Deferred

 

15,272

 

(14,530)

 

6,364

$

22,562

$

12,707

$

14,619

A reconciliation of the expected federal income tax expense to the income tax expense included in the consolidated statements of income was as follows for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019:

Year Ended December 31, 

 

2021

2020

2019

 

% of

% of

% of

 

Pretax

Pretax

Pretax

 

    

 

Amount

    

Income

    

Amount

    

Income

    

Amount

    

Income

 

(dollars in thousands)

Computed "expected" tax expense

$

25,508

 

21.0

%  

$

15,391

 

21.0

%  

$

15,126

 

21.0

%

Tax exempt income, net

 

(7,537)

 

(6.2)

 

(5,943)

 

(8.1)

 

(4,470)

 

(6.2)

Bank-owned life insurance

 

(386)

 

(0.3)

 

(308)

 

(0.4)

 

(360)

 

(0.5)

State income taxes, net of federal benefit, current year

 

5,089

 

4.2

 

3,622

 

4.9

 

3,668

 

5.1

Change in unrecognized tax benefits

 

578

 

0.5

 

546

 

0.7

 

(93)

 

(0.1)

Goodwill impairment

105

0.1

630

0.9

Intended liquidation of bank-owned life insurance

790

1.1

Tax credits

 

34

 

 

(456)

 

(0.6)

 

(705)

 

(1.0)

Acquisition costs

 

95

 

0.1

 

 

 

 

Excess tax benefit on stock options exercised and restricted stock awards vested

 

(436)

 

(0.4)

 

(242)

 

(0.3)

 

(287)

 

(0.4)

Re-measurement of deferred tax asset to incorporate newly enacted tax rates

 

 

 

207

 

0.3

 

 

Other

 

(383)

 

(0.3)

 

(215)

 

(0.3)

 

320

 

0.4

Federal and state income tax expense

$

22,562

 

18.6

%  

$

12,707

 

17.3

%  

$

14,619

 

20.3

%

Changes in the unrecognized tax benefits included in other liabilities are as follows for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

1,893

$

1,254

Impact of tax positions taken during current year

 

1,326

 

787

Gross increase (decrease) related to tax positions of prior years

 

(646)

 

39

Reduction as a result of a lapse of the applicable statute of limitations

 

(391)

 

(187)

Balance, ending

$

2,182

$

1,893

Included in the unrecognized tax benefits liability at December 31, 2021 are potential benefits of approximately $1.7 million that, if recognized, would affect the effective tax rate.

117

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 14. Federal and State Income Taxes (continued)

The liability for unrecognized tax benefits includes accrued interest for tax positions, which either do not meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold or where the tax benefit is measured at an amount less than the tax benefit claimed or expected to be claimed on an income tax return. At December 31, 2021 and 2020, accrued interest on uncertain tax positions was approximately $236 thousand and $277 thousand, respectively. Estimated interest related to the underpayment of income taxes is classified as a component of “income tax expense” in the statements of income.

The Company’s federal income tax returns are open and subject to examination from the 2018 tax return year and later. Various state franchise and income tax returns are generally open from the 2017 and later tax return years based on individual state statutes of limitations.

The net deferred tax liabilities consisted of the following as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Deferred tax assets:

 

  

 

  

Historic tax credits

$

68

$

68

Compensation

 

11,912

 

10,288

Loan/lease losses

 

19,023

 

20,016

Net operating loss carryforwards, federal and state

 

1,354

 

628

Premises and equipment

16,509

Other

 

17

 

71

 

32,374

 

47,580

Deferred tax liabilities:

 

  

 

  

Net unrealized gains on securities available for sale and derivative instruments

747

869

Premises and equipment

 

6,099

 

Equipment financing leases

 

6,462

 

13,373

Acquisition fair value adjustments

 

3,269

 

3,351

Investment accretion

 

27

 

28

Deferred loan origination fees, net

 

1,403

 

197

Other

 

677

 

922

 

18,684

 

18,740

Net deferred tax assets

$

13,690

$

28,840

During the third quarter of 2021, effective January 1, 2020, the Company elected a tax accounting method change for identifying costs for self-constructed assets.  The change resulted in an increase in capitalized costs for tax purposes in the amount of $88.0 million as of January 1, 2020, which, in turn, resulted in the recording of a deferred tax asset.  A change from one generally accepted accounting principle to another is applied retrospectively, therefore deferred income taxes as of December 31, 2020, shown in the table above, have been adjusted retrospectively to reflect this change.  The impact of the change was an increase in the deferred tax asset for premises and equipment in the amount of $22.2 million. The Company has concluded it qualifies for another automatic federal income tax accounting method change for self-constructed assets and intends to elect such, effective January 1, 2021, with the filing of its 2021 income tax return.  This resulted in a reversal of the deferred tax asset as of January 1, 2021.

At December 31, 2021, the Company had $4.8 million of federal tax net operating loss carryforwards and $10.9 million of state tax net operating loss carryforwards.  $3.0 million of the federal tax net operating loss carryforwards are related to the acquisition of Community National and CNB and these losses are set to expire in varying amounts between 2029 and 2033.  $2.1 million of the state tax net operating loss carryforwards are also related to the acquisition of Community National and CNB and are set to expire in varying amounts between 2023 and 2028.  An additional

118

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 14. Federal and State Income Taxes (continued)

$1.8 million of federal tax net operating loss carryforwards and an additional $8.8 million of state tax net operating loss carryforwards were generated in 2021.  All of these net operating losses generated in 2021 are expected to be utilized in 2022.

The change in deferred income taxes was reflected in the Consolidated Financial Statements as follows for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Provision for income taxes

$

15,272

$

(14,530)

$

6,364

Net deferred tax asset resulting from market value adjustments of acquisitions

 

 

 

(381)

Net deferred tax assets resulting from sale of other subsidiary

363

Net deferred tax liabilities resulting from sale of bank subsidiary

(1,644)

Statement of stockholders' equity- Other comprehensive income (loss)

 

(122)

 

837

 

1,433

$

15,150

$

(13,330)

$

5,772

Note 15. Employee Benefit Plans

The Company has a profit sharing plan, which includes a provision designed to qualify under Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, to allow for participant contributions. Substantially all employees who are at least 18 years of age are eligible to participate in the plan. The Company matches 100% of the first 3% of employee contributions, and 50% of the next 3% of employee contributions, up to a maximum amount of 4.5% of an employee’s compensation. Additionally, at its discretion, the Company may make additional contributions to the plan, which are allocated to the accounts of participants in the plan based on relative compensation. There were no discretionary contributions for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019. Company matching contributions for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019 were as follows:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Matching contribution

$

2,446

$

2,520

$

2,443

The Company has entered into nonqualified supplemental executive retirement plans (SERPs) with certain executive officers. The SERPs allow certain executives to accumulate retirement benefits beyond those provided by the qualified retirement plan. Changes in the liability related to the SERPs, included in other liabilities, are as follows for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

6,189

$

5,160

$

4,623

Expense accrued

 

1,532

 

1,193

 

701

Cash payments made

 

(448)

 

(164)

 

(164)

Balance, ending

$

7,273

$

6,189

$

5,160

The Company has entered into deferred compensation agreements with certain executive officers. Under the provisions of the agreements, the officers may defer compensation and the Company matches the deferral up to certain

119

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 15. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

maximums. The Company’s matching contribution varies by officer and is a maximum of between $10 thousand and $25 thousand annually as set forth in each officer’s participation agreement. Interest on the deferred amounts is earned at prime rate subject to a minimum of 4% and a maximum of 12%, with such limits differing by officer.  The Company

has also entered into deferred compensation agreements with certain other officers. Under the provisions of the agreements, the officers may defer compensation and the Company matches the deferral up to certain maximums. The Company’s matching contribution differs by officer and is a maximum between 4% and 10% of compensation. Interest on the deferred amounts is earned at prime rate plus one percentage point, and has a minimum of 4% and shall not exceed 8%.

Upon retirement, the officer will receive the deferral balance in 180 equal monthly installments. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the liability related to the agreements totaled $32.3 million and $24.7 million, respectively.

Changes in the deferred compensation agreements, included in other liabilities, are as follows for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning

$

24,713

$

19,474

$

15,029

Employee deferrals

 

4,900

 

3,959

 

2,474

Company match and interest

 

3,048

 

2,628

 

2,072

Cash payments made

 

(308)

 

(1,348)

 

(101)

Balance, ending

$

32,353

$

24,713

$

19,474

Note 16. Stock-Based Compensation

The Company’s Board of Directors adopted in February 2010, and the stockholders approved in May 2010, the QCR Holdings, Inc. 2010 Equity Incentive Plan (“2010 Equity Incentive Plan”). The Company’s Board of Directors adopted in February 2013, and the stockholders approved in May 2013, the QCR Holdings, Inc. 2013 Equity Incentive Plan (“2013 Equity Incentive Plan”). The Company’s Board of Directors adopted in February 2016, and the stockholders approved in May 2016, the QCR Holdings, Inc. 2016 Equity Incentive Plan (“2016 Equity Incentive Plan”). Up to 350,000, 350,000, and 400,000 shares of common stock, respectively, may be issued to employees and directors of the Company and its subsidiaries pursuant to equity incentive awards granted under these plans.

The 2010 Equity Incentive Plan, the 2013 Equity Incentive Plan, and the 2016 Equity Incentive Plan (collectively, the “Equity Plans”) are administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors (the “Committee”). As of December 31, 2021, there were 132,375 remaining shares of common stock available for the grant of future awards under the Equity Plans; however, such future awards may be granted only under the 2016 Equity Incentive Plan.

The number and exercise price of options granted under the Equity Plans are determined by the Committee at the time the option is granted. In no event can the exercise price be less than the value of the common stock at the date of the grant for stock options. All options have a 10-year life and will vest and become exercisable from 3-to-7 years after the date of the grant.

120

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 16. Stock-Based Compensation (continued)

Stock-based compensation expense was reflected in the Consolidated Financial Statements as follows for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019.

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Stock options

$

270

$

297

$

475

Restricted stock awards

1,864

1,619

1,850

Stock purchase plan

 

218

 

234

 

144

$

2,352

$

2,150

$

2,469

Stock options:

A summary of the stock option plans as of December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019 and changes during the years then ended is presented below:

December 31, 

2021

2020

2019

Weighted

Weighted

Weighted

Average

Average

Average

Exercise

Exercise

Exercise

    

Shares

    

Price

    

Shares

    

Price

    

Shares

    

Price

Outstanding, beginning

407,763

$

22.24

426,913

$

20.14

469,572

$

18.52

Granted

 

22,150

 

43.61

 

23,350

 

39.12

 

20,200

 

36.00

Exercised

 

(60,317)

 

15.76

 

(41,650)

 

10.67

 

(59,393)

 

12.11

Forfeited

 

(1,598)

 

38.50

 

(850)

 

19.94

 

(3,466)

 

31.59

Outstanding, ending

 

367,998

 

24.46

 

407,763

 

22.24

 

426,913

 

20.14

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Exercisable, ending

 

318,266

 

  

 

354,899

 

  

 

365,084

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Weighted average fair value per option granted

$

10.85

 

  

$

10.07

 

  

$

11.29

 

  

A further summary of options outstanding as of December 31, 2021 is presented below:

Options Outstanding

Weighted

Options Exercisable

Average

Weighted

Weighted

Remaining

Average

Average

Range of

Number

Contractual

Exercise

Number

Exercise

Exercise Prices

    

Outstanding

    

Life

    

Price

    

Exercisable

    

Price

$9.30

29,406

0.08

$

9.30

29,406

$

9.30

$15.50 to $15.65

 

64,106

 

1.25

 

15.64

 

64,066

 

15.64

$17.10 to $18.00

 

110,499

 

2.57

 

17.31

 

110,459

 

17.31

$22.64 to $29.77

 

55,216

 

4.20

 

22.83

 

53,716

 

22.64

$36.00 to $41.95

 

37,834

 

7.66

 

38.25

 

14,360

 

37.84

$42.65 to $48.50

 

70,937

 

6.59

 

43.78

 

46,259

 

43.84

 

367,998

 

  

 

  

 

318,266

 

  

 

 

  

121

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 16. Stock-Based Compensation (continued)

Restricted stock awards:

A summary of changes in the Company’s nonvested restricted stock, restricted stock unit and performance stock unit awards as of December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 is presented below:

December 31, 

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

Outstanding, beginning

102,489

106,826

64,099

Granted*

 

38,360

 

34,559

 

85,961

Released

 

(43,691)

 

(37,296)

 

(37,624)

Forfeited

 

(51)

 

(1,600)

 

(5,610)

Outstanding, ending

97,107

102,489

106,826

Weighted average fair value per share granted

$

45.18

$

39.39

$

20.14

*  At December 31, 2021, includes 12,412 shares of restricted stock, 25,948 restricted stock units.

At December 31, 2020, includes 8,913 shares of restricted stock and 25,646 restricted stock units.

At December 31, 2019, includes 18,634 shares of restricted stock, 49,269 restricted stock units and 18,058 restricted stock units.

The total grant value of restricted stock, restricted stock unit and performance share unit awards that were released during the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 was $1.9 million, $1.4 million and $1.3 million, respectively.

Stock purchase plan:

The Company’s Board of Directors and its stockholders adopted in October 2002 the QCR Holdings, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the “Purchase Plan”). On May 2, 2012, the Company’s stockholders approved a complete amendment and restatement of the Purchase Plan. As of January 1, 2021, there were 61,186 shares of common stock available for issuance under the Purchase Plan. For each six-month offering period, the Board of Directors will determine how many of the total number of available shares will be offered. The purchase price is the lesser of 85% or the fair market value at the date of the grant or the investment date. The investment date, as established by the Board of Directors, is the date common stock is purchased after the end of each calendar quarter during an offering period. The maximum dollar amount any one participant can elect to contribute in an offering period is $10 thousand. Additionally, the maximum percentage that any one participant can elect to contribute is 15% of his or her compensation for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019.  Information for the stock purchase plan for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 is presented below:

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

Shares granted

 

28,396

 

38,738

 

29,882

Shares purchased

 

30,543

 

37,114

 

28,775

Weighted average fair value per share granted

$

7.67

$

6.03

$

4.81

122

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 17. Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Dividends

The Company (on a consolidated basis) and the subsidiary banks are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company and subsidiary banks’ financial statements.

Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Company and the subsidiary banks must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of their assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors. Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and the subsidiary banks to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the following table) of total common equity Tier 1 and Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets and of Tier 1 capital to average assets, each as defined by regulation. Management believes, as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, that the Company and the subsidiary banks met all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject.

Under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, to be categorized as “well capitalized,” an institution must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier 1 risk-based, Tier 1 leverage and common equity Tier 1 ratios as set forth in the following tables. The Company and the subsidiary banks’ actual capital amounts and ratios as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are also presented in the following table (dollars in thousands). As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the subsidiary banks met the requirements to be “well capitalized”.

For Capital

To Be Well

 

Adequacy Purposes

Capitalized Under

 

For Capital

With Capital

Prompt Corrective

 

Actual

Adequacy Purposes

Conservation Buffer

Action Provisions

 

    

Amount

    

Ratio

    

Amount

Ratio

    

Amount

Ratio

    

Amount

Ratio

( dollars in thousands)

As of December 31, 2021:

Company:

Total risk-based capital

$

814,629

14.77

%  

$

441,100

> 

8.00

%  

$

578,944

> 

10.50

%  

$

551,375

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

631,649

 

11.46

 

330,825

> 

6.00

 

468,669

> 

8.50

 

441,100

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

631,649

 

10.46

 

241,579

> 

4.00

 

241,579

> 

4.00

 

301,974

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

593,494

 

10.76

 

248,119

> 

4.50

 

385,962

> 

7.00

 

358,394

> 

6.50

Quad City Bank & Trust:

 

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

247,658

13.29

%  

$

149,126

> 

8.00

%  

$

195,727

> 

10.50

%  

$

186,407

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

224,253

 

12.03

 

111,844

> 

6.00

 

158,446

> 

8.50

 

149,126

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

224,253

 

10.45

 

85,873

> 

4.00

 

85,873

> 

4.00

 

107,341

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

224,253

 

12.03

 

83,883

> 

4.50

 

130,485

> 

7.00

 

121,164

> 

6.50

Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust:

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

277,673

14.85

%  

$

149,595

> 

8.00

%  

$

196,343

> 

10.50

%  

$

186,993

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

254,279

 

13.60

 

112,196

> 

6.00

 

158,944

> 

8.50

 

149,595

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

254,279

 

12.59

 

80,777

> 

4.00

 

80,777

> 

4.00

 

100,971

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

254,279

 

13.60

 

84,147

> 

4.50

 

130,895

> 

7.00

 

121,546

> 

6.50

Community State Bank:

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

123,365

11.95

%  

$

82,601

> 

8.00

%  

$

108,413

> 

10.50

%  

$

103,251

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

110,410

 

10.69

 

61,951

> 

6.00

 

87,763

> 

8.50

 

82,601

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

110,410

 

9.67

 

45,676

> 

4.00

 

45,676

> 

4.00

 

57,095

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

110,410

 

10.69

 

46,463

> 

4.50

 

72,276

> 

7.00

 

67,113

> 

6.50

Springfield First Community Bank:

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

101,067

13.39

%  

$

60,369

> 

8.00

%  

$

79,235

> 

10.50

%  

$

75,462

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

91,625

 

12.14

 

45,277

> 

6.00

 

64,142

> 

8.50

 

60,369

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

91,625

 

11.08

 

33,088

> 

4.00

 

33,088

> 

4.00

 

41,360

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

91,625

 

12.14

 

33,958

> 

4.50

 

52,823

> 

7.00

 

49,050

> 

6.50

123

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 17. Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Dividends (continued)

For Capital

To Be Well

 

Adequacy Purposes

Capitalized Under

 

For Capital

With Capital

Prompt Corrective

 

Actual

Adequacy Purposes

Conservation Buffer

Action Provisions

 

    

Amount

    

Ratio

    

Amount

Ratio

    

Amount

Ratio

    

Amount

Ratio

 

( dollars in thousands)

As of December 31, 2020:

Company:

Total risk-based capital

$

721,004

14.95

%  

$

385,832

> 

8.00

%  

$

506,404

> 

10.50

%  

$

482,290

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

546,729

 

11.34

 

289,374

> 

6.00

 

409,946

> 

8.50

 

385,832

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

546,729

 

9.49

 

230,345

> 

4.00

 

230,345

> 

4.00

 

287,931

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

508,736

 

10.55

 

217,030

> 

4.50

 

337,603

> 

7.00

 

313,488

> 

6.50

Quad City Bank & Trust:

 

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

213,608

12.24

%  

$

139,581

> 

8.00

%  

$

183,200

> 

10.50

%  

$

174,477

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

191,693

10.99

 

104,686

> 

6.00

 

148,305

> 

8.50

 

139,581

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

191,693

8.48

 

90,430

> 

4.00

 

90,430

> 

4.00

 

113,038

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

191,693

10.99

 

78,514

> 

4.50

 

122,134

> 

7.00

 

113,410

> 

6.50

Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust:

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

217,227

13.14

%  

$

132,269

> 

8.00

%  

$

173,603

> 

10.50

%  

$

165,336

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

196,438

11.88

 

99,202

> 

6.00

 

140,536

> 

8.50

 

132,269

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

196,438

10.01

 

78,535

> 

4.00

 

78,535

> 

4.00

 

98,169

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

196,438

11.88

 

74,401

> 

4.50

 

115,735

> 

7.00

 

107,469

> 

6.50

Community State Bank:

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

108,040

12.69

%  

$

68,117

> 

8.00

%  

$

89,404

> 

10.50

%  

$

85,146

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

97,350

11.43

 

51,088

> 

6.00

 

72,374

> 

8.50

 

68,117

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

97,350

10.27

 

37,930

> 

4.00

 

37,930

> 

4.00

 

47,412

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

97,350

11.43

 

38,316

> 

4.50

 

59,602

> 

7.00

 

55,345

> 

6.50

Springfield First Community Bank:

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

Total risk-based capital

$

90,334

14.35

%  

$

50,357

> 

8.00

%  

$

66,094

> 

10.50

%  

$

62,947

> 

10.00

%

Tier 1 risk-based capital

 

77,668

12.34

 

37,768

> 

6.00

 

53,505

> 

8.50

 

50,357

> 

8.00

Tier 1 leverage

 

77,668

10.87

 

28,575

> 

4.00

 

28,575

> 

4.00

 

35,719

> 

5.00

Common equity Tier 1

 

77,668

12.34

 

28,326

> 

4.50

 

44,063

> 

7.00

 

40,915

> 

6.50

The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its stockholders may be affected by both general corporate law considerations and policies of the Federal Reserve applicable to bank holding companies.

The payment of dividends by any financial institution or its holding company is affected by the requirement to maintain adequate capital pursuant to applicable capital adequacy guidelines and regulations, and a financial institution generally is prohibited from paying any dividends if, following payment thereof, the institution would be undercapitalized. Notwithstanding the availability of funds for dividends, however, the Federal Reserve may prohibit the payment of any dividends by the subsidiary banks if the Federal Reserve determines such payment would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice.

The Company also has certain contractual restrictions on its ability to pay dividends. The Company has issued junior subordinated debentures in four private placements and assumed three issues of junior subordinated debentures in connection with the acquisitions. Under the terms of the debentures, the Company may be prohibited, under certain circumstances, from paying dividends on shares of its common stock. These circumstances did not exist at December 31, 2021 or 2020.

In September 2020 and in February 2019, the Company completed subordinated notes offerings.  See Note 12 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.

On February 18, 2020, the Board of Directors of the Company approved a share repurchase program under which the Company is authorized to repurchase, from time to time as the Company deems appropriate, up to 800,000 shares of its outstanding common stock, or approximately 5% of the outstanding shares as of December 31, 2019.  There were 293,153 and 100,932 shares of common stock purchased by the Company during the year ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.  There are 405,915 shares of common stock remaining for repurchase as of December  31, 2021.

124

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 18. Earnings per Share

The following information was used in the computation of basic and diluted EPS for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019:

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands, except per share data)

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

$

57,408

Basic EPS

$

6.30

$

3.84

$

3.65

Diluted EPS

$

6.20

$

3.80

$

3.60

Weighted average common shares outstanding

 

15,708,744

 

15,771,650

 

15,730,016

Weighted average common shares issuable upon exercise of stock options

and under the employee stock purchase plan

 

235,964

 

180,987

 

237,759

Weighted average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

 

15,944,708

 

15,952,637

 

15,967,775

*  Excludes anti-dilutive shares of 0, 104,636 and 80,437  at December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019, respectively.

Note 19. Commitments and Contingencies

In the normal course of business, the subsidiary banks make various commitments and incur certain contingent liabilities that are not presented in the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements. The commitments and contingent liabilities include various guarantees, commitments to extend credit, and standby letters of credit.

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The subsidiary banks evaluate each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the subsidiary banks upon extension of credit, is based upon management’s credit evaluation of the counterparty. Collateral held varies but may include accounts receivable, marketable securities, inventory, property, plant and equipment, and income-producing commercial properties.

Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the subsidiary banks to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Those guarantees are primarily issued to support public and private borrowing arrangements and, generally, have terms of one year or less. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The subsidiary banks hold collateral, as described above, supporting those commitments if deemed necessary. In the event the customer does not perform in accordance with the terms of the agreement with the third party, the subsidiary banks would be required to fund the commitments. The maximum potential amount of future payments the subsidiary banks could be required to make is represented by the contractual amount. If the commitment is funded, the subsidiary banks would be entitled to seek recovery from the customer. At December 31, 2021 and 2020, no amounts had been recorded as liabilities for the subsidiary banks’ potential obligations under these guarantees.

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, commitments to extend credit aggregated $1.2 billion and $1.4 billion, respectively. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, standby letters of credit aggregated $21.7 million and $24.8 million, respectively. Management does not expect that all of these commitments will be funded.

125

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 19. Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

The Company has also executed contracts for the sale of mortgage loans in the secondary market in the amount of $3.8 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020. These amounts are included in loans held for sale at the respective balance sheet dates.

Residential mortgage loans sold to investors in the secondary market are sold with varying recourse provisions. Essentially, all loan sales agreements require the repurchase of a mortgage loan by the seller in situations such as breach of representation, warranty, or covenant, untimely document delivery, false or misleading statements, failure to obtain certain certificates of insurance, unmarketability, etc. Certain loan sales agreements contain repurchase requirements based on payment-related defects that are defined in terms of the number of days/months since the purchase, the sequence number of the payment, and/or the number of days of payment delinquency. Based on the specific terms stated in the agreements of investors purchasing residential mortgage loans from the Company’s subsidiary banks, the Company had $20.8 million and $32.4 million of sold residential mortgage loans with recourse provisions still in effect at December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. The subsidiary banks did not repurchase any loans from secondary market investors under the terms of loans sales agreements during the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019. In the opinion of management, the risk of recourse and the subsequent requirement of loan repurchase to the subsidiary banks is not significant, and accordingly no liabilities have been established related to such.

Aside from cash on-hand and in-vault, the majority of the Company’s cash is maintained at upstream correspondent banks. The total amount of cash on deposit, certificates of deposit, and federal funds sold exceeded federal insured limits by approximately $48.2 million and $59.4 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. In the opinion of management, no material risk of loss exists due to the financial condition of the upstream correspondent banks.

In an arrangement with Goldman Sachs, CRBT offers a cash management program for select customers. Based on a predetermined minimum balance, which must be maintained in the customer’s account, excess funds are automatically swept daily to an institutional money market fund administered by Goldman Sachs. At December 31, 2021 and 2020, the Company had $107.0 million and $103.8 million, respectively of customer funds invested in this cash management program. In the opinion of management, no material risk of loss exists due to the financial condition of Goldman Sachs. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, there were $31.5 million and $24.0 million of investment securities pledged on the Goldman Sachs program, respectively, as a cover to the swap exposure.

126

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 20. Parent Company Only Financial Statements

The following is condensed financial information of QCR Holdings, Inc. (parent company only):

Condensed Balance Sheets
December 31, 2021 and 2020

     

2021

    

2020

(dollars in thousands)

Assets

Cash and due from banks

$

41,531

$

88,610

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

5,750

 

7,200

Investment in bank subsidiaries

 

769,628

 

655,232

Investment in nonbank subsidiaries

 

5,341

 

4,540

Premises and equipment, net

 

8,632

 

9,242

Other assets

 

7,716

 

16,268

Total assets

$

838,598

$

781,092

 

  

 

  

Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity

 

  

 

  

Liabilities:

 

  

 

  

Subordinated notes

$

113,850

$

113,691

Junior subordinated debentures

 

38,155

 

37,993

Other liabilities

 

9,583

 

35,615

Total liabilities

 

161,588

 

187,299

 

  

 

  

Stockholders' Equity:

 

  

 

  

Common stock

 

15,613

 

15,806

Additional paid-in capital

 

273,768

 

275,807

Retained earnings

 

386,077

 

300,804

Accumulated other comprehensive income

 

1,552

 

1,376

Total stockholders' equity

 

677,010

 

593,793

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

$

838,598

$

781,092

127

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 20. Parent Company Only Financial Statements (continued)

Condensed Statements of Income
Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Total interest income

$

3

$

29

$

77

Equity in net income of bank subsidiaries

 

117,408

 

79,624

 

69,966

Equity in net income (loss) of nonbank subsidiaries

 

456

 

(261)

 

6,797

Other

 

853

 

289

 

314

Total income

 

118,720

 

79,681

 

77,154

 

  

 

  

 

  

Interest expense

 

8,482

 

6,662

 

5,836

Salaries and employee benefits

 

12,446

 

11,825

 

8,739

Professional fees

 

1,983

 

2,558

 

1,545

Acquisition costs

 

624

 

 

Post-acquisition compensation, transition and integration costs

 

 

145

 

3,171

Disposition costs

13

312

1,606

Goodwill impairment

 

 

500

 

3,000

Other

 

2,784

 

2,505

 

2,147

Total expenses

 

26,332

 

24,507

 

26,044

 

  

 

  

 

  

Income before income tax benefit

 

92,388

 

55,174

 

51,110

 

  

 

  

 

  

Income tax benefit

 

6,517

 

5,408

 

6,298

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

$

57,408

128

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 20. Parent Company Only Financial Statements (continued)

Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019

    

2021

    

2020

    

2019

(dollars in thousands)

Cash Flows from Operating Activities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Net income

$

98,905

$

60,582

$

57,408

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Earnings of bank subsidiaries

(117,408)

 

(79,624)

 

(69,966)

(Earnings) losses of nonbank subsidiaries

 

(456)

 

261

 

(6,797)

Distributions from nonbank subsidiaries

 

30

 

40

 

45,058

Deferred income taxes

(1,093)

6,909

2,498

Accretion of acquisition fair value adjustments

 

321

 

378

 

305

Depreciation

 

486

 

454

 

327

Deferred compensation expense accrued

573

Stock-based compensation expense

 

2,352

 

2,150

 

2,469

Loss on sale of subsidiary

158

Gain on sale of fixed assets

155

Goodwill impairment

500

3,000

Decrease (increase) in other assets

 

5

 

(7,380)

 

(2,472)

Increase (decrease) in other liabilities

 

(14,702)

 

(5,923)

 

7,814

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

 

(30,832)

 

(21,495)

 

39,644

 

  

 

 

  

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Net increase (decrease) in interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

1,450

 

(1,599)

 

(4,600)

Capital infusion, bank subsidiaries

 

 

 

(8,600)

Capital infusion, non-bank subsidiaries

(375)

(100)

Net cash received in dissolution of subsidiary

8,450

Net cash received in sale of subsidiary

195

Purchase of premises and equipment

 

(31)

 

(272)

 

(2,861)

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

 

1,044

 

6,774

 

(16,161)

 

  

 

  

 

  

Cash Flows from Financing Activities:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Activity in other borrowings:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Paydown on revolving line of credit

 

(9,000)

Prepayments

 

(21,313)

Calls, maturities and scheduled payments

 

 

(1,799)

Proceeds from subordinated notes

50,000

63,393

Payment of cash dividends

 

(3,793)

 

(3,779)

 

(3,767)

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net

 

670

 

1,360

 

1,926

Repurchase and cancellation of shares

 

(14,168)

 

(3,779)

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

(17,291)

 

43,802

 

29,440

 

  

 

  

 

  

Net increase (decrease) in cash and due from banks

 

(47,079)

 

29,081

 

52,923

 

  

 

  

 

  

Cash and due from banks:

 

  

 

  

 

  

Beginning

 

88,610

 

59,529

 

6,606

Ending

$

41,531

$

88,610

$

59,529

129

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 21. Fair Value

Accounting guidance on fair value measurements uses a hierarchy intended to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. This hierarchy includes three levels and is based upon the valuation techniques used to measure assets and liabilities. The three levels are as follows:

Level 1 – Inputs to the valuation methodology are quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in markets;
Level 2 – Inputs to the valuation methodology include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets and inputs that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly, for substantially the full term of the financial instrument; and
Level 3 – Inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable and significant to the fair value measurement

Assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis comprised the following at December 31, 2021 and 2020:

Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using

Quoted Prices

Significant

in Active

Other

Significant

Markets for

Observable

Unobservable

Identical Assets

Inputs

Inputs

    

Fair Value

    

(Level 1)

    

(Level 2)

    

(Level 3)

(dollars in thousands)

December 31, 2021:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

U.S. treasuries and govt. sponsored agency securities

$

23,328

$

$

23,328

$

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

94,323

 

 

94,323

 

Municipal securities

 

168,266

 

 

168,266

 

Asset-backed securities

27,124

27,124

Other securities

 

24,789

 

 

24,789

 

Derivatives

 

222,220

 

 

222,220

 

Total assets measured at fair value

$

560,050

$

$

560,050

$

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Derivatives

$

225,135

$

$

225,135

$

Total liabilities measured at fair value

$

225,135

$

$

225,135

$

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

December 31, 2020:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Securities AFS:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

$

15,336

$

$

15,336

$

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

 

132,842

 

 

132,842

 

Municipal securities

 

152,408

 

 

152,408

 

Asset-backed securities

40,683

40,683

Other securities

 

20,697

 

 

20,697

 

Derivatives

 

222,757

 

 

222,757

 

Total assets measured at fair value

$

584,723

$

$

584,723

$

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Derivatives

$

229,270

$

$

229,270

$

Total liabilities measured at fair value

$

229,270

$

$

229,270

$

The securities AFS portfolio consists of securities whereby the Company obtains fair values from an independent pricing service. The fair values are determined by pricing models that consider observable market data, such as interest rate volatilities, LIBOR yield curve, credit spreads and prices from market makers and live trading systems (Level 2 inputs).

130

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 21. Fair Value (continued)

Interest rate caps are used for the purpose of hedging interest rate risk on deposits. See Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for the details of these instruments. The fair values are determined by pricing models that consider observable market data for derivative instruments with similar structures (Level 2 inputs).

Interest rate swaps are used for the purpose of hedging interest rate risk on loans and junior subordinated debt.  See Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for the details of these instruments. The fair values are determined by comparing the contract rate on the swap with the observable then-current market rate for the remaining term of the transaction (Level 2 inputs).

Interest rate swaps are also executed for select commercial customers. See Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for the detail of these instruments. The fair values are determined by comparing the contractual rate on the swap with the observable then-current market rate for the remaining term of the transaction (Level 2 inputs).

Certain financial assets are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis; that is, the assets are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment).

Assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis comprised the following at December 31, 2021 and 2020:

    

Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using

Quoted Prices

Significant

in Active

Other

Significant

Markets for

Observable

Unobservable

Identical Assets

Inputs

Inputs

    

Fair Value

    

Level 1

    

Level 2

    

Level 3

(dollars in thousands)

December 31, 2021:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Loans/leases evaluated individually

$

6,618

$

$

$

6,618

December 31, 2020:

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

Loans/leases evaluated individually

$

9,926

$

$

$

9,926

OREO

 

22

 

 

 

22

$

9,948

$

$

$

9,948

Loans/leases evaluated individually are valued at the lower of cost or fair value and are classified as a Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. Fair value is measured based on the value of the collateral securing these loans/leases. Collateral may be real estate and/or business assets including equipment, inventory and/or accounts receivable and is determined based on appraisals by qualified licensed appraisers hired by the Company. Appraised and reported values may be discounted based on management’s historical knowledge, changes in market conditions from the time of valuation, and/or management’s expertise and knowledge of the client and client’s business.

OREO in the table above consists of property acquired through foreclosures and settlements of loans. Property acquired is carried at the estimated fair value of the property, less disposal costs, and is classified as a Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. The estimated fair value of the property is determined based on appraisals by qualified licensed appraisers hired by the Company. Appraised and reported values are discounted based on management’s historical knowledge, changes in market conditions from the time of valuation, and/or management’s expertise and knowledge of the property.

131

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 21. Fair Value (continued)

The following table presents additional quantitative information about assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis for which the Company has utilized Level 3 inputs to determine fair value:

Quantitative Information about Level Fair Value Measurements

 

Fair Value

Fair Value

 

December 31, 

December 31, 

 

    

2021

    

2020

    

Valuation Technique

    

Unobservable Input

    

Range

(dollars in thousands)

Loans/leases evaluated individually

$

6,618

$

9,926

 

Appraisal of collateral

 

Appraisal adjustments

 

-10.00

%  

to

 

-30.00

%

OREO

 

 

22

 

Appraisal of collateral

 

Appraisal adjustments

 

0.00

%  

to

 

-35.00

%

For loans/leases evaluated individually and OREO, the Company records carrying value at fair value less disposal or selling costs. The amounts reported in the tables above are fair values before the adjustment for disposal or selling costs.

There have been no changes in valuation techniques used for any assets measured at fair value during the years ended December 31, 2021 or 2020.

The following table presents the carrying values and estimated fair values of financial assets and liabilities carried on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet, including those financial assets and liabilities that are not measured and reported at fair value on a recurring basis or non-recurring basis:

Fair Value

As of December 31, 2021

As of December 31, 2020

Hierarchy

Carrying

Estimated

Carrying

Estimated

    

Level

    

Value

    

Fair Value

    

Value

    

Fair Value

(dollars in thousands)

Cash and due from banks

 

Level 1

$

37,490

$

37,490

$

61,329

$

61,329

Federal funds sold

 

Level 2

 

12,370

 

12,370

 

9,080

 

9,080

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

 

Level 2

 

75,292

 

75,292

 

86,596

 

86,596

Investment securities:

 

  

 

 

 

 

HTM

 

Level 2

 

472,385

 

522,297

 

476,165

 

521,277

AFS

 

Level 2

 

337,830

 

337,830

 

361,966

 

361,966

Loans/leases receivable, net

 

Level 3

 

6,128

 

6,618

 

9,191

 

9,926

Loans/leases receivable, net

 

Level 2

 

4,595,283

 

4,478,899

 

4,157,562

 

4,112,735

Derivatives

 

Level 2

 

222,220

 

222,220

 

222,757

 

222,757

Deposits:

 

  

 

 

 

 

Nonmaturity deposits

 

Level 2

 

4,501,424

 

4,501,424

 

4,138,478

 

4,138,478

Time deposits

 

Level 2

 

421,348

 

419,453

 

460,659

 

465,681

Short-term borrowings

 

Level 2

 

3,800

 

3,800

 

5,430

 

5,430

FHLB advances

 

Level 2

 

15,000

 

15,000

 

15,000

 

14,998

Subordinated notes

Level 2

113,850

116,203

118,691

112,406

Junior subordinated debentures

 

Level 2

 

38,155

 

31,072

 

37,993

 

30,618

Derivatives

 

Level 2

 

225,135

 

225,135

 

229,270

 

229,270

132

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 22. Business Segment Information

Selected financial and descriptive information is required to be disclosed for reportable operating segments, applying a “management perspective” as the basis for identifying reportable segments. The management perspective is determined by the view that management takes of the segments within the Company when making operating decisions, allocating resources, and measuring performance. The segments of the Company have been defined by the structure of the Company’s internal organization, focusing on the financial information that the Company’s operating decision-makers routinely use to make decisions about operating matters.

The Company’s Commercial Banking business is geographically divided by markets into the operating segments which are the four subsidiary banks wholly-owned by the Company: QCBT, CRBT, CSB and SFCB. Each of these operating segments offer similar products and services, but are managed separately due to different pricing, product demand, and consumer markets. Each offers commercial, consumer, and mortgage loans and deposit services.

The Company's All Other segment includes the corporate operations of the parent and operations of all other consolidated subsidiaries and/or defined operating segments that fall below the segment reporting thresholds.  

Selected financial information on the Company’s business segments is presented as follows as of and for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019:

Commercial Banking

Intercompany

Consolidated

    

QCBT

    

CRBT

    

CSB

    

SFCB

    

All other

    

Eliminations

    

Total

(dollars in thousands)

Year Ended December 31, 2021

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Total revenue

$

88,689

$

129,080

$

43,945

$

38,342

$

119,451

$

(118,930)

$

300,577

Net interest income

 

66,232

 

57,354

 

35,512

 

26,351

 

(8,479)

 

1,263

 

178,233

Provision for credit losses

 

1,519

 

(697)

 

2,219

 

445

 

 

 

3,486

Net income (loss)

 

34,616

 

55,411

 

12,802

 

14,579

 

99,331

 

(117,834)

 

98,905

Goodwill

 

3,223

 

14,980

 

9,888

 

45,975

 

 

 

74,066

Intangibles

 

 

1,702

 

2,653

 

4,994

 

 

 

9,349

Total assets

 

2,142,344

 

2,030,279

 

1,168,606

 

882,885

 

845,120

 

(973,102)

 

6,096,132

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

Year Ended December 31, 2020*

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Total revenue

$

92,336

$

125,416

$

50,448

$

42,036

$

2,197

$

(262)

$

312,171

Net interest income

 

63,366

 

52,857

 

31,570

 

24,759

 

(6,633)

 

1,031

 

166,950

Provision for loan/lease losses

 

21,612

 

19,438

 

9,243

 

5,411

 

 

 

55,704

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

 

21,557

 

33,890

 

11,379

 

12,797

 

(19,041)

 

 

60,582

Goodwill

 

3,223

 

14,980

 

9,888

 

45,975

 

 

 

74,066

Intangibles

 

 

2,189

 

3,305

 

5,887

 

 

 

11,381

Total assets

 

2,153,773

 

1,957,695

 

1,004,183

 

779,956

 

134,407

 

(324,971)

 

5,705,043

Year Ended December 31, 2019*

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Total revenue

$

87,433

$

96,631

$

42,059

$

31,569

$

38,758

$

(1,606)

$

294,844

Net interest income

 

52,097

 

44,310

 

31,370

 

21,422

 

6,360

 

 

155,559

Provision for loan/lease losses

 

3,433

 

1,080

 

679

 

1,315

 

559

 

 

7,066

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

 

21,607

 

27,716

 

10,787

 

8,244

 

(10,946)

 

 

57,408

Goodwill

 

3,223

 

14,980

 

9,888

 

45,975

 

682

 

 

74,748

Intangibles

 

 

2,684

 

3,980

 

6,802

 

1,504

 

 

14,970

Total assets

 

1,682,477

 

1,572,324

 

853,833

 

748,753

 

116,968

 

(65,305)

 

4,909,050

*Includes financial results for RB&T for the period from January 1, 2019 through November 30, 2019, prior to the sale of the majority of  its assets and liabilities.  Includes financial results for the Bates Companies for the year 2019 and the period from January 1, 2020 through August 12, 2020, prior to the sale of the companies.

Note 23. Pending Acquisition

On November 9, 2021, the Company announced the signing of a definitive agreement whereby the Company will acquire GFED and merge Guaranty Bank, the banking subsidiary of GFED into SFCB, the Company’s Springfield-based charter.  The combined bank will operate under the Guaranty Bank name in all Springfield and southwest Missouri markets.  As of December 31, 2021, GFED had $1.2 billion in assets, $815 million in loans and $1.0 billion in deposits.

Under the terms of the merger agreement, stockholders of GFED will have the right to receive for each share of GFED common stock owned, at the election of each stockholder, and subject to proration and adjustment, (1) $30.50 in cash, (2) 0.58775 shares of the Company’s common stock, or (3) mixed consideration of $6.10 in cash and 0.4702 shares of the Company’s common stock, with total consideration to consist of approximately 80% stock and 20% cash.  Based upon the $59.99 closing price of the Company’s common stock as of November 5, 2021, the transaction is valued at approximately $151.6 million.  The transaction is subject to regulatory approvals, approval by GFED’s stockholders and certain customary closing conditions.  The transaction is expected to close late in the first quarter or early in the second quarter of 2022.

133

Table of Contents

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Item 9.    Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None.

Item 9A.    Controls and Procedures

Evaluation of disclosure controls and procedures. An evaluation was performed under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) and 15d – 15(e) promulgated under the Exchange Act) as of December 31, 2021. Based on that evaluation, the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the reports filed and submitted under the Exchange Act was: (1) accumulated and communicated to our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, to allow for timely decisions regarding required disclosures; and (2) recorded, processed, summarized and reported as and when required.

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act). Internal control over financial reporting includes controls and procedures designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that: (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions of the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations, including the possibility of human error and the circumvention of overriding controls. Accordingly, even effective internal control can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation. Further, because of changes in conditions, the effectiveness of internal control may vary over time.

The Company’s management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021. Management’s assessment is based on the criteria established in the Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013 and was designed to provide reasonable assurance that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021. Based on this assessment, management believes that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021.

RSM US LLP, the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm has issued an attestation report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, which is included on the following pages of this Form 10-K.

134

Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of QCR Holdings, Inc.

 

 

Opinion on the Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

We have audited QCR Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries' (the Company) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013. In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated balance sheets of the Company as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders' equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2021, and the related notes to the consolidated financial statements of the Company and our report dated March 11, 2022 expressed an unqualified opinion.

 

Basis for Opinion

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting in the accompanying Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with

authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

135

Table of Contents

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

/s/ RSM US LLP

 

Davenport, Iowa

March 11, 2022

 

 

136

Table of Contents

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting. There have been no significant changes to the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the period covered by this report that have materially affected, or are reasonably like to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Item 9B.    Other Information

None.

Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspection.

Not Applicable.

137

Table of Contents

Part III

Item 10.    Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

The information required by this item is set forth under the captions “Proposal 1: Election of Directors,” “Corporate Governance and the Board of Directors” and “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Company’s 2022 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 11.    Executive Compensation

The information required by this item is set forth under the captions “Executive Compensation” and “Director Compensation” in the Company’s 2022 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 12.    Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

The information required by this item is set forth under the caption “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners” in the Company’s 2022 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

The table below sets forth the following information as of December 31, 2021 for (i) all compensation plans previously approved by the Company’s stockholders and (ii) all compensation plans not previously approved by the Company’s stockholders:

(a)The number of securities to be issued upon the exercise of outstanding options, warrants, and rights;
(b)The weighted-average exercise price of such outstanding options, warrants, and rights; and
(c)Other than securities to be issued upon the exercise of such outstanding options, warrants, and rights, the number of securities remaining available for future issuance under the plans.

EQUITY COMPENSATION PLAN INFORMATION

 

Number of securities remaining

 

Number of securities to be

available for future issuance

 

issued upon exercise of

Weighted-average exercise price

under equity compensation

 

outstanding options, warrants,

of outstanding options,

plans (excluding securities

 

Plan category

    

and rights

    

warrants, and rights (1)

    

reflected in column (a))

 

 

(a)

 

(b)

 

(c)

Equity compensation plans approved by stockholders

 

452,586

(2)

$

24.65

 

193,561

(3)

 

  

 

  

 

  

  

Equity compensation plans not approved by stockholders

 

 

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

  

Total

 

452,586

(2)

$

24.65

 

193,561

(3)

 

(1)The weighted average exercise price only relates to outstanding option awards.
(2)Includes 367,998 outstanding option awards and 69,476 outstanding restricted stock units and 10,082 performance share units granted under the Equity Plans.
(3)Includes 132,375 and 61,186 shares available under the QCR Holdings, Inc. 2016 Equity Incentive Plan and QCR Holdings, Inc.

Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

138

Table of Contents

Item 13.    Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

The information required by this item is set forth under the captions “Corporate Governance and the Board of Directors” and “Transactions with Management and Directors” in the Company’s 2022 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 14.    Principal Accountant Fees and Services

The information required by this item is set forth under the caption “Proposal 3: Ratification of Selection of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in the Company’s 2022 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Part IV

Item 15.    Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

(a)1. Financial Statements

These documents are listed in the Index to Consolidated Financial Statements under Item 8.

(a)2. Financial Statement Schedules

Financial statement schedules are omitted, as they are not required or are not applicable, or the required information is shown in the Consolidated Financial Statements and the accompanying notes thereto.

(a)3. Exhibits

The following exhibits are either filed as a part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K or are incorporated herein by reference:

Exhibit
Number

    

Exhibit Description

2.1

Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of November 9, 2021, by and between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Guaranty Federal Bancshares, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 9, 2021).*

3.1

Certificate of Incorporation of QCR Holdings, Inc., as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q/A Amendment No. 1 for the period ended September 30, 2011).

3.2

Bylaws of QCR Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Company’s Form 8-K filed on February 19, 2019).

4.1

Certain instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt of the Company, none of which authorize a total amount of indebtedness in excess of 10% of the total assets of the Company and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, have not been filed as exhibits. The Company hereby agrees to furnish a copy of any of these agreements to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request.

4.2

Description of the Company’s Securities (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2019).

10.1

Dividend Reinvestment Plan of QCR Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of Company’s Form S-3D, File No. 333-102699 dated January 24, 2003).

139

Table of Contents

10.2+

Amended and Restated Executive Deferred Compensation Plan Participation Agreement between Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company and Larry J. Helling dated December 19, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014).

10.3+

Amended and Restated Executive Deferred Compensation Plan Participation Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Todd A. Gipple dated December 19, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014).

10.4+

Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Joinder Agreement between Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company and Larry J. Helling dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

10.5+

Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Joinder Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Todd A. Gipple dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

10.6+

QCR Holdings, Inc. Amended and Restated Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A dated March 21, 2012).

10.7+

QCR Holdings, Inc. 2013 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A dated March 20, 2013).

10.8+

Form of Participation Agreement under the QCR Holdings, Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014).

10.9+

QCR Holdings, Inc. 2016 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A of the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on April 1, 2016).

10.10+

QCR Holdings, Inc., Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, as amended and restated December 22, 2016 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 28, 2016).

10.11+

Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Joinder Agreement between Quad City Bank and Trust Company and John H. Anderson dated December 22, 2016 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 28, 2016).

10.12+

Form of QCR Holdings, Inc. 2016 Equity Incentive Plan Nonqualified Stock Option Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 of the Company’s Form S-8 filed on October 27, 2016 (File No. 333-214282)).

10.13+

Form of QCR Holdings, Inc. 2016 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 of the Company’s Form S-8 filed on October 27, 2016 (File No. 333-214282)).

140

Table of Contents

10.14+

Form of QCR Holdings, Inc. 2016 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 of the Company’s Form S-8 filed on October 27, 2016 (File No. 333-214282)).

10.15+

Employment Agreement, dated November 19, 2018, between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Larry Helling (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed November 19, 2018).

10.16+

Employment Agreement, dated November 19, 2018, between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Todd Gipple (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed November 19, 2018).

10.17+

Employment Agreement, dated January 9, 2019, between QCR Holdings, Inc., Quad City Bank and Trust Company, and John Anderson (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2019).

10.18+

Executive Deferred Compensation Plan Participation Agreement, dated December 16, 2016, between Quad City Bank and Trust Company and John Anderson (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2019).

10.19+

Executive Deferred Compensation Plan Participation Agreement, dated November 24, 2014, between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Dana Nichols (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2019).

10.20+

Employment Agreement, dated January 1, 2004, between Cedar Rapid Bank and Trust and Dana Nichols (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.45 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2019).

10.21+

First Amendment to the Employment Agreement, dated December 31, 2008, between Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company and Dana Nichols (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.40 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2019).

10.22+

QCR Holdings, Inc. 2010 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A dated March 22, 2010).

10.23+

Separation Agreement and General Release of Claims, dated January 15, 2021, between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Robert Fulp.

21.1

Subsidiaries of QCR Holdings, Inc. (filed herewith).

23.1

Consent of Independent Registered Pubic Accounting Firm - RSM US LLP (filed herewith).

31.1

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) (filed herewith).

31.2

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) (filed herewith).

32.1

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (filed herewith).

32.2

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (filed herewith).

141

Table of Contents

101

Inline XBRL Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2021 and December 31, 2020; (ii) Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2021, December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019; (iii) Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the years ended December 31, 2021, December 31, 2020, and December 31, 2019; (iv) Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders; Equity for the years ended December 31, 2021, December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019; (v) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2021, December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019; and (vi) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

104

Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as inline XBRL with applicable taxonomy extension information contained in Exhibit 101).

+

A compensatory arrangement.

*

QCR Holdings, Inc. has omitted schedules and similar attachments to the subject agreement pursuant to Item 601(b) of Regulation S-K. QCR Holdings, Inc. will furnish a copy of any omitted schedule or similar attachment to the SEC upon request.

Item 16.    Form 10-K Summary

None

142

Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

QCR HOLDINGS, INC.

Dated: March 11, 2022

By:

/s/ Larry J. Helling

Larry J. Helling

Chief Executive Officer

Dated: March 11, 2022

By:

/s/ Todd A. Gipple

Todd A. Gipple

President, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Dated: March 11, 2022

By:

/s/ Nick W. Anderson

Nick W. Anderson

Chief Accounting Officer

(Principal Accounting Officer)

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

143

Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Signature

    

Title

    

Date

/s/ Marie Ziegler

Chair of the Board of Directors

March 11, 2022

Marie Ziegler

/s/ James Field

Vice-Chair of the Board of Directors

March 11, 2022

James Field

/s/ Larry J. Helling

Chief Executive Officer and Director

March 11, 2022

Larry J. Helling

/s/ John Paul E. Besong

Director

March 11, 2022

John Paul E. Besong

/s/ Todd A. Gipple

President, Chief Operating Officer

March 11, 2022

Todd A. Gipple

Chief Financial Officer and Director

/s/ Mary Kay Bates

Director

March 11, 2022

Mary Kay Bates

/s/ Mark C. Kilmer

Director

March 11, 2022

Mark C. Kilmer

/s/ Patrick S. Baird

Director

March 11, 2022

Patrick S. Baird

/s/ Brent R. Cobb

Director

March 11, 2022

Brent R. Cobb

/s/ Elizabeth S. Jacobs

Director

March 11, 2022

Elizabeth S. Jacobs

/s/ Donna J. Sorensen, J.D.

Director

March 11, 2022

Donna J. Sorensen, J.D.

144

Table of Contents

Appendix A

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

General

FDIC-insured institutions, their holding companies and their affiliates are extensively regulated under federal and state law. As a result, the growth and earnings performance of the Company may be affected not only by management decisions and general economic conditions, but also by the requirements of federal and state statutes and by the regulations and policies of various bank regulatory agencies, including the Iowa Division of Banking, the Missouri Division of Finance, the Federal Reserve, the FDIC and the CFPB. Furthermore, taxation laws administered by the Internal Revenue Service and state taxing authorities, accounting rules developed by the Financial Accounting Standards Board, securities laws administered by the SEC and state securities authorities, and anti-money laundering laws enforced by the Treasury have an impact on the business of the Company. The effect of these statutes, regulations, regulatory policies and accounting rules are significant to the Company’s operations and results.

Federal and state banking laws impose a comprehensive system of supervision, regulation and enforcement on the operations of FDIC-insured institutions, their holding companies and affiliates that is intended primarily for the protection of the FDIC-insured deposits and depositors of banks, rather than stockholders. These laws, and the regulations of the bank regulatory agencies issued under them, affect, among other things, the scope of the Company’s business, the kinds and amounts of investments the Company and the Banks may make, required capital levels relative to assets, the nature and amount of collateral for loans, the establishment of branches, the ability to merge, consolidate and acquire, dealings with the Company’s and the Banks’ insiders and affiliates and the Company’s payment of dividends.

In reaction to the global financial crisis and particularly following the passage of the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company experienced heightened regulatory requirements and scrutiny. Although the reforms primarily targeted systemically important financial service providers, their influence filtered down in varying degrees to community banks over time and caused the Company’s compliance and risk management processes, and the costs thereof, to increase. The Economic Growth, Regulatory Relief and Consumer Protection Act of 2018 (“Regulatory Relief Act”) eliminated questions about the applicability of certain Dodd-Frank Act reforms to community bank systems, including relieving the Company of any requirement to engage in mandatory stress tests, maintain a risk committee or comply with the Volcker Rule’s complicated prohibitions on proprietary trading and ownership of private funds. These reforms have been favorable to the Company’s operations.

The supervisory framework for U.S. banking organizations subjects banks and bank holding companies to regular examination by their respective regulatory agencies, which results in examination reports and ratings that are not publicly available and that can impact the conduct and growth of their business. These examinations consider not only compliance with applicable laws and regulations, but also capital levels, asset quality and risk, management ability and performance, earnings, liquidity, and various other factors. The regulatory agencies generally have broad discretion to impose restrictions and limitations on the operations of a regulated entity where the agencies determine, among other things, that such operations are unsafe or unsound, fail to comply with applicable law or are otherwise inconsistent with laws and regulations.

The following is a summary of the material elements of the supervisory and regulatory framework applicable to the Company and the Banks. It does not describe all of the statutes, regulations and regulatory policies that apply, nor does it restate all of the requirements of those that are described. The descriptions are qualified in their entirety by reference to the particular statutory and regulatory provision.

145

Table of Contents

COVID-19 Pandemic

The federal bank regulatory agencies, along with their state counterparts, issued a steady stream of guidance responding to the COVID-19 pandemic and they took a number of unprecedented steps to help banks navigate the pandemic and mitigate its impact. These included, without limitation: requiring banks to focus on business continuity and pandemic planning; adding pandemic scenarios to stress testing; encouraging bank use of capital buffers and reserves in lending programs; permitting certain regulatory reporting extensions; reducing margin requirements on swaps; permitting certain otherwise prohibited investments in investment funds; issuing guidance to encourage banks to work with customers affected by the pandemic and encourage loan workouts; and providing credit under the CRA for certain pandemic-related loans, investments and public service. Because of the need for social distancing measures, the agencies revamped the manner in which they conducted periodic examinations of their regulated institutions, including making greater use of off-site reviews, and they have continued using virtual bank examinations in 2022.

Reference is made to the discussion of Economic Risks in the Risk Factors section and Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations of the Company’s Form 10-K for discussions of the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic. In addition, information as to selected topics is contained in the relevant sections of this Supervision and Regulation discussion provided below.

The Role of Capital

Regulatory capital represents the net assets of a banking organization available to absorb losses. Because of the risks attendant to their business, FDIC-insured institutions generally are required to hold more capital than other businesses, which directly affects the Company’s earnings capabilities. Although capital has historically been one of the key measures of the financial health of both bank holding companies and banks, its role became fundamentally more important in the wake of the global financial crisis, as the banking regulators recognized that the amount and quality of capital held by banks prior to the crisis was insufficient to absorb losses during periods of severe stress.

Capital Levels. Banks have been required to hold minimum levels of capital based on guidelines established by the bank regulatory agencies since 1983. The minimums have been expressed in terms of ratios of “capital” divided by “total assets.” The capital guidelines for U.S. banks beginning in 1989 have been based upon international capital accords (known as “Basel” rules) adopted by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, a committee of central banks and bank supervisors that acts as the primary global standard-setter for prudential regulation, as implemented by the U.S. bank regulatory agencies on an interagency basis. The accords recognized that bank assets for the purpose of the capital ratio calculations needed to be risk weighted (the theory being that riskier assets should require more capital) and that off-balance sheet exposures needed to be factored in the calculations. Following the global financial crisis, the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, announced agreement on a strengthened set of capital requirements for banking organizations around the world, known as Basel III, to address deficiencies recognized in connection with the global financial crisis. 

The Basel III Rule. The United States bank regulatory agencies adopted the Basel III regulatory capital reforms, and, at the same time, effected changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act, in regulations that were effective (with certain phase-ins) in 2015 (the “Basel III Rule”). Basel III established capital standards for banks and bank holding companies that are meaningfully more stringent than those in place previously: it increased the required quantity and quality of capital; and it required a more complex, detailed and calibrated assessment of risk in the calculation of risk weightings.

146

Table of Contents

The Basel III Rule is applicable to all banking organizations that are subject to minimum capital requirements, including federal and state banks and savings and loan associations, as well as to most bank and savings and loan holding companies. The Company and the Banks are each subject to the Basel III Rule.

Not only did the Basel III Rule increase most of the required minimum capital ratios in effect prior to January 1, 2015, but in requiring that forms of capital be of higher quality to absorb loss, it introduced the concept of Common Equity Tier 1 Capital, which consists primarily of common stock, related surplus (net of Treasury stock), retained earnings, and Common Equity Tier 1 minority interests subject to certain regulatory adjustments. The Basel III Rule also changed the definition of capital by establishing more stringent criteria that instruments must meet to be considered Additional Tier 1 Capital (primarily non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock that meets certain requirements) and Tier 2 Capital (primarily other types of preferred stock and subordinated debt, subject to limitations). The Basel III Rule also constrained the inclusion of minority interests, mortgage-servicing assets, and deferred tax assets in capital and required deductions from Common Equity Tier 1 Capital in the event that such assets exceeded a percentage of a banking institution’s Common Equity Tier 1 Capital.

The Basel III Rule requires minimum capital ratios as follows:

A ratio of Common Equity Tier 1 Capital equal to 4.5% of risk-weighted assets;
A ratio of Tier 1 Capital equal to 6% of risk-weighted assets;
A continuation of the minimum required amount of Total Capital (Tier 1 plus Tier 2) at 8% of risk-weighted assets; and
A leverage ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total quarterly average assets equal to 4% in all circumstances.

In addition, institutions that seek the freedom to make capital distributions (including for dividends and repurchases of stock) and pay discretionary bonuses to executive officers without restriction must also maintain 2.5% in Common Equity Tier 1 Capital attributable to a capital conservation buffer. The purpose of the conservation buffer is to ensure that banking institutions maintain a buffer of capital that can be used to absorb losses during periods of financial and economic stress. Factoring in the conservation buffer increases the minimum ratios depicted above to 7% for Common Equity Tier 1 Capital, 8.5% for Tier 1 Capital and 10.5% for Total Capital. The federal bank regulators released a joint statement in response to the COVID-19 pandemic reminding the industry that capital and liquidity buffers were meant to give banks the means to support the economy in adverse situations, and that the agencies would support banks that use the buffers for that purpose if undertaken in a safe and sound manner.

Well-Capitalized Requirements. The ratios described above are minimum standards for banking organizations to be considered “adequately capitalized.” Bank regulatory agencies uniformly encourage banks to hold more capital and be “well-capitalized” and, to that end, federal law and regulations provide various incentives for banking organizations to maintain regulatory capital at levels in excess of minimum regulatory requirements. For example, a banking organization that is well-capitalized may: (i) qualify for exemptions from prior notice or application requirements otherwise applicable to certain types of activities; (ii) qualify for expedited processing of other required notices or applications; and (iii) accept, roll-over or renew brokered deposits. Higher capital levels could also be required if warranted by the particular circumstances or risk profiles of individual banking organizations. For example, the Federal Reserve’s capital guidelines contemplate that additional capital may be required to take adequate account of, among other things, interest rate risk, or the risks posed by concentrations of credit, nontraditional activities or securities trading activities. Further, any banking organization experiencing or anticipating significant growth would be expected to

147

Table of Contents

maintain capital ratios, including tangible capital positions (i.e., Tier 1 Capital less all intangible assets), well above the minimum levels.

Under the capital regulations of the Federal Reserve, in order to be well-capitalized, a banking organization must maintain:

A Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio to risk-weighted assets of 6.5% or more;
A ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total risk-weighted assets of 8% or more;
A ratio of Total Capital to total risk-weighted assets of 10% or more; and
A leverage ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total adjusted average quarterly assets of 5% or greater.

It is possible under the Basel III Rule to be well-capitalized while remaining out of compliance with the capital conservation buffer discussed above.

As of December 31, 2021: (i) none of the Banks was subject to a directive from the Iowa Division of Banking, the Missouri Division of Finance, or the Federal Reserve, as applicable, to increase its capital and (ii) the Banks were well-capitalized, as defined by Federal Reserve regulations. As of December 31, 2021, the Company had regulatory capital in excess of the Federal Reserve’s requirements and met the Basel III Rule requirements to be well-capitalized. The Company also is in compliance with the capital conservation buffer.

Prompt Corrective Action. The concept of an institution being “well-capitalized” is part of a regulatory enforcement regime that provides the federal banking regulators with broad power to take “prompt corrective action” to resolve the problems of depository institutions based on the capital level of each particular institution. The extent of the regulators’ powers depends on whether the institution in question is “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” or “critically undercapitalized,” in each case as defined by regulation. Depending upon the capital category to which an institution is assigned, the regulators’ corrective powers include: (i) requiring the institution to submit a capital restoration plan; (ii) limiting the institution’s asset growth and restricting its activities; (iii) requiring the institution to issue additional capital stock (including additional voting stock) or to sell itself; (iv) restricting transactions between the institution and its affiliates; (v) restricting the interest rate that the institution may pay on deposits; (vi) ordering a new election of directors of the institution; (vii) requiring that senior executive officers or directors be dismissed; (viii) prohibiting the institution from accepting deposits from correspondent banks; (ix) requiring the institution to divest certain subsidiaries; (x) prohibiting the payment of principal or interest on subordinated debt; and (xi) ultimately, appointing a receiver for the institution.

Community Bank Capital Simplification.  Community banks have long raised concerns with bank regulators about the regulatory burden, complexity, and costs associated with certain provisions of the Basel III Rule.  In response, Congress provided an “off-ramp” for institutions, like the Company, with total consolidated assets of less than $10 billion. Section 201 of the Regulatory Relief Act instructed the federal banking regulators to establish a single “Community Bank Leverage Ratio” (“CBLR”) of between 8 and 10%. Under the final rule, a community banking organization is eligible to elect the new framework if it has: less than $10 billion in total consolidated assets, limited amounts of certain assets and off-balance sheet exposures, and a CBLR greater than 9%. The Company may elect the CBLR framework at any time but has not currently determined to do so.

Supervision and Regulation of the Company

General. The Company, as the sole stockholder of the Banks, is a bank holding company. As a bank holding company, the Company is registered with, and is subject to regulation, supervision and enforcement by, the Federal Reserve under the BHCA. The Company is legally obligated to act as a source of financial

148

Table of Contents

strength to the Banks and to commit resources to support the Banks in circumstances where the Company might not otherwise do so. Under the BHCA, the Company is subject to periodic examination by the Federal Reserve. The Company is required to file with the Federal Reserve periodic reports of the Company’s operations and such additional information regarding the Company and its subsidiaries as the Federal Reserve may require.

Acquisitions, Activities and Financial Holding Company Election. The primary purpose of a bank holding company is to control and manage banks. The BHCA generally requires the prior approval of the Federal Reserve for any merger involving a bank holding company or any acquisition by a bank holding company of another bank or bank holding company. Subject to certain conditions (including deposit concentration limits established by the BHCA), the Federal Reserve may allow a bank holding company to acquire banks located in any state of the United States. In approving interstate acquisitions, the Federal Reserve is required to give effect to applicable state law limitations on the aggregate amount of deposits that may be held by the acquiring bank holding company and its FDIC-insured institution affiliates in the state in which the target bank is located (provided that those limits do not discriminate against out-of-state institutions or their holding companies) and state laws that require that the target bank have been in existence for a minimum period of time (not to exceed five years) before being acquired by an out-of-state bank holding company. Furthermore, in accordance with the Dodd-Frank Act, bank holding companies must be well-capitalized and well-managed in order to effect interstate mergers or acquisitions. For a discussion of the capital requirements, see “—The Role of Capital” above.

The BHCA generally prohibits the Company from acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any company that is not a bank and from engaging in any business other than that of banking, managing and controlling banks or furnishing services to banks and their subsidiaries. This general prohibition is subject to a number of exceptions. The principal exception allows bank holding companies to engage in, and to own shares of companies engaged in, certain businesses found by the Federal Reserve prior to November 11, 1999, to be “so closely related to banking ... as to be a proper incident thereto.” This authority permits the Company to engage in a variety of banking-related businesses, including the ownership and operation of a savings association, or any entity engaged in consumer finance, equipment leasing, the operation of a computer service bureau (including software development) and mortgage banking and brokerage services. The BHCA does not place territorial restrictions on the domestic activities of nonbank subsidiaries of bank holding companies.

Additionally, bank holding companies that meet certain eligibility requirements prescribed by the BHCA and elect to operate as financial holding companies may engage in, or own shares in companies engaged in, a wider range of nonbanking activities, including securities and insurance underwriting and sales, merchant banking and any other activity that the Federal Reserve, in consultation with the Secretary of the Treasury, determines by regulation or order is financial in nature or incidental to any such financial activity or that the Federal Reserve determines by order to be complementary to any such financial activity, as long as the activity does not pose a substantial risk to the safety or soundness of FDIC-insured institutions or the financial system generally. The Company has elected to operate as a financial holding company.

In order to maintain its status as a financial holding company, the Company and the Banks must be well-capitalized, well-managed, and the Banks must have a least a satisfactory CRA rating. If the Federal Reserve determines that a financial holding company is not well-capitalized or well-managed, the Federal Reserve will provide a period of time in which to achieve compliance, but, during the period of noncompliance, the Federal Reserve may place any limitations on the Company that it deems appropriate. Furthermore, if the Federal Reserve determines that a financial holding company’s subsidiary bank has not received a satisfactory CRA rating, that company will not be able to commence any new financial activities or acquire a company that engages in such activities.

149

Table of Contents

Change in Control. Federal law prohibits any person or company from acquiring “control” of an FDIC-insured depository institution or its holding company without prior notice to the appropriate federal bank regulator. “Control” is conclusively presumed to exist upon the acquisition of 25% or more of the outstanding voting securities of a bank or bank holding company but may arise under certain circumstances between 10% and 24.99% ownership.

Capital Requirements. Bank holding companies are required to maintain capital in accordance with Federal Reserve capital adequacy requirements. For a discussion of capital requirements, see “—The Role of Capital” above.

Dividend Payments. The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its stockholders may be affected by both general corporate law considerations and policies of the Federal Reserve applicable to bank holding companies. As a Delaware corporation, the Company is subject to the limitations of the DGCL, which allow the Company to pay dividends only out of its surplus (as defined and computed in accordance with the provisions of the DGCL) or if the Company has no such surplus, out of its net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend is declared and/or the preceding fiscal year.

As a general matter, the Federal Reserve has indicated that the board of directors of a bank holding company should eliminate, defer or significantly reduce dividends to stockholders if: (i) the company’s net income available to stockholders for the past four quarters, net of dividends previously paid during that period, is not sufficient to fully fund the dividends; (ii) the prospective rate of earnings retention is inconsistent with the company’s capital needs and overall current and prospective financial condition; or (iii) the company will not meet, or is in danger of not meeting, its minimum regulatory capital adequacy ratios. The Federal Reserve also possesses enforcement powers over bank holding companies and their nonbank subsidiaries to prevent or remedy actions that represent unsafe or unsound practices or violations of applicable statutes and regulations. Among these powers is the ability to proscribe the payment of dividends by banks and bank holding companies. In addition, under the Basel III Rule, institutions that seek the freedom to pay dividends have to maintain 2.5% in Common Equity Tier 1 Capital attributable to the capital conservation buffer. See “—The Role of Capital” above.

Incentive Compensation. There have been a number of developments in recent years focused on incentive compensation plans sponsored by bank holding companies and banks, reflecting recognition by the bank regulatory agencies and Congress that flawed incentive compensation practices in the financial industry were one of many factors contributing to the global financial crisis. Layered on top of that are the abuses in the headlines dealing with product cross-selling incentive plans. The result is interagency guidance on sound incentive compensation practices.

The interagency guidance recognized three core principles. Effective incentive plans should: (i) provide employees incentives that appropriately balance risk and reward; (ii) be compatible with effective controls and risk-management; and (iii) be supported by strong corporate governance, including active and effective oversight by the organization’s board of directors. Much of the guidance addresses large banking organizations and, because of the size and complexity of their operations, the regulators expect those organizations to maintain systematic and formalized policies, procedures, and systems for ensuring that the incentive compensation arrangements for all executive and non-executive employees covered by this guidance are identified and reviewed, and appropriately balance risks and rewards.  Smaller banking organizations, like the Company, that use incentive compensation arrangements are expected to be less extensive, formalized, and detailed than those of the larger banks. 

Monetary Policy. The monetary policy of the Federal Reserve has a significant effect on the operating results of financial or bank holding companies and their subsidiaries. Among the tools available to the Federal Reserve to affect the money supply are open market transactions in U.S. government securities

150

Table of Contents

and changes in the discount rate on bank borrowings. These means are used in varying combinations to influence overall growth and distribution of bank loans, investments and deposits, and their use may affect interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

Federal Securities Regulation. The Company’s common stock is registered with the SEC under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Exchange Act. Consequently, the Company is subject to the information, proxy solicitation, insider trading and other restrictions and requirements of the SEC under the Exchange Act.

Corporate Governance. The Dodd-Frank Act addressed many investor protection, corporate governance and executive compensation matters that will affect most U.S. publicly traded companies. It increased stockholder influence over boards of directors by requiring companies to give stockholders a nonbinding vote on executive compensation and so-called “golden parachute” payments and authorizing the SEC to promulgate rules that would allow stockholders to nominate and solicit voters for their own candidates using a company’s proxy materials. The legislation also directed the Federal Reserve to promulgate rules prohibiting excessive compensation paid to executives of bank holding companies, regardless of whether such companies are publicly traded.

Supervision and Regulation of the Banks

General. The Company owns four subsidiary banks: QCBT, CRBT and CSB are chartered under Iowa law (collectively, the “Iowa Banks”) and SFCB is chartered under Missouri law. The deposit accounts of the Banks are insured by the FDIC’s DIF to the maximum extent provided under federal law and FDIC regulations, currently $250,000 per insured depositor category. All four of the Company’s subsidiary banks are members of the Federal Reserve System (“member banks”). In 2019, the Company sold RB&T and it no longer owns a bank in Illinois. QCBT owns QCIA, a registered investment adviser, as a wholly owned subsidiary.

As Iowa-chartered, FDIC-insured banks, the Iowa Banks are subject to the examination, supervision, reporting and enforcement requirements of the Iowa Division of Banking, as the chartering authority for Iowa banks. As a Missouri-chartered, FDIC-insured bank, SFCB is subject to the examination, supervision, reporting and enforcement requirements of the Missouri Division of Finance, as the chartering authority for Missouri banks. All four of the Company’s subsidiary banks also are subject to the examination, reporting and enforcement requirements of the Federal Reserve, as the primary federal regulator of member banks. In addition, the FDIC, as administrator of the DIF, has regulatory authority over the Banks.

Deposit Insurance. As FDIC-insured institutions, the Banks are required to pay deposit insurance premium assessments to the FDIC.  The FDIC has adopted a risk-based assessment system whereby FDIC-insured institutions pay insurance premiums at rates based on their risk classification.  For institutions like the Banks that are not considered large and highly complex banking organizations, assessments are now based on examination ratings and financial ratios. The total base assessment rates currently range from 1.5 basis points to 30 basis points. At least semi-annually, the FDIC updates its loss and income projections for the DIF and, if needed, increases or decreases the assessment rates, following notice and comment on proposed rulemaking.

The reserve ratio is the FDIC insurance fund balance divided by estimated insured deposits. The Dodd-Frank Act altered the minimum reserve ratio of the DIF, increasing the minimum from 1.15% to 1.35% of the estimated amount of total insured deposits. The reserve ratio reached 1.36% as of September 30, 2018. As a result, the FDIC provided assessment credits to insured depository institutions, like the Banks, with total consolidated assets of less than $10 billion, for the portion of their regular assessments that contributed to growth in the reserve ratio between 1.15% and 1.35%. The FDIC applied the small bank credits for quarterly

151

Table of Contents

assessment periods beginning July 1, 2019. However, the reserve ratio fell to 1.30% in 2020 because of extraordinary insured deposit growth caused by an unprecedented inflow of more than $1 trillion in estimated insured deposits in the first half of 2020, stemming mainly from the COVID-19 pandemic. Although the FDIC could have ceased the small bank credits, it waived the requirement that the reserve ratio be at least 1.35% for full remittance of the remaining assessment credits, and it refunded all small bank credits to the Banks as of September 30, 2020.

The DIF balance was $121.9 billion on September 30, 2021, up $1.4 billion from the end of the second quarter.  The reserve ratio remained at 1.27%, as growth in the fund balance kept pace with growth in insured deposits. The FDIC staff continues to closely monitor the factors that affect the reserve ratio, and any change could impact FDIC assessments.

Supervisory Assessments. Each of the Banks is required to pay supervisory assessments to its respective state banking regulator to fund the operations of that agency. The amount of the assessment payable by each Bank is calculated on the basis of that Bank’s total assets. During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Iowa Banks paid supervisory assessments to the Iowa Division of Banking totaling $312,943 and SFCB paid supervisory assessments to the Missouri Division of Finance totaling $52,710.

Capital Requirements. Banks are generally required to maintain capital levels in excess of other businesses. For a discussion of capital requirements, see “—The Role of Capital” above.

Liquidity Requirements. Liquidity is a measure of the ability and ease with which bank assets may be converted to cash. Liquid assets are those that can be converted to cash quickly if needed to meet financial obligations. To remain viable, FDIC-insured institutions must have enough liquid assets to meet their near-term obligations, such as withdrawals by depositors. Because the global financial crisis was in part a liquidity crisis, Basel III also includes a liquidity framework that requires FDIC-insured institutions to measure their liquidity against specific liquidity tests. One test, referred to as the liquidity coverage ratio or LCR, is designed to ensure that the banking entity has an adequate stock of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets that can be converted easily and immediately in private markets into cash to meet liquidity needs for a 30-calendar day liquidity stress scenario. The other test, known as the net stable funding ratio or NSFR, is designed to promote more medium- and long-term funding of the assets and activities of FDIC-insured institutions over a one-year horizon. These tests provide an incentive for banks and holding companies to increase their holdings in Treasury securities and other sovereign debt as a component of assets, increase the use of long-term debt as a funding source and rely on stable funding like core deposits (in lieu of brokered deposits).

In addition to liquidity guidelines already in place, the federal bank regulatory agencies implemented the Basel III LCR in September 2014, which requires large financial firms to hold levels of liquid assets sufficient to protect against constraints on their funding during times of financial turmoil, and in 2016 proposed implementation of the NSFR. While these rules do not, and will not, apply to the Banks, they continue to review their liquidity risk management policies in light of developments.

Liability of Commonly Controlled Institutions. Under federal law, institutions insured by the FDIC may be liable for any loss incurred by, or reasonably expected to be incurred by, the FDIC in connection with the default of commonly controlled FDIC-insured depository institutions or any assistance provided by the FDIC to commonly controlled FDIC-insured depository institutions in danger of default. Because the Company controls each of the Banks, the Banks are commonly controlled for purposes of these provisions of federal law.

Dividend Payments. The primary source of funds for the Company is dividends from the Banks. In general, the Banks may only pay dividends either out of their historical net income after any required

152

Table of Contents

transfers to surplus or reserves have been made or out of their retained earnings. The Federal Reserve Act also imposes limitations on the amount of dividends paid by state member banks, such as the Banks. Without Federal Reserve approval, a state member bank may not pay dividends in any calendar year that, in the aggregate, exceed that bank’s calendar year-to-date net income plus the bank’s retained income for the two preceding calendar years.

The payment of dividends by any FDIC-insured institution is affected by the requirement to maintain adequate capital pursuant to applicable capital adequacy guidelines and regulations, and an FDIC-insured institution generally is prohibited from paying any dividends if, following payment thereof, the institution would be undercapitalized. As described above, each of the Banks exceeded its minimum capital requirements under applicable guidelines as of December 31, 2021. Notwithstanding the availability of funds for dividends, however, the Federal Reserve, the FDIC, the Missouri Division of Finance or the Iowa Division of Banking, as applicable, may prohibit the payment of dividends by one of the Banks if it determines such payment would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice. In addition, under the Basel III Rule, institutions that seek the freedom to pay unrestricted dividends have to maintain 2.5% in Common Equity Tier 1 Capital attributable to the capital conservation buffer. See “—The Role of Capital” above.

State Bank Investments and Activities. The Banks are permitted to make investments and engage in activities directly or through subsidiaries as authorized by Iowa or Missouri law, as applicable. However, under federal law and FDIC regulations, FDIC-insured state banks are prohibited, subject to certain exceptions, from making or retaining equity investments of a type, or in an amount, that are not permissible for a national bank. Federal law and FDIC regulations also prohibit FDIC-insured state banks and their subsidiaries, subject to certain exceptions, from engaging as principal in any activity that is not permitted for a national bank unless the bank meets, and continues to meet, its minimum regulatory capital requirements and the FDIC determines that the activity would not pose a significant risk to the DIF. These restrictions have not had, and are not currently expected to have, a material impact on the operations of the Banks.

Insider Transactions. The Banks are subject to certain restrictions imposed by federal law on “covered transactions” between each Bank and its “affiliates.” The Company is an affiliate of the Banks for purposes of these restrictions, and covered transactions subject to the restrictions include extensions of credit to the Company, investments in the stock or other securities of the Company and the acceptance of the stock or other securities of the Company as collateral for loans made by any of the Banks. The Dodd-Frank Act enhanced the requirements for certain transactions with affiliates, including an expansion of the definition of “covered transactions” and an increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered transactions must be maintained.

Certain limitations and reporting requirements are also placed on extensions of credit by each Bank to its directors and officers, to directors and officers of the Company and its subsidiaries, to principal stockholders of the Company and to “related interests” of such directors, officers and principal stockholders. In addition, federal law and regulations may affect the terms on which any person who is a director or officer of the Company or the Banks, or a principal stockholder of the Company, may obtain credit from banks with which any of the Banks maintains a correspondent relationship.

Safety and Soundness Standards/Risk Management. The federal banking agencies have adopted operational and managerial standards to promote the safety and soundness of FDIC-insured institutions. The standards apply to internal controls, information systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth, compensation, fees and benefits, asset quality and earnings.

In general, the safety and soundness standards prescribe the goals to be achieved in each area, and each institution is responsible for establishing its own procedures to achieve those goals. Although regulatory standards do not have the force of law, if an institution operates in an unsafe and unsound manner, the FDIC-

153

Table of Contents

insured institution’s primary federal regulator may require the institution to submit a plan for achieving and maintaining compliance. If an FDIC-insured institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan or fails in any material respect to implement a compliance plan that has been accepted by its primary federal regulator, the regulator is required to issue an order directing the institution to cure the deficiency. Until the deficiency cited in the regulator’s order is cured, the regulator may restrict the FDIC-insured institution’s rate of growth, require the FDIC-insured institution to increase its capital, restrict the rates that the institution pays on deposits, or require the institution to take any action that the regulator deems appropriate under the circumstances. Noncompliance with safety and soundness also may constitute grounds for other enforcement action by the federal bank regulatory agencies, including cease and desist orders and civil money penalty assessments.

During the past decade, the bank regulatory agencies have increasingly emphasized the importance of sound risk management processes and strong internal controls when evaluating the activities of the FDIC-insured institutions that they supervise. Properly managing risks has been identified as critical to the conduct of safe and sound banking activities and has become even more important as new technologies, product innovation, and the size and speed of financial transactions have changed the nature of banking markets. The agencies have identified a spectrum of risks facing a banking institution including, but not limited to, credit, market, liquidity, operational, legal and reputational risk. Each Bank is expected to have active board and senior management oversight; adequate policies, procedures and limits; adequate risk measurement, monitoring and management information systems; and comprehensive internal controls.

Privacy and Cybersecurity. The Banks are subject to many U.S. federal and state laws and regulations governing requirements for maintaining policies and procedures to protect non-public confidential information of their customers. These laws require each Bank to periodically disclose its privacy policies and practices relating to sharing such information and permit consumers to opt out of their ability to share information with unaffiliated third parties under certain circumstances. They also impact each Bank’s ability to share certain information with affiliates and non-affiliates for marketing and/or non-marketing purposes, or to contact customers with marketing offers. In addition, the Banks are required to implement a comprehensive information security program that includes administrative, technical, and physical safeguards to ensure the security and confidentiality of customer records and information. These security and privacy policies and procedures are in effect across all businesses and geographic locations.

Branching Authority. The Iowa Banks have the authority under Iowa law to establish branches anywhere in the State of Iowa, subject to receipt of all required regulatory approvals. Similarly, SFCB has the authority under Missouri law to establish branches anywhere in the State of Missouri, subject to receipt of all required regulatory approvals. The Dodd-Frank Act permits well-capitalized and well-managed banks to establish new interstate branches or acquire individual branches of a bank in another state (rather than the acquisition of an out-of-state bank in its entirety) without impediments. In addition, federal law permits state and national banks to merge with banks in other states subject to: (i) regulatory approval; (ii) federal and state deposit concentration limits; and (iii) state law limitations requiring the merging bank to have been in existence for a minimum period of time (not to exceed five years) prior to the merger.

Transaction Account Reserves. Federal law requires FDIC-insured institutions to maintain reserves against their transaction accounts (primarily NOW and regular checking accounts) to provide liquidity. The amount of reserves is established by the Federal Reserve based on tranches of zero, three and ten percent of a bank’s transaction account deposits. However, in March 2020, in an unprecedented move, the Federal Reserve announced that the banking system had ample reserves, and, as reserve requirements no longer played a significant role in this regime, it reduced all reserve tranches to zero percent, thereby freeing banks from the legally mandated reserve maintenance requirement. The action permits the Banks to loan or invest

154

Table of Contents

funds that were previously unavailable. The Federal Reserve has indicated that it expects to continue to operate in an ample reserves regime for the foreseeable future.

Federal Home Loan Bank System. The Banks are each a member of the FHLB, which serves as a central credit facility for its members. The FHLB is funded primarily from proceeds from the sale of obligations of the FHLB system. It makes loans to member banks in the form of FHLB advances. All advances from the FHLB are required to be fully collateralized as determined by the FHLB.

Community Reinvestment Act Requirements. The CRA requires the Banks to have a continuing and affirmative obligation in a safe and sound manner to help meet the credit needs of the entire community, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. Federal regulators regularly assess each Bank’s record of meeting the credit needs of its communities. Applications for additional acquisitions would be affected by the evaluation of the Bank’s effectiveness in meeting its CRA requirements. In a joint statement responding to the COVID-19 pandemic, the bank regulatory agencies announced favorable CRA consideration for banks providing retail banking services and lending activities in their assessment areas, consistent with safe and sound banking practices, that are responsive to the needs of low- and moderate-income individuals, small businesses, and small farms affected by the pandemic. Those activities include waiving certain fees, easing restrictions on out-of-state and non-customer checks, expanding credit products, increasing credit limits for creditworthy borrowers, providing alternative service options, and offering prudent payment accommodations. The joint statement also provided favorable CRA consideration for certain pandemic-related community development activities.

Anti-Money Laundering. The USA PATRIOT Act, the Bank Secrecy Act and other similar laws are designed to deny terrorists and criminals the ability to obtain access to the U.S. financial system and have significant implications for FDIC-insured institutions and other businesses involved in the transfer of money. These laws mandate financial services companies to have policies and procedures with respect to measures designed to address the following matters: (i) customer identification programs; (ii) money laundering; (iii) terrorist financing; (iv) identifying and reporting suspicious activities and currency transactions; (v) currency crimes; and (vi) cooperation between FDIC-insured institutions and law enforcement authorities.

Concentrations in Commercial Real Estate. Concentration risk exists when FDIC-insured institutions deploy too many assets to any one industry or segment. A concentration in commercial real estate (“CRE”) is one example of regulatory concern. The interagency Concentrations in Commercial Real Estate Lending, Sound Risk Management Practices guidance (“CRE Guidance”) provides supervisory criteria, including the following numerical indicators, to assist bank examiners in identifying banks with potentially significant commercial real estate loan concentrations that may warrant greater supervisory scrutiny: (i) CRE loans exceeding 300% of capital and increasing 50% or more in the preceding three years; or (ii) construction and land development loans exceeding 100% of capital. The CRE Guidance does not limit banks’ levels of CRE lending activities, but rather guides institutions in developing risk management practices and levels of capital that are commensurate with the level and nature of their commercial real estate concentrations. On December 18, 2015, the federal banking agencies issued a statement to reinforce prudent risk-management practices related to CRE lending, having observed substantial growth in many CRE asset and lending markets, increased competitive pressures, rising CRE concentrations in banks, and an easing of CRE underwriting standards. The federal bank agencies reminded FDIC-insured institutions to maintain underwriting discipline and exercise prudent risk-management practices to identify, measure, monitor, and manage the risks arising from CRE lending. In addition, FDIC-insured institutions must maintain capital commensurate with the level and nature of their CRE concentration risk. As of December 31, 2021, QCBT, CRBT and SFCB were in compliance with the 300% guideline for commercial real estate loans. Although CSB’s loan portfolio has historically been real estate dominated and its real estate portfolio levels exceed these policy limits, it has established a Credit Risk Committee to routinely monitor its real estate portfolio.

155

Table of Contents

Consumer Financial Services. The historical structure of federal consumer protection regulation applicable to all providers of consumer financial products and services changed significantly on July 21, 2011, when the CFPB commenced operations to supervise and enforce consumer protection laws. The CFPB has broad rulemaking authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that apply to all providers of consumer products and services, including the Banks, as well as the authority to prohibit “unfair, deceptive or abusive” acts and practices. The CFPB has examination and enforcement authority over providers with more than $10 billion in assets. FDIC-insured institutions with $10 billion or less in assets, like the Banks, continue to be examined by their applicable bank regulators.

Because abuses in connection with residential mortgages were a significant factor contributing to the global financial crisis, many rules issued by the CFPB, as required by the Dodd-Frank Act, addressed mortgage and mortgage-related products, their underwriting, origination, servicing and sales. The Dodd-Frank Act significantly expanded underwriting requirements applicable to loans secured by 1-4 family residential real property and augmented federal law combating predatory lending practices. In addition to numerous disclosure requirements, the Dodd-Frank Act and the CFPB’s enabling rules imposed new standards for mortgage loan originations on all lenders, including banks and savings associations, in an effort to strongly encourage lenders to verify a borrower’s ability to repay, while also establishing a presumption of compliance for certain “qualified mortgages.” The CFPB’s rules have not had a significant impact on any Bank operations, except for higher compliance costs.

Regulation of QCIA

QCIA provides financial investment services as part of the wealth management operations of the Company. QCIA is an investment adviser registered with the SEC.  The SEC has supervisory, examination and enforcement authority over its operations. The SEC’s focus is primarily for the protection of investors under the federal securities laws.

 

156